This vehicle is equipped with service-related devices that record information about powertrain ...... computer's ELAPSED TIME display, and press ...... Page 365 ...
2008 MDX Owner’s Manual (Unlinked)
This document does not contain hyperlinks and may be formatted for printing instead of web us. This is due to changes in content and specifications of the vehicle that happen throughout the model year. This manual will be replaced with a hyperlinked version at the end of the model year. © 2007 Honda Motor Co., Ltd. P/N 00X31-STX-6102
07/07/09 09:20:33 31STX610 0001
Owner s Identification This owner’s manual should be considered a permanent part of the vehicle and should remain with the vehicle when it is sold.
OWNER
This Owner’s Manual covers all models of the MDX. You may find descriptions of equipment and features that are not on your particular model.
ADDRESS STREET
CITY
STATE/PROVINCE
ZIP CODE/ POSTAL CODE
V. I. N. DELIVERY DATE (Date sold to original retail purchaser)
DEALER NAME
DEALER NO.
ADDRESS STREET
CITY
OWNER’S SIGNATURE DEALER’S SIGNATURE
STATE/PROVINCE
ZIP CODE/ POSTAL CODE
The information and specifications included in this publication were in effect at the time of approval for printing. Honda Motor Co., Ltd. reserves the right, however, to discontinue or change specifications or design at any time without notice and without incurring any obligation whatsoever. POUR CLIENTS CANADIEN AVIS IMPORTANT: Si vous avez besoin d un Manuel du Conducteur en fran ais, veuillez demander votre concessionnaire de commander le numØro de piŁce 33STXC10
07/07/09 09:20:38 31STX610 0002
Introduction Congratulations! Your selection of a 2008 Acura MDX was a wise investment. It will give you years of driving pleasure. One of the best ways to enhance the enjoyment of your new vehicle is to read this manual. In it, you will learn how to operate its driving controls and convenience items. Afterwards, keep this owner’s manual in your vehicle so you can refer to it at any time.
As you read this manual, you will find information that is preceded by a symbol. This information is intended to help you avoid damage to your vehicle, other property, or the environment.
Several warranties protect your new vehicle. Read the warranty booklet thoroughly so you understand the coverages and are aware of your rights and responsibilities. Maintaining your vehicle according to the maintenance minder shown in the instrument panel helps to keep your driving trouble-free while it preserves your investment. When your vehicle needs maintenance, keep in mind that your dealer’s staff is specially trained in servicing the many systems unique to your vehicle. Your dealer is dedicated to your satisfaction and will be pleased to answer any questions and concerns.
i
07/07/09 09:20:42 31STX610 0003
Introduction California Proposition 65 Warning WARNING: This product contains or emits chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm. Event Data Recorders This vehicle is equipped with one or more devices commonly referred to as event data recorders. These devices record front seat belt use, front passenger seat occupancy, airbag deployment data, and the failure of any airbag system component. This data belongs to the vehicle owner and may not be accessed by anyone else except as legally required or with the permission of the vehicle owner. Service Diagnostic Recorders This vehicle is equipped with service-related devices that record information about powertrain performance. The data can be used to verify emissions law requirements and/or help technicians diagnose and solve service problems. It may also be combined with data from other sources for research purposes, but it remains confidential.
ii
07/07/09 09:20:52 31STX610 0004
A Few Words About Safety Your safety, and the safety of others, is very important. And operating this vehicle safely is an important responsibility. To help you make informed decisions about safety, we have provided operating procedures and other information on labels and in this manual. This information alerts you to potential hazards that could hurt you or others. Of course, it is not practical or possible to warn you about all the hazards associated with operating or maintaining your vehicle. You must use your own good judgement.
You will find this important safety information in a variety of forms, including: Safety Labels − on the vehicle. and one of Safety Messages − preceded by a safety alert symbol three signal words: DANGER, WARNING, or CAUTION. These signal words mean: You WILL be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if you don’t follow instructions. You CAN be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if you don’t follow instructions. You CAN be HURT if you don’t follow instructions. Safety Headings − such as Important Safety Reminders or Important Safety Precautions. Safety Section − such as Driver and Passenger Safety. Instructions − how to use this vehicle correctly and safely. This entire book is filled with important safety information − please read it carefully.
iii
07/07/09 09:20:57 31STX610 0005
Important Handling Information Your MDX has higher ground clearance than a passenger vehicle designed for use only on pavement. Higher ground clearance has many advantages for off-highway driving. It allows you to travel over bumps, obstacles, and rough terrain. It also provides good visibility so you can anticipate problems earlier. These advantages come at some cost. Because your vehicle is taller and rides higher off the ground, it has a high center of gravity. This means your vehicle can tip or roll over if you make abrupt turns. Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover rate than other types of vehicles. In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt. As a reminder, make sure you and your passengers always wear seat belts. For information on how to reduce the risk of rollover, read ‘‘Driving Guidelines’’ on page 338 of this manual and the Off-Highway Driving Guidelines section on page 377 . Failure to operate your vehicle correctly might result in loss of control or an accident.
iv
07/07/09 09:21:06 31STX610 0006
Contents Your Vehicle at a Glance (main controls) ................................................................................................ 3 Driver and Passenger Safety (seat belts, SRS, and child protection) ............................................................. 5 Instruments and Controls (indicators, gauges, multi-information display, dashboard, and steering column) ........ 61 Features (climate control, audio, rear entertainment, steering wheel, security, cruise control, and other convenience items) ....... 169 Before Driving (fuel, vehicle break-in, and cargo loading) ........................................................................ 321 Driving (engine and transmission operation).......................................................................................... 337 Maintenance (minder, fluid checking, minor services, and vehicle storage).................................................. 381 Taking Care of the Unexpected (flat tire, dead battery, overheating, and fuses) .......................................... 423 Technical Information (vehicle specifications, tires, and emissions controls)............................................... 449 Warranty and Client Relations (U.S. and Canada only) (warranty and contact information) ........................ 465 Authorized Manuals (U.S. only) (how to order) ................................................................................... 469
Service Information Summary (fluid capacities and tire pressures) ................................................... last page
1
INDEX
Index ................................................................................................................................................. I
07/07/09 09:21:23 31STX610 0007
Overview of Contents Contents A convenient reference to the sections in this manual. Your Vehicle at a Glance A quick reference to the main controls in your vehicle. Driver and Passenger Safety Important information about the proper use and care of your vehicle’s seat belts, an overview of the supplemental restraint system, and valuable information on how to protect children with child restraints. Instruments and Controls Explains the purpose of each instrument panel indicator and gauge, and how to use the controls on the dashboard and steering column. Features How to operate the climate control system, the audio system, rear entertainment system, and other convenience features.
2
Before Driving What gasoline to use, how to breakin your new vehicle, and how to load luggage and other cargo. Driving The proper way to start the engine, shift the transmission, and park; plus what you need to know if you’re planning to tow a trailer. Maintenance The maintenance minder shows you when you need to take your vehicle to the dealer for maintenance service. There is also a list of things to check and instructions on how to check them. Taking Care of the Unexpected This section covers several problems motorists sometimes experience, and details how to handle them.
Technical Information ID numbers, dimensions, capacities, and technical information. Warranty and Client Relations (U.S. and Canada only) A summary of the warranties covering your new vehicle, and how to contact us for any reason. Refer to your warranty manual for detailed information. Authorized Manuals (U.S. only) How to order manuals and other technical literature. Index Service Information Summary A summary of the information you need when you pull up to the fuel pump.
07/07/09 09:21:32 31STX610 0008
Your Vehicle at a Glance
INSTRUMENT PANEL INDICATORS (P.63) GAUGES (P.72)
HomeLink BUTTONS (P.276)
MOONROOF SWITCH (P.152)
DRIVING POSITION MEMORY SYSTEM (P.157)
PASSENGER’S FRONT AIRBAG (P.9, 27)
POWER DOOR LOCK MASTER SWITCH (P.130)
CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM (P.170)
PARKING BRAKE RELEASE HANDLE (P.153)
AUDIO SYSTEM (P.180)
POWER WINDOW SWITCHES (P.149)
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION (P.341)
FUEL FILL DOOR RELEASE BUTTON (P.323)
REAR CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM (P.175)
POWER TAILGATE BUTTON* (P.132) HOOD RELEASE HANDLE (P.325)
*: If equipped
MIRROR CONTROL AUTO BUTTON* (P.154)
Your Vehicle at a Glance
DRIVER’S FRONT AIRBAG(P.9, 27)
PARKING BRAKE PEDAL (P.153)
AUXILIARY INPUT JACKS* (P.267)
HEADPHONE CONNECTORS* (P.268)
CONTINUED
3
07/07/09 09:21:41 31STX610 0009
Your Vehicle at a Glance
HEADLIGHT WASHER SWITCH*2 (P.117)
HEADLIGHT/TURN SIGNAL/ FRONT FOG LIGHTS (P.118)
STEERING WHEEL AUDIO CONTROLS (P.233)
WINDSHIELD WIPERS/WASHERS (P.116)
VEHICLE STABILITY ASSIST SYSTEM OFF SWITCH (P.360)
HAZARD WARNING BUTTON (P.122)
MIRROR CONTROLS (P.155)
REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER (P.122)
DRIVING POSITION MEMORY SYSTEM (P.157)
ACCESSORY POWER SOCKETS (P.166)
POWER DOOR LOCK MASTER SWITCH (P.130) PARKING BRAKE RELEASE HANDLE (P.153) POWER WINDOW SWITCHES (P.149) POWER TAILGATE FUEL FILL DOOR RELEASE BUTTON BUTTON*2 (P.132) (P.323)
SEAT HEATER SWITCHES (P.148)
HORN*1
HOOD RELEASE HANDLE (P.325)
STEERING WHEEL ADJUSTMENTS (P.124)
*1: To use the horn, press the center pad of the steering wheel. *2: If equipped
4
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRIGHTNESS (P.123) PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF INDICATOR (P.34)
CRUISE CONTROL BUTTONS (P.270)
ACTIVE DAMPER SYSTEM SWITCH*2 (P.361)
07/07/09 09:21:46 31STX610 0010
Driver and Passenger Safety
Important Safety Precautions .......... 6 Your Vehicle’s Safety Features........ 7 Seat Belts ........................................ 8 Airbags ............................................ 9 Protecting Adults and Teens.......... 11 1. Close and Lock the Doors ...... 11 2. Adjust the Front Seats ............ 12 3. Adjust the Seat-Backs ............. 13 4. Adjust the Head Restraints .... 14 5. Fasten and Position the Seat Belts ...................................... 15 6. Maintain a Proper Sitting Position ................................. 17 Advice for Pregnant Women...... 18 Additional Safety Precautions .... 19
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts ........................ 20 Seat Belt System Components ... 20 Lap/Shoulder Belt ....................... 21 Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners ................................ 22 Seat Belt Maintenance ................ 23 Additional Information About Your Airbags ............................ 24 Airbag System Components ....... 24 How Your Front Airbags Work.......................................... 27 How Your Side Airbags Work.... 30 How Your Side Curtain Airbags Work.......................................... 32 How the SRS Indicator Works ... 33 How The Side Airbag Off Indicator Works ....................... 33 How the Passenger Airbag Off Indicator Works ................ 34 Airbag Service .............................. 35 Additional Safety Precautions .... 35 Protecting Children − General Guidelines ................................. 37 All Children Must Be Restrained ................................ 37
All Children Should Sit in a Back Seat .................................. 38 The Passenger’s Front Airbag Can Pose Serious Risks .......... 38 If You Must Drive with Several Children .................................... 40 If a Child Requires Close Attention ................................... 40 Additional Safety Precautions .... 41 Protecting infants and Small Children.......................... 42 Protecting Infants ........................ 42 Protecting Small Children .......... 43 Selecting a Child Seat ...................... 45 Installing a Child Seat ..................... 46 With LATCH ................................ 47 With a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt .. 50 With a Tether ............................... 51 Protecting Larger Children ............ 54 Checking Seat Belt Fit ................ 54 Using a Booster Seat ................... 55 When Can a Child Sit in Front ... 56 Additional Safety Precautions .... 57 Carbon Monoxide Hazard .............. 58 Safety Labels .................................... 59
5
Driver and Passenger Safety
This section gives you important information about how to protect yourself and your passengers. It shows you how to use seat belts. It explains how your airbags work. And it tells you how to properly restrain infants and children in your vehicle.
07/07/09 09:21:56 31STX610 0011
Important Safety Precautions You’ll find many safety recommendations throughout this section, and throughout this manual. The recommendations on this page are the ones we consider to be the most important. Always Wear Your Seat Belt A seat belt is your best protection in all types of collisions. Airbags are designed to supplement seat belts, not replace them. So even though your vehicle is equipped with airbags, make sure you and your passengers always wear your seat belts, and wear them properly (see page 15 ).
Restrain All Children Children age 12 and under should ride properly restrained in a back seat, not the front seat. Infants and small children should be restrained in a child seat. Larger children should use a booster seat and a lap/ shoulder belt until they can use the belt properly without a booster seat (see pages 37 − 57 ). Be Aware of Airbag Hazards While airbags can save lives, they can cause serious or fatal injuries to occupants who sit too close to them, or are not properly restrained. Infants, young children, and short adults are at the greatest risk. Be sure to follow all instructions and warnings in this manual. Don tDrink and Drive Alcohol and driving don’t mix. Even one drink can reduce your ability to respond to changing conditions, and your reaction time gets worse with
6
every additional drink. So don’t drink and drive, and don’t let your friends drink and drive, either. Control Your Speed Excessive speed is a major factor in crash injuries and deaths. Generally, the higher the speed, the greater the risk, but serious injuries can also occur at lower speeds. Never drive faster than is safe for current conditions, regardless of the maximum speed posted. Keep Your Vehicle in Safe Condition Having a tire blowout or a mechanical failure can be extremely hazardous. To reduce the possibility of such problems, check your tire pressures and condition frequently, and perform all regularly scheduled maintenance (see page 415 ).
07/07/09 09:22:03 31STX610 0012
Your Vehicle sSafety Features
(3)
(1)
(4)
Some features do not require any action on your part. These include a strong steel framework that forms a safety cage around the passenger compartment, front and rear crush zones, a collapsible steering column, and tensioners that tighten the front seat belts in a crash.
(7)
(6) (5)
(11) (2)
(8) (10)
(2)
(1) Safety Cage (2) Crush Zones (3) Seats and Seat-Backs (4) Head Restraints (5) Collapsible Steering Column (6) Seat Belts (7) Front Airbags (8) Side Airbags (9) Side Curtain Airbags (10) Front Seat Belt Tensioners (11) Door Locks
However, you and your passengers can’t take full advantage of these features unless you remain sitting in a proper position and always wear your seat belts. In fact, some safety features can contribute to injuries if they are not used properly. The following pages explain how you can take an active role in protecting yourself and your passengers.
7
Driver and Passenger Safety
Your vehicle is equipped with many features that work together to protect you and your passengers during a crash.
(9)
07/07/09 09:22:15 31STX610 0013
Your Vehicle sSafety Features Seat Belts Your vehicle is equipped with seat belts in all seating positions. Your seat belt system also includes an indicator on the instrument panel and a beeper to remind you and your passengers to fasten your seat belts. Why Wear Seat Belts
Seat belts are the single most effective safety device for adults and larger children. (Infants and smaller children must be properly restrained in child seats.) Not wearing a seat belt properly increases the chance of serious injury or death in a crash, even though your vehicle has airbags. In addition, most states and all Canadian provinces require you to wear seat belts.
8
Not wearing a seat belt properly increases the chance of serious injury or death in a crash, even though your vehicle has airbags. Be sure you and your passengers always wear seat belts and wear them properly. When properly worn, seat belts: Keep you connected to the vehicle so you can take advantage of the vehicle’s built-in safety features. Help protect you in almost every type of crash, including frontal, side, and rear impacts and rollovers.
Help keep you from being thrown against the inside of the vehicle and against other occupants. Keep you from being thrown out of the vehicle. Help keep you in a good position should the airbags ever deploy. A good position reduces the risk of injury from an inflating airbag and allows you to get the best advantage from the airbag. Of course, seat belts cannot completely protect you in every crash. But in most cases, seat belts can reduce your risk of serious injury. What you should do: Always wear your seat belt, and make sure you wear it properly.
07/07/09 09:22:22 31STX610 0014
Your Vehicle sSafety Features Airbags
Your vehicle also has side airbags to help protect the upper torso of the driver or a front seat passenger during a moderate to severe side impact (see page 30 for more information on how your side airbags work).
In addition, your vehicle has side curtain airbags to help protect the heads of the driver, front passenger, and passengers in the outer rear seating positions during a moderate to severe side impact or rollover (see page 32 for more information on how your side curtain airbags work). CONTINUED
9
Driver and Passenger Safety
Your vehicle has a supplemental restraint system (SRS) with front airbags to help protect the heads and chests of the driver and a front seat passenger during a moderate to severe frontal collision (see page 27 for more information on how your front airbags work).
07/07/09 09:22:29 31STX610 0015
Your Vehicle sSafety Features The most important things you need to know about your airbags are: Airbags do not replace seat belts.
They are designed to supplement the seat belts. Airbags offer no protection in rear impacts, or minor frontal or side collisions. Airbags can pose serious hazards.
To do their job, airbags must inflate with tremendous force. So while airbags help save lives, they can cause minor injuries or more serious or even fatal injuries if occupants are not properly restrained or sitting properly.
10
What you should do: Always wear your seat belt properly, and sit upright and as far back from the steering wheel as possible while allowing full control of the vehicle. A front passenger should move their seat as far back from the dashboard as possible.
The rest of this section gives more detailed information about how you can maximize your safety. Remember, however, that no safety system can prevent all injuries or deaths that can occur in a severe crash, even when seat belts are properly worn and the airbags deploy.
07/07/09 09:22:37 31STX610 0016
Protecting Adults and Teens Your vehicle has a door and tailgate monitor on the multi-information display to indicate when a specific door or the tailgate is not tightly closed. You will see the appropriate indicator and the message for each condition.
See pages 37 − 41 for important guidelines on how to properly protect infants, small children, and larger children who ride in your vehicle.
Driver and Passenger Safety
Introduction The following pages provide instructions on how to properly protect the driver, adult passengers, and teenage children who are large enough and mature enough to drive or ride in the front.
When the tailgate is not tightly closed, the ‘‘TAILGATE OPEN’’ message will come on.
1. Close and Lock the Doors After everyone has entered the vehicle, be sure the doors and the tailgate are closed and locked. When one or more doors are not tightly closed, the ‘‘DOOR OPEN’’ message will come on.
CONTINUED
11
07/07/09 09:22:44 31STX610 0017
Protecting Adults and Teens Locking the doors reduces the chance of someone being thrown out of the vehicle during a crash, and it helps prevent passengers from accidentally opening a door and falling out.
2.Adjust the Front Seats
Locking the doors also helps prevent an outsider from unexpectedly opening a door when you come to a stop. When both tailgate and one or more doors are not tightly closed, the ‘‘DOOR & TAILGATE OPEN’’ message will come on.
12
Your vehicle has the auto door locking/unlocking feature. For more information, see page 130 .
Adjust the driver’s seat as far to the rear as possible while allowing you to maintain full control of the vehicle. Have a front passenger adjust their seat as far to the rear as possible.
07/07/09 09:22:52 31STX610 0018
Protecting Adults and Teens
The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration and Transport Canada recommend that drivers allow at least 10 inches (25 cm) between the center of the steering wheel and the chest. In addition to adjusting the seat, you can adjust the steering wheel up and down, and in and out (see page 124 ). If you cannot get far enough away from the steering wheel and still reach the controls, we recommend that you investigate whether some type of adaptive equipment may help.
3.Adjust the Seat-Backs Sitting too close to a front airbag can result in serious injury or death if the front airbags inflate.
Driver and Passenger Safety
If you sit too close to the steering wheel or dashboard, you can be seriously injured by an inflating front airbag, or by striking the steering wheel or dashboard.
Always sit as far back from the front airbags as possible. See page 140 for how to adjust the front seats. Adjust the driver’s seat-back to a comfortable, upright position, leaving ample space between your chest and the airbag cover in the center of the steering wheel. Passengers with adjustable seatbacks should also adjust their seatback to a comfortable, upright position. CONTINUED
13
07/07/09 09:23:00 31STX610 0019
Protecting Adults and Teens 4.Adjust the Head Restraints Improperly positioning head restraints reduces their effectiveness and you can be seriously injured in a crash.
Reclining the seat-back too far can result in serious injury or death in a crash. Adjust the seat-back to an upright position, and sit well back in the seat. Reclining a seat-back so that the shoulder part of the belt no longer rests against the occupant’s chest reduces the protective capability of the belt. It also increases the chance of sliding under the belt in a crash and being seriously injured. The farther a seat-back is reclined, the greater the risk of injury. See page 140 for how to adjust the seat-backs.
14
Make sure head restraints are in place and positioned properly before driving.
Adjust the driver’s head restraint so the center of the back of your head rests against the center of the restraint. Have passengers adjust their head restraints properly as well. Taller persons should adjust their restraint as high as possible.
Properly adjusted head restraints will help protect occupants from whiplash and other crash injuries. See page 141 for how to adjust the head restraints and how the driver’s and front passenger’s active head restraints work.
07/07/09 09:23:07 31STX610 0020
Protecting Adults and Teens
The second row center seat, and both third row seats, have a detachable shoulder belt that can be unlatched and retracted, to allow the seats to be folded down. See page 146 for how to unlatch and relatch the seat belts.
If necessary, pull up on the belt again to remove any slack, then check that the belt rests across the center of your chest and over your shoulder. This spreads the forces of a crash over the strongest bones in your upper body.
Position the lap part of the belt as low as possible across your hips, then pull up on the shoulder part of the belt so the lap part fits snugly. This lets your strong pelvic bones take the force of a crash and reduces the chance of internal injuries.
Improperly positioning the seat belts can cause serious injury or death in a crash. Make sure all seat belts are properly positioned before driving.
CONTINUED
15
Driver and Passenger Safety
5.Fasten and Position the Seat Belts Insert the latch plate into the buckle, then tug on the belt to make sure the belt is securely latched. Check that the belt is not twisted, because a twisted belt can cause serious injuries in a crash.
07/07/09 09:23:14 31STX610 0021
Protecting Adults and Teens If the seat belt touches or crosses your neck, or if it crosses your arm instead of your shoulder, you need to adjust the seat belt anchor height.
The front seats have adjustable seat belt anchors. To adjust the height of an anchor, squeeze the release button and slide the anchor up or down as needed (it has four positions).
Never place the shoulder portion of a lap/shoulder belt under your arm or behind your back. This could cause
very serious injuries in a crash.
If a seat belt does not seem to work properly, it may not protect the occupant in a crash. No one should sit in a seat with an inoperative seat belt. Using a seat
RELEASE BUTTON
belt that is not working properly can result in serious injury or death. Have your dealer check the belt as soon as possible. See page 20 for additional information about your seat belts and how to take care of them.
16
07/07/09 09:23:18 31STX610 0022
Protecting Adults and Teens In addition, an occupant who is out of position in the front seat can be seriously or fatally injured in a crash by striking interior parts of the vehicle or being struck by an inflating front airbag.
Sitting improperly or out of position can result in serious injury or death in a crash.
Driver and Passenger Safety
6.Maintain a Proper Sitting Position After all occupants have adjusted their seats and head restraints, and put on their seat belts, it is very important that they continue to sit upright, well back in their seats, with their feet on the floor, until the vehicle is parked and the engine is off.
Always sit upright, well back in the seat, with your feet on the floor.
Sitting improperly can increase the chance of injury during a crash. For example, if an occupant slouches, lies down, turns sideways, sits forward, leans forward or sideways, or puts one or both feet up, the chance of injury during a crash is greatly increased.
17
07/07/09 09:23:24 31STX610 0023
Protecting Adults and Teens Advice for Pregnant Women
If you are pregnant, the best way to protect yourself and your unborn child when driving or riding in a vehicle is to always wear a seat belt, and keep the lap part of the belt as low as possible across the hips.
18
When driving, remember to sit upright and adjust the seat as far back as possible while allowing full control of the vehicle. When riding as a front passenger, adjust the seat as far back as possible.
This will reduce the risk of injuries to both you and your unborn child that can be caused by a crash or an inflating front airbag. Each time you have a checkup, ask your doctor if it’s okay for you to drive.
07/07/09 09:23:32 31STX610 0024
Protecting Adults and Teens Additional Safety Precautions
could be very seriously injured in a crash. Passengers should not stand up or change seats while the vehicle is moving. A passenger who is not
wearing a seat belt during a crash or emergency stop can be thrown against the inside of the vehicle, against other occupants, or out of the vehicle.
Two people should never use the same seat belt. If they do, they
could be very seriously injured in a crash. Do not put any accessories on seat belts. Devices intended to improve
occupant comfort or reposition the shoulder part of a seat belt can reduce the protective capability of the belt and increase the chance of serious injury in a crash. Do not place hard or sharp objects between yourself and a front airbag. Carrying hard or sharp
objects on your lap, or driving with a pipe or other sharp object in your mouth, can result in injuries if your front airbag inflates.
Keep your hands and arms away from the airbag covers. If your
hands or arms are close to an airbag cover, they could be injured if the airbag inflates. Do not attach or place objects on the front airbag covers. Objects on
the covers marked ‘‘SRS AIRBAG’’ could interfere with the proper operation of the airbags or be propelled inside the vehicle and hurt someone if the airbags inflate. Do not attach hard objects on or near a door. If a side airbag or a
side curtain airbag inflates, a cup holder or other hard object attached on or near the door could be propelled inside the vehicle and hurt someone.
19
Driver and Passenger Safety
Never let passengers ride in the cargo area or on top of a foldeddown back seat. If they do, they
07/07/09 09:23:39 31STX610 0025
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts Seat Belt System Components Your seat belt system includes lap/ shoulder belts in all seven seating positions. The front seat belts are also equipped with automatic seat belt tensioners. This system uses the same sensors as the front airbags to monitor whether the front seat belts are latched or unlatched, and how much weight is on the front passenger’s seat (see pages 29 and 30 ).
The seat belt system includes an indicator on the instrument panel and a beeper to remind you and your passengers to fasten your seat belts.
If either the driver or a front passenger does not fasten their seat belt while driving, the beeper will sound and the indicator will flash again at regular intervals.
This system monitors the front seat belts. If you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position before your seat belt is fastened, the beeper will sound and the indicator will flash. If your seat belt is not fastened before the beeper stops, the indicator will stop flashing but remain on.
You will also see a ‘‘FASTEN SEAT BELT’’ or ‘‘FASTEN PASSENGER SEAT BELT’’ message on the multiinformation display (see page 81 ).
If a front passenger does not fasten their seat belt, the indicator will come on about 6 seconds after the ignition switch is turned to the ON (II) position.
20
When no one is sitting in the front passenger’s seat, or a child or small adult is riding there, the indicator should not come on and the beeper should not sound.
07/07/09 09:23:49 31STX610 0026
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
Any items under the front passenger’s seat. Any object(s) hanging on the seat or in the seat-back pocket. Any object(s) touching the rear of the seat-back. If no obstructions are found, have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Lap/Shoulder Belt The lap/shoulder belt goes over your shoulder, across your chest, and across your hips. To fasten the belt, insert the latch plate into the buckle, then tug on the belt to make sure the buckle is latched (see page 15 for how to properly position the belt). To unlock the belt, press the red PRESS button on the buckle. Guide the belt across your body so that it retracts completely. After exiting the vehicle, be sure the belt is out of the way and will not get closed in the door.
All seat belts have an emergency locking retractor. In normal driving, the retractor lets you move freely in your seat while it keeps some tension on the belt. During a collision or sudden stop, the retractor automatically locks the belt to help restrain your body. The seat belts in all positions except the driver’s have a lockable retractor that must be activated to secure a child seat (see page 50 ). If the shoulder part of the belt is pulled all the way out, the lockable retractor will activate. The belt will retract, but it will not allow the passenger to move freely. To deactivate the lockable retractor, unlatch the buckle and let the seat belt fully retract. To refasten the seat belt, pull it out only as far as needed.
CONTINUED
21
Driver and Passenger Safety
If the indicator comes on or the beeper sounds when the driver’s seat belt is latched and there is no front seat passenger and no items on the front seat, something may be interfering with the monitoring system. Look for and remove:
07/07/09 09:23:57 31STX610 0027
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners
The tensioners are designed to activate in any collision severe enough to cause the front airbags to deploy, or if a sensor detects your vehicle is about to roll over (see page 32 ). If a side airbag or side curtain airbag deploys during a side impact, the tensioner on that side of the vehicle will also deploy.
DETACHABLE ANCHOR
The lap/shoulder belts in the center seat of the second row and both of the third row seats are equipped with a detachable anchor that has two parts: a small latch plate and a buckle. The detachable seat belt should normally be latched whenever the seat-backs are in an upright position. For more information about the detachable seat belt, see page 144 .
22
For added protection, the front seat belts are equipped with automatic seat belt tensioners. When activated, the tensioners immediately tighten the belts to help hold the driver and a front passenger in position.
The tensioners can also be activated during a collision in which the front airbags do not deploy. In this case, the airbags would not be needed, but the additional restraint could be helpful. When the tensioners are activated, the seat belts will remain tight until they are unbuckled.
07/07/09 09:24:04 31STX610 0028
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts Seat Belt Maintenance For safety, you should check the condition of your seat belts regularly.
The dealer should also inspect the anchors for damage and replace them if needed. If the automatic seat belt tensioners activate during a crash, they must be replaced.
Not checking or maintaining seat belts can result in serious injury or death if the seat belts do not work properly when needed.
Driver and Passenger Safety
Pull each belt out fully, and look for frays, cuts, burns, and wear. Check that the latches work smoothly and the belts retract easily. If a belt does not retract easily, cleaning the belt may correct the problem (see page 409 ). Any belt that is not in good condition or working properly will not provide good protection and should be replaced as soon as possible.
If a seat belt is worn during a crash, it must be replaced by the dealer. A belt that has been worn during a crash may not provide the same level of protection in a subsequent crash.
Check your seat belts regularly and have any problem corrected as soon as possible.
Acura provides a limited warranty on seat belts. See your Acura Warranty Information booklet for details.
23
07/07/09 09:24:09 31STX610 0029
Additional Information About Your Airbags Airbag System Components
(1)
(6)
(11)
(8)
(5)
(2)
(4) (3) (1) Driver’s Front Airbag (2) Passenger’s Front Airbag (3) Control Unit (4) Front Seat Belt Tensioners (5) Side Airbags (6) Driver’s Seat Position Sensor (7) Front Passenger’s Weight Sensors (8) Passenger Airbag Off Indicator (9) Occupant Position Detection System (OPDS) Sensors (10) Front Passenger’s Weight Sensors/OPDS Sensors Control Unit (11) SRS Indicator
24
(5)
(10)
(9)
(7)
(4)
07/07/09 09:24:16 31STX610 0030
Additional Information About Your Airbags Your Airbag System (SRS) includes:
(17)
(16)
(13)
Two side airbags, one for the driver and one for a front passenger. The airbags are stored in the outer edges of the seatbacks. Both are marked ‘‘SIDE AIRBAG’’ (see page 30 ).
(15) (12) Front Impact Sensors (13) Side Curtain Airbags (14) Side Impact Sensors (First) (15) Side Impact Sensors (Second) (16) Roll Rate Sensor (17) Safing Sensor
(14)
Two side curtain airbags, one for each side of the vehicle. The airbags are stored in the roof above the side windows. The front and rear pillars are marked ‘‘SIDE CURTAIN AIRBAG’’ (see page 32 ). CONTINUED
25
Driver and Passenger Safety
(12)
Two SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) front airbags. The driver’s airbag is stored in the center of the steering wheel; the front passenger’s airbag is stored in the dashboard. Both are marked ‘‘SRS AIRBAG’’ (see page 27 ).
07/07/09 09:24:26 31STX610 0031
Additional Information About Your Airbags Automatic front seat belt tensioners (see page 22 ). Sensors that can detect a moderate to severe front impact, side impact, or if your vehicle is about to rollover. Sensors that can detect whether a child is in the passenger’s side airbag path and signal the control unit to turn the airbag off (see page 31 ). Sensors that can detect whether the driver’s seat belt and the front passenger’s seat belt are latched or unlatched (see page 20 ). A driver’s seat position sensor that monitors the distance of the seat from the front airbag. If the seat is too far forward, the airbag will inflate with less force (see page 29 ).
26
Weight sensors that monitor the weight on the front passenger’s seat. If the weight is about 65 lbs (29 kg) or less (the weight of an infant or small child), the passenger’s front airbag will be turned off (see page 29 ). A rollover sensor that can detect if your vehicle is about to roll over and signal the control unit to deploy both side curtain airbags and front seat belt tensioners (see page 32 ). A sophisticated electronic system that continually monitors and records information about the sensors, the control unit, the airbag activators, the seat belt tensioners, and driver and front passenger seat belt use when the ignition switch is in the ON (II) position.
An indicator on the instrument panel that alerts you to a possible problem with your airbags, sensors, or seat belt tensioners (see page 33 ). An indicator on the instrument panel that alerts you that the passenger’s side airbag has been turned off (see page 33 ). An indicator on the dashboard that alerts you that the passenger’s front airbag has been turned off (see page 34 ). Emergency backup power in case your vehicle’s electrical system is disconnected in a crash.
07/07/09 09:24:35 31STX610 0032
Additional Information About Your Airbags How Your Front Airbags Work
Although both airbags normally inflate within a split second of each other, it is possible for only one airbag to deploy.
If you ever have a moderate to severe frontal collision, sensors will detect the vehicle’s rapid deceleration.
This can happen if the severity of a collision is at the margin, or threshold, that determines whether or not the airbags will deploy. In such cases, the seat belt will provide sufficient protection, and the supplemental protection offered by the airbag would be minimal.
If the rate of deceleration is high enough, the control unit will instantly inflate the driver’s and front passenger’s airbags, at the time and with the force needed.
Only the driver’s airbag can deploy if there is no passenger in the front seat, or if the advanced airbag system has turned the passenger’s airbag off (see page 34 ).
After inflating, the front airbags immediately deflate, so they won’t interfere with the driver’s visibility, or the ability to steer or operate other controls.
CONTINUED
27
Driver and Passenger Safety
During a frontal crash, your seat belt restrains your lower body and torso, and the front airbag helps protect your head and chest.
07/07/09 09:24:43 31STX610 0033
Additional Information About Your Airbags The total time for inflation and deflation is one-tenth of a second, so fast that most occupants are not aware that the airbags deployed until they see them lying in their laps. After a crash, you may see what looks like smoke. This is actually powder from the airbag’s surface. Although the powder is not harmful, people with respiratory problems may experience some temporary discomfort. If this occurs, get out of the vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so.
28
Dual-Stage Airbags
Your front airbags are dual-stage airbags. This means they have two inflation stages that can be ignited sequentially or simultaneously, depending on crash severity. In a more severe crash, both stages will ignite simultaneously to provide the quickest and greatest protection. In a less severe crash, one stage will ignite first, then the second stage will ignite a split second later. This provides longer airbag inflation time with a little less force.
Dual-Threshold Airbags
Your front airbags are also dualthreshold airbags. Airbags with this feature have two deployment thresholds that depend on whether sensors detect the occupant is wearing a seat belt or not. If the occupant’s belt is not latched, the airbag will deploy at a slightly lower threshold, because the occupant would need extra protection. If the occupant’s belt is latched, the airbag will inflate at a slightly higher threshold, when the airbag would be needed to supplement the protection provided by the seat belt.
07/07/09 09:24:53 31STX610 0034
Additional Information About Your Airbags Advanced Airbags
For both advanced airbags to work properly: Occupants must sit upright and wear their seat belts properly. Do not spill any liquids on or under the seats, cover the sensors, or put any objects or metal items under the front seats. Second-row passengers should not put their feet under the front seats. Failure to follow these instructions could damage the sensors or prevent them from working properly.
DRIVER’S SEAT POSITION SENSOR
The driver’s advanced front airbag system includes a seat position sensor under the seat. If the seat is too far forward, the airbag will inflate with less force, regardless of the severity of the impact. If there is a problem with the sensor, the SRS indicator will come on, and the airbag will inflate in the normal manner regardless of the driver’s seating position.
PASSENGER’S SEAT WEIGHT SENSOR
The passenger’s advanced front airbag system has weight sensors under the seat. Although Acura does not encourage carrying an infant or small child in front, if the sensors detect the weight of an infant or small child (up to about 65 lbs or 29 kg), the system will automatically turn the passenger’s front airbag off.
CONTINUED
29
Driver and Passenger Safety
Your front airbags are also advanced airbags. The main purpose of this feature is to help prevent airbagcaused injuries to short drivers and children who ride in front.
07/07/09 09:25:02 31STX610 0035
Additional Information About Your Airbags Be aware that objects placed on the passenger’s seat can also cause the airbag to be turned off.
Moving the front seat forcibly back against cargo on the seat or floor behind it.
When the airbag is turned off, a ‘‘passenger airbag off’’ indicator in the center of the dashboard comes on (see page 34 ).
Hanging heavy items on the front passenger seat, or placing heavy items in the seat-back pocket.
If the weight sensors detect there is no passenger in the front seat, the airbag will be off. However, the passenger airbag off indicator will not come on. To ensure that the passenger’s advanced front airbag system will work properly, do not do anything
that would increase or decrease the weight on the front passenger sseat.
This includes:
A second-row passenger pushing or pulling on the back of the front passenger’s seat.
30
How Your Side Airbags Work
Moving the front passenger’s seat or seat-back forcibly back against the folded right-side second-row seat. Also, make sure the floor mat behind the front passenger’s seat is hooked to the floor mat anchor (see page 410 ). If it is not, the mat may interfere with the proper operation of the sensors and operation of the seat.
If you ever have a moderate to severe side impact, sensors will detect rapid acceleration and signal the control unit to instantly inflate either the driver’s or the passenger’s side airbag and activate the seat belt tensioner on the affected side.
07/07/09 09:25:10 31STX610 0036
Additional Information About Your Airbags
To get the best protection from the side airbags, front seat occupants should wear their seat belts and sit upright and well back in their seats.
Side Airbag Cutoff System
Your vehicle has a side airbag cutoff system designed primarily to protect a child riding in the front passenger’s seat. Although Acura does not encourage children to ride in front, if the position sensors detect a child has leaned into the side airbag’s deployment path, the airbag will shut off. The side airbag may also shut off if a short adult leans sideways, or a larger adult slouches and leans sideways into the airbag’s deployment path.
If the side airbag off indicator comes on (see page 33 ), have the passenger sit upright. Once the passenger is out of the airbag’s deployment path, the system will turn the airbag back on, and the indicator will go out. There will be some delay between the moment the passenger moves into or out of the airbag deployment path and when the indicator comes on or goes off. A front seat passenger should not use a cushion or other object as a backrest. It may prevent the cutoff system from working properly.
Objects placed on the front passenger seat can also cause the side airbag to be shut off.
31
Driver and Passenger Safety
Only one airbag will deploy during a side impact. If the impact is on the passenger’s side, the passenger’s side airbag will deploy even if there is no passenger.
07/07/09 09:25:18 31STX610 0037
Additional Information About Your Airbags How Your Side Curtain Airbags Work
If the impact is on the passenger’s side, the passenger’s side curtain airbag will inflate even if there are no occupants on that side of the vehicle.
In a Rollover
If the rollover sensor detects your vehicle is about to roll over, it signals the control unit, which immediately deploys both side curtain airbags and activates both front seat belt tensioners. The airbag on the passenger’s side will deploy, and the seat belt tensioner will activate, even if there are no passengers on that side of the vehicle.
In a Side Impact
In a moderate to severe side impact, sensors will detect rapid acceleration and signal the control unit to instantly inflate the side curtain airbag and activate the seat belt tensioner on the driver’s or the passenger’s side of the vehicle.
32
To get the best protection from the side curtain airbags, occupants should wear their seat belts and sit upright and well back in their seats.
07/07/09 09:25:30 31STX610 0038
Additional Information About Your Airbags
When you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, this indicator comes on briefly then goes off. This tells you the system is working properly. If the indicator comes on at any other time, or does not come on at all, you should have the system checked by your dealer. For example: If the SRS indicator does not come on after you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. If the indicator stays on after the engine starts.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK AIRBAG SYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page 81 ). If you see any of these indications, the airbags and seat belt tensioners may not work properly when you need them.
Ignoring the SRS indicator can result in serious injury or death if the airbag systems or tensioners do not work properly. Have your vehicle checked by a dealer as soon as possible if the SRS indicator alerts you to a possible problem.
How the Side Airbag Off Indicator Works U.S.
Canada
This indicator alerts you that the passenger’s side airbag has been automatically shut off. It does not mean there is a problem with your side airbags. When you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, the indicator should come on briefly and then go out (see page 66 ). If it does not come on, stays on, or comes on while driving without a passenger in the front seat, you will also see a ‘‘PASSENGER SIDE AIRBAG OFF’’ message on the multi-information display. Have the system checked (see page 81 ).
If the indicator comes on or flashes on and off while you drive.
33
Driver and Passenger Safety
How the SRS Indicator Works The SRS indicator alerts you to a potential problem with your airbags or seat belt tensioners.
07/07/09 09:25:39 31STX610 0039
Additional Information About Your Airbags How the Passenger Airbag Off Indicator Works PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF INDICATOR U.S. Canada
Be aware that objects placed on the front seat can cause the indicator to come on. If no weight is detected on the front seat, the airbag will be automatically shut off. However, the indicator will not come on. The passenger airbag off indicator may come on and off repeatedly if the total weight on the seat is near the airbag cutoff threshold.
This indicator alerts you that the passenger’s front airbag has been shut off because weight sensors detect about 65 lbs (29 kg) or less (the weight of an infant or small child) on the front passenger’s seat. It does not mean there is a problem with the airbag.
34
If an adult or teenage passenger is riding in front, move the seat as far to the rear as possible, and have the passenger sit upright and wear the seat belt properly.
If the indicator comes on with no front seat passenger and no objects on the seat, or with an adult riding there, something may be interfering with the weight sensors. Look for and remove: Any items under the front passenger’s seat. Any object(s) hanging on the seat or in the seat-back pocket. Any object(s), such as a foldeddown back seat, that are touching the rear of the seat-back. If no obstructions are found, have your vehicle checked by a dealer as soon as possible.
07/07/09 09:25:48 31STX610 0040
Additional Information About Your Airbags
An airbag ever inflates. Any airbag
that has deployed must be replaced along with the control unit and other related parts. Any seat belt tensioner that activates must also be replaced.
Do not try to remove or replace any airbag by yourself. This must be done by an authorized dealer or a knowledgeable body shop.
If your vehicle has a moderate to severe impact. Even if your
airbags do not inflate, your dealer should inspect the driver’s seat position sensor, the front passenger’s weight sensors, the front seat belt tensioners, and all seat belts worn during a crash to make sure they are operating properly.
Additional Safety Precautions
Do not attempt to deactivate your airbags. Together, airbags and
seat belts provide the best protection.
Do not tamper with airbag components or wiring for any reason. Tampering could cause
the airbags to deploy, possibly causing very serious injury.
Do not expose the front passenger s seat-back to liquid. If water or
another liquid soaks into a seatback, it can prevent the side airbag cutoff system from working properly.
The SRS indicator alerts you to a problem. Take your vehicle to an
authorized dealer as soon as possible. If you ignore this indication, your airbags may not operate properly.
CONTINUED
35
Driver and Passenger Safety
Airbag Service Your airbag systems are virtually maintenance free, and there are no parts you can safely service. However, you must have your vehicle serviced if:
07/07/09 09:25:52 31STX610 0041
Additional Information About Your Airbags Do not remove or modify a front seat without consulting your dealer. This could make the
driver’s seat position sensor or the front passenger’s weight sensors ineffective. If it is necessary to remove or modify a front seat to accommodate a person with disabilities, first contact Acura Client Services at 800-382-2238.
36
Do not cover or replace front seatback covers without consulting your dealer. Improperly replacing
or covering front seat-back covers can prevent your side airbags from inflating during a side impact.
07/07/09 09:26:00 31STX610 0042
Protecting Children − General Guidelines
Children depend on adults to protect them. However, despite their best intentions, many adults do not know how to properly protect child passengers. If you have children, or ever need to drive with a child in your vehicle, be sure to read this section. It begins with important general guidelines, then presents special information for infants, small children, and larger children.
To reduce the number of child deaths and injuries, every state and Canadian province requires that infants and children be properly restrained when they ride in a vehicle. Infants and small children must be restrained in an approved child seat that is properly secured to the vehicle (see pages 42 − 53 ).
Children who are unrestrained or improperly restrained can be seriously injured or killed in a crash. Any child too small for a seat belt should be properly restrained in a child seat. A larger child should be properly restrained with a seat belt and use a booster seat if necessary. Larger children must be restrained with a lap/shoulder belt and ride on a booster seat until the seat belt fits them properly (see pages 54 − 57 ).
37
Driver and Passenger Safety
All Children Must Be Restrained Each year, many children are injured or killed in vehicle crashes because they are either unrestrained or not properly restrained. In fact, vehicle accidents are the number one cause of the death of children ages 12 and under.
07/07/09 09:26:10 31STX610 0043
Protecting Children − General Guidelines All Children Should Sit in a Back Seat According to accident statistics, children of all ages and sizes are safer when they are restrained in a back seat. The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration and Transport Canada recommend that all children aged 12 and under be properly restrained in a back seat. Some states have laws restricting where children may ride. Children who ride in the back are less likely to be injured by striking interior vehicle parts during a collision or hard braking. Also, children cannot be injured by an inflating front airbag when they ride in the back.
38
The Passenger s Front Airbag Can Pose Serious Risks Front airbags have been designed to help protect adults in a moderate to severe frontal collision. To do this, the passenger’s front airbag is quite large, and it can inflate with enough force to cause very serious injuries. Even though your vehicle has an advanced front airbag system that automatically turns the passenger’s front airbag off (see page 34 ), please follow these guidelines: Infants Never put a rear-facing child seat in the front seat of a vehicle equipped with a passenger s front airbag. If
the airbag inflates, it can hit the back of the child seat with enough force to kill or very seriously injure an infant.
Small Children Placing a forward-facing child seat in the front seat of a vehicle equipped with a passenger s front airbag can be hazardous. If the vehicle seat is
too far forward, or the child’s head is thrown forward during a collision, an inflating front airbag can strike the child with enough force to kill or very seriously injure a small child. Larger Children Children who have outgrown child seats are also at risk of being injured or killed by an inflating passenger s front airbag. Whenever possible,
larger children should sit in the back seat, on a booster seat if needed, and be properly restrained with a seat belt. (See page 54 for important information about protecting larger children.)
07/07/09 09:26:23 31STX610 0044
Protecting Children − General Guidelines U.S. Models
DASHBOARD
SUN VISORS
Driver and Passenger Safety
To remind you of the passenger’s front airbag hazards, and that children must be properly restrained in a back seat, your vehicle has warning labels on the dashboard (U.S. models) and on the front visors. Please read and follow the instructions on these labels.
Canadian Models SUN VISORS
39
07/07/09 09:26:31 31STX610 0045
Protecting Children − General Guidelines If You Must Drive with Several Children Your vehicle has two rows of back seats where children can be properly restrained. If you ever have to carry a group of children, and a child must ride in front: Place the largest child in the front seat, provided the child is large enough to wear the lap/shoulder belt properly (see page 54 ). Move the vehicle seat as far to the rear as possible (see page 12 ). Have the child sit upright and well back in the seat (see page 17 ). Make sure the seat belt is properly positioned and secured (see page 15 ).
40
If a Child Requires Close Attention Many parents say they prefer to put an infant or a small child in the front passenger seat so they can watch the child, or because the child requires attention. Placing a child in the front seat exposes the child to hazards in a frontal collision, and paying close attention to a child distracts the driver from the important tasks of driving, placing both of you at risk.
If a child requires close physical attention or frequent visual contact, we strongly recommend that another adult ride with the child in a back seat. The back seat is far safer for a child than the front.
07/07/09 09:26:40 31STX610 0046
Protecting Children − General Guidelines Additional Safety Precautions
Never hold an infant or child on your lap. If you are not wearing a
seat belt in a crash, you could be thrown forward and crush the child against the dashboard or a seat-back. If you are wearing a seat belt, the child can be torn from your arms and be seriously hurt or killed.
seat belt around their neck, they can be seriously or fatally injured. (See pages 50 and 51 for how to activate and deactivate the lockable retractor.)
Never put a seat belt over yourself and a child. During a crash, the
Never let two children use the same seat belt. If they do, they
belt could press deep into the child and cause serious or fatal injuries.
could be very seriously injured in a crash.
Use the childproof door locks to prevent children from opening the rear doors. This can prevent
Do not leave children alone in a vehicle. Leaving children without
children from accidentally falling out (see page 131 ).
adult supervision is illegal in most states and Canadian provinces, and can be very hazardous.
For example, infants and small children left in a vehicle on a hot day can die from heatstroke. A child left alone with the key in the ignition switch can accidentally set the vehicle in motion, possibly injuring themselves or others. Lock all doors and the tailgate when your vehicle is not in use.
Children who play in vehicles can accidentally get trapped inside. Teach your children not to play in or around vehicles. Keep vehicle keys/remote transmitters out of the reach of children. Even very young
children learn how to unlock vehicle doors, turn on the ignition switch, and open the tailgate, which can lead to accidental injury or death.
41
Driver and Passenger Safety
Make sure any unused seat belt that a child can reach is buckled, the lockable retractor is activated, and the belt is fully retracted and locked. If a child wraps a loose
07/07/09 09:26:48 31STX610 0047
Protecting Infants and Small Children Protecting Infants
Two types of seats may be used: a seat designed exclusively for infants, or a convertible seat used in the rearfacing, reclining mode. Do not put a rear-facing child seat in a forward-facing position. If placed
facing forward, an infant could be very seriously injured during a frontal collision.
Child Seat Type
An infant must be properly restrained in a rear-facing, reclining child seat until the child reaches the seat maker’s weight or height limit for the seat, and the child is at least one year old. Only a rear-facing child seat provides proper support for a baby’s head, neck, and back.
42
Rear-facing Child Seat Placement
A rear-facing child seat can be placed in any seating position in the back seat, but not in the front. Never put a rear-facing child seat in the front seat.
If the passenger’s front airbag inflates, it can hit the back of the child seat with enough force to kill or seriously injure an infant. When properly installed in the second row, a rear-facing child seat may prevent the driver or a front passenger from moving their seat as far back as recommended, or from locking their seat-back in the desired position. It can also interfere with proper operation of the passenger’s advanced front airbag system.
07/07/09 09:26:56 31STX610 0048
Protecting Infants and Small Children
Placing a rear-facing child seat in the front seat can result in serious injury or death during a collision. Always place a rear-facing child seat in the back seat, not the front.
Protecting Small Children
We also recommend that a small child use the child seat until the child reaches the weight or height limit for the seat.
Child Seat Type
A child who is at least one year old, and who fits within the child seat maker’s weight and height limits, should be restrained in a forwardfacing, upright child seat. Of the different seats available, we recommend those that have a fivepoint harness system as shown. CONTINUED
43
Driver and Passenger Safety
In any of these situations, we strongly recommend that you install the child seat directly behind the front passenger’s seat, move the seat as far forward as needed, and leave it unoccupied. Or, you may wish to get a smaller rear-facing child seat.
07/07/09 09:27:02 31STX610 0049
Protecting Infants and Small Children Child Seat Placement
We strongly recommend placing a forward-facing child seat in a back seat, not the front. Placing a forward-facing child seat in the front seat of a vehicle equipped with a passenger s airbag can be hazardous. If the vehicle seat is too
far forward, or the child’s head is thrown forward during a collision, an inflating airbag can strike the child with enough force to cause very serious or fatal injuries.
44
Even with advanced front airbags that automatically turn the passenger’s front airbag off (see page 34 ), a back seat is the safest place for a small child. If it is necessary to put a forwardfacing child seat in the front, move the vehicle seat as far to the rear as possible, be sure the child seat is firmly secured to the vehicle and the child is properly strapped in the seat.
Placing a forward-facing child seat in the front seat can result in serious injury or death if the front airbag inflates. If you must place a forwardfacing child seat in front, move the vehicle seat as far back as possible, and properly restrain the child.
07/07/09 09:27:09 31STX610 0050
Selecting a Child Seat
Conventional child seats must be secured to a vehicle with a seat belt, whereas LATCH-compatible seats are secured by attaching the seat to hardware built into the second-row seats. Since LATCH-compatible child seats are easier to install and reduce the possibility of improper installation, we recommend selecting this style.
In seating positions and vehicles not equipped with LATCH, a LATCHcompatible child seat can be installed using a seat belt.
Whatever type of seat you choose, to provide proper protection, a child seat should meet three requirements: 1. The child seat should meet U.S. or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213. Look for FMVSS
213 or CMVSS 213 on the box.
2. The child seat should be of the proper type and size to fit the child.
Rear-facing for infants, forwardfacing for small children.
3. The child seat should fit the vehicle seating position (or positions) where it will be used.
Before purchasing a conventional child seat, or using a previously purchased one, we recommend that you test the seat in the specific vehicle seating position or positions where the seat will be used.
45
Driver and Passenger Safety
When buying a child seat, you need to choose either a conventional child seat, or one designed for use with the lower anchors and tethers for children (LATCH) system.
07/07/09 09:27:16 31STX610 0051
Installing a Child Seat After selecting a proper child seat and a good place to install the seat, there are three main steps in installing the seat: 1. Properly secure the child seat to the vehicle. All child seats must be
secured to the vehicle with the lap part of a lap/shoulder belt or with the LATCH (lower anchors and tethers for children) system. A child whose seat is not properly secured to the vehicle can be endangered in a crash.
2. Make sure the child seat is firmly secured. After installing a child
seat, push and pull the seat forward and from side-to-side to verify that it is secure.
46
A child seat secured with a seat belt should be installed as firmly as possible. However, it does not need to be ‘‘rock solid.’’ Some side-to-side movement can be expected and should not reduce the child seat’s effectiveness. If the child seat is not secure, try installing it in a different seating position, or use a different style of child seat that can be firmly secured. 3. Secure the child in the child seat.
Make sure the child is properly strapped in the child seat according to the child seat maker’s instructions. A child who is not properly secured in a child seat can be seriously injured in a crash.
The following pages provide guidelines on how to properly install a child seat. A forward-facing child seat is used in all examples, but the instructions are the same for a rearfacing child seat.
07/07/09 09:27:26 31STX610 0052
Installing a Child Seat
The lower anchors are located between the seat-back and seat bottom, and are to be used only with a child seat designed for use with LATCH. The location of each lower anchor is indicated by a small button above the anchor point.
MARKS
Using the Outer LATCH
LOWER ANCHORS
When you install a child seat in rear seating position, use the lower anchors as shown in the illustration. You can install up to three child seats at a time with LATCH. Do not attach two child seat connectors to a single lower anchor at a time.
To install a LATCH-compatible child seat in either outer second row seat: 1. Move the seat belt buckle or tongue away from the lower anchors. 2. Make sure there are no objects near the anchors that could prevent a secure connection between the child seat and the CONTINUED anchors.
47
Driver and Passenger Safety
Installing a Child Seat with LATCH Your vehicle is equipped with LATCH (lower anchors and tethers for children) at each of the second row seats.
07/07/09 09:27:34 31STX610 0053
Installing a Child Seat
RIGID TYPE
3. Place the child seat on the vehicle seat, then attach the seat to the lower anchors according to the child seat maker’s instructions. Some LATCH-compatible seats have a rigid-type connector as shown above.
48
FLEXIBLE TYPE
Other LATCH-compatible seats have a flexible-type connector as shown above. 4. Whatever type you have, follow the child seat maker’s instructions for adjusting or tightening the fit.
TETHER STRAP
5. Lift the head restraint (see page 141 ), then route the tether strap through the legs of the head restraint and over the seat-back, making sure the strap is not twisted.
07/07/09 09:27:42 31STX610 0054
Installing a Child Seat Using the Center LATCH
2. Follow step 1 through 4 as described previously to secure the child seat.
6. Attach the tether strap hook to the tether anchor, then tighten the strap as instructed by the child seat maker.
To install a LATCH-compatible child seat in the center seating position on the second row seat, use the center lower anchors as shown above.
7. Push and pull the child seat forward and from side-to-side to verify that it is secure.
1. Pull up the cover below the armrest and find one of the anchors. The other anchor is located underneath the flap at the bottom of the outer seat’s inner bolster.
4. Push and pull the child seat forward and from side-to-side to verify that it is secure.
49
Driver and Passenger Safety
3. Lower the head restraint first. Route the tether strap over the head restraint and seat-back, then attach the tether strap hook to the anchor, making sure the strap is not twisted.
07/07/09 09:27:50 31STX610 0055
Installing a Child Seat Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/ Shoulder Belt When not using the LATCH system, all child seats must be secured to the vehicle with the lap part of a lap/ shoulder belt. In addition, the lap/shoulder belts in all seating positions except the driver’s have a lockable retractor that must be activated to secure a child seat. If you intend to install a child seat in the center seating position of second row seat, make sure the detachable seat belt is securely latched (see page146 ).
50
1. With the child seat in the desired seating position, route the belt through the child seat according to the seat maker’s instructions, then insert the latch plate into the buckle.
2. To activate the lockable retractor, slowly pull the shoulder part of the belt all the way out until it stops, then let the belt feed back into the retractor. 3. After the belt has retracted, tug on it. If the belt is locked, you will not be able to pull it out. If you can pull the belt out, it is not locked, and you will need to repeat these steps.
07/07/09 09:27:58 31STX610 0056
Installing a Child Seat
Since a tether can provide additional security to the lap/shoulder belt installation, we recommend using a tether whenever one is required or available. 4. After confirming that the belt is locked, grab the shoulder part of the belt near the buckle, and pull up to remove any slack from the lap part of the belt. Remember, if the lap part of the belt is not tight, the child seat will not be secure. To remove slack, it may help to put weight on the child seat, or push on the back of the seat while pulling up on the belt.
5. Push and pull the child seat forward and from side-to-side to verify that it is secure enough to stay upright during normal driving maneuvers. If the child seat is not secure, unlatch the belt, allow it to retract fully, then repeat these steps. To deactivate the lockable retractor and remove a child seat, unlatch the buckle, unroute the seat belt, and let the belt fully retract.
CONTINUED
51
Driver and Passenger Safety
Installing a Child Seat with a Tether A child seat with a tether can be installed in any seating position in the second or third row.
07/07/09 09:28:06 31STX610 0057
Installing a Child Seat Second Row Installation TETHER STRAP
TETHER ANCHORAGE POINT
Each second row seat has a tether anchorage point behind the seatback.
52
Outer Seating Position
1. After properly securing the child seat (see page 50 ), lift the head restraint, then route the tether strap over the seat-back and through the head restraint legs.
For the center seat, lower the head restraint, then route the tether strap over the head restraint and seat-back.
07/07/09 09:28:15 31STX610 0058
Installing a Child Seat Third Row Installation
3. Tighten the strap according to the seat maker’s instructions.
Each third row seat has a tether anchorage point on the tailgate sill. 1. Select the anchor point you want to use. Then open the anchor cover with a small flat-tip screwdriver. 2. Secure the child seat in the desired position (see page 50 ).
Driver and Passenger Safety
2. Attach the tether strap hook to the anchor, making sure the tether strap is not twisted.
3. Route the tether strap over the head restraint, then attach the tether strap hook to the anchor, making sure the strap is not twisted. 4. Tighten the strap according to the seat maker’s instructions.
53
07/07/09 09:28:22 31STX610 0059
Protecting Larger Children Checking Seat Belt Fit
When a child reaches the recommended weight or height limit for a forward-facing child seat, the child should sit in a back seat on a booster seat and wear a lap/shoulder belt.
Allowing a child age 12 or under to sit in front can result in injury or death if the passenger’s front airbag inflates.
The following pages give instructions on how to check proper seat belt fit, what kind of booster seat to use if one is needed, and important precautions for a child who must sit in front.
If a child must ride in front, move the vehicle seat as far back as possible, use a booster seat if needed, have the child sit up properly and wear the seat belt properly. To determine if a lap/shoulder belt properly fits a child, have the child put on the seat belt, then ask yourself: 1. Does the child sit all the way back against the seat? 2. Do the child’s knees bend comfortably over the edge of the seat?
54
07/07/09 09:28:30 31STX610 0060
Protecting Larger Children 3. Does the shoulder belt cross between the child’s neck and arm?
Using a Booster Seat
5. Will the child be able to stay seated like this for the whole trip? If you answer yes to all these questions, the child is ready to wear the lap/shoulder belt correctly. If you answer no to any question, the child needs to ride on a booster seat.
A child who has outgrown a forwardfacing child seat should ride in a back seat and use a booster seat until the lap/shoulder belt fits them properly without the booster.
Booster seats can be high-back or low-back. Whichever style you select, make sure the booster seat meets federal safety standards (see page 45 ) and that you follow the booster seat maker’s instructions.
CONTINUED
55
Driver and Passenger Safety
4. Is the lap part of the belt as low as possible, touching the child’s thighs?
Some states and Canadian provinces also require children to use a booster seat until they reach a given age or weight (e.g., 6 years or 60 lbs). Be sure to check current laws in the states or provinces where you intend to drive.
07/07/09 09:28:39 31STX610 0061
Protecting Larger Children If a child who uses a booster seat must ride in front, move the vehicle seat as far back as possible and be sure the child is wearing the seat belt properly. A child may continue using a booster seat until the tops of their ears are even with the top of the vehicle’s or booster’s seat-back. A child of this height should be tall enough to use the lap/shoulder belt without a booster seat.
When Can a Larger Child Sit in Front The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration and Transport Canada recommend that all children age 12 and under be properly restrained in a back seat. If the passenger’s front airbag inflates in a moderate to severe frontal collision, the airbag can cause serious injuries to a child who is unrestrained, improperly restrained, sitting too close to the airbag, or out of position. A side airbag also poses risks. If any part of a larger child’s body is in the path of a deploying side airbag, the child could receive possibly serious injuries.
56
Of course, children vary widely. And while age may be one indicator of when a child can safely ride in front, there are other important factors you should consider. Physical Size
Physically, a child must be large enough for the lap/shoulder belt to properly fit (see pages 15 and 54 ). If the seat belt does not fit properly, with or without the child sitting on a booster seat, the child should not sit in front. Maturity
To safely ride in front, a child must be able to follow the rules, including sitting properly, and wearing the seat belt properly throughout a ride.
07/07/09 09:28:48 31STX610 0062
Protecting Larger Children If you decide that a child can safely ride up front, be sure to:
Move the vehicle seat to the rearmost position.
Do not let a child wear a seat belt across the neck. This could result
in serious neck injuries during a crash.
Do not let a child put the shoulder part of a seat belt behind the back or under the arm. This could
Have the child sit up straight, back against the seat, and feet on or near the floor.
cause very serious injuries during a crash. It also increases the chance that the child will slide under the belt in a crash and be injured.
Check that the child’s seat belt is properly and securely positioned.
Two children should never use the same seat belt. If they do, they
Supervise the child. Even mature children sometimes need to be reminded to fasten the seat belts or sit properly.
Do not put any accessories on a seat belt. Devices intended to
improve a child’s comfort or reposition the shoulder part of a seat belt can make the belt less effective and increase the chance of serious injury in a crash.
could be very seriously injured in a crash.
57
Driver and Passenger Safety
Carefully read the owner’s manual, and make sure you understand all seat belt instructions and all safety information.
Additional Safety Precautions
07/07/09 09:28:56 31STX610 0063
Carbon Monoxide Hazard Your vehicle’s exhaust contains carbon monoxide gas. Carbon monoxide should not enter the vehicle in normal driving if you maintain your vehicle properly and follow the information on this page. Have the exhaust system inspected for leaks whenever: The vehicle is raised for an oil change. You notice a change in the sound of the exhaust. The vehicle was in an accident that may have damaged the underside.
58
Carbon monoxide gas is toxic. Breathing it can cause unconsciousness and even kill you. Avoid any enclosed areas or activities that expose you to carbon monoxide. High levels of carbon monoxide can collect rapidly in enclosed areas, such as a garage. Do not run the engine with the garage door closed. Even with the door open, run the engine only long enough to move the vehicle out of the garage.
With the tailgate open, airflow can pull exhaust gas into your vehicle’s interior and create a hazardous condition. If you must drive with the tailgate open, open all the windows, and set the climate control system as shown below. If you must sit in your parked vehicle with the engine running, even in an unconfined area, adjust the climate control system as follows: 1. Select the fresh air mode. mode. 2. Select the 3. Turn the fan on high speed. 4. Set the temperature control to a comfortable setting.
07/07/09 09:29:07 31STX610 0064
Safety Labels These labels are in the locations shown. They warn you of potential hazards that could cause serious injury or death. Read these labels carefully.
DASHBOARD U.S. models only
Driver and Passenger Safety
If a label comes off or becomes hard to read (except for the U.S. dashboard label which may be removed by the owner), contact your dealer for a replacement.
HOOD
RADIATOR CAP
BATTERY LABEL
CONTINUED
59
07/07/09 09:29:24 31STX610 0065
Safety Labels SUN VISOR U.S. models
Canadian models
U.S. models
60
DOORJAMBS U.S. models
Canadian models
07/07/09 09:29:28 31STX610 0066
Instruments and Controls This section gives information about the controls and displays that contribute to the daily operation of your vehicle. All the essential controls are within easy reach.
Seat Heaters ................................... 148 Power Windows ............................. 149 Moonroof ........................................ 152 Parking Brake ................................ 153 Mirrors ............................................ 154 Driving Position Memory System......................................... 157 Interior Lights ................................ 159 Interior Convenience Items .......... 162 Beverage Holders ...................... 163 Console Compartment .............. 164 Storage Compartment ............... 164 Glove Box ................................... 164 Sunglasses Holder ..................... 165 Cargo Hooks .............................. 165 Sun Visor .................................... 166 Vanity Mirror ............................. 166 Accessory Power Sockets......... 166 AC Power Outlet ........................ 167
61
Instruments and Controls
Control Locations ............................ 62 Instrument Panel ............................. 63 Instrument Panel Indicators ........... 64 Gauges .............................................. 72 Multi-Information Display .............. 73 Controls Near the Steering Wheel .......................................... 115 Windshield Wipers and Washers .................................. 116 Rear Window Wiper and Washer .................................... 117 Turn Signal and Headlights.......... 118 Hazard Warning Button ................ 122 Rear Window Defogger ................ 122 Instrument Panel Brightness ....... 123 Steering Wheel Adjustments ....... 124 Keys and Locks.............................. 126 Immobilizer System....................... 128 Ignition Switch ............................... 129 Door Locks ..................................... 130 Childproof Door Locks ............. 131 Tailgate ........................................... 131 Power Tailgate ........................... 132 Remote Transmitter ...................... 135 Seats ................................................ 140 Detachable Anchor.................... 146
07/07/09 09:29:36 31STX610 0067
Control Locations
DRIVING POSITION MEMORY SYSTEM (P.157)
INSTRUMENT PANEL INDICATORS (P.63) GAUGES (P.72)
HomeLink BUTTONS (P.276)
MOONROOF SWITCH (P.152) MIRROR CONTROL AUTO BUTTON* (P.154)
POWER DOOR LOCK MASTER SWITCH (P.130)
CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM (P.170)
PARKING BRAKE RELEASE HANDLE (P.153)
AUDIO SYSTEM (P.180)
POWER WINDOW SWITCHES (P.149)
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION (P.341)
FUEL FILL DOOR RELEASE BUTTON (P.323)
REAR CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM (P.175)
POWER TAILGATE BUTTON* (P.132) HOOD RELEASE HANDLE (P.325)
*: If equipped
62
PARKING BRAKE PEDAL (P.153)
AUXILIARY INPUT JACKS* (P.267)
HEADPHONE CONNECTORS* (P.268)
07/07/09 09:29:46 31STX610 0068
Instrument Panel
SIDE AIRBAG OFF INDICATOR (P.66)
ANTI-LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM INDICATOR (P.66) MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP (P.437) SH-AWD®
(P.69)
LOW TIRE PRESSURE INDICATOR (P.68) LOW FUEL INDICATOR (P.71) CRUISE CONTROL INDICATOR (P.70)
INDICATOR
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM INDICATOR (P.70) CHARGING SYSTEM INDICATOR (P.65) A/T TEMPERATURE INDICATOR (P.68) LOW OIL PRESSURE INDICATOR (P.65) FOG LIGHT INDICATOR (P.70)
CRUISE MAIN INDICATOR (P.70) SECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR (P.71) PARKING BRAKE AND BRAKE SYSTEM INDICATOR (P.65) VEHICLE STABILITY ASSIST (VSA) SYSTEM INDICATOR (P.67) VSA ACTIVATION INDICATOR (P.67)
* : If equipped The U.S. instrument panel is shown. Differences for the Canadian models are noted in the text.
63
Instruments and Controls
MESSAGE INDICATOR MULTI-INFORMATION DISPLAY (P.73) (P.69) SEAT BELT REMINDER INDICATOR (P.64) HIGH BEAM INDICATOR LIGHTS ON INDICATOR (P.70) (P.70) ACTIVE DAMPER SYSTEM SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT INDICATOR* (P.71) SYSTEM INDICATOR (P.66)
07/07/09 09:29:52 31STX610 0069
Instrument Panel Indicators The instrument panel has many indicators to give you important information about your vehicle.
Seat Belt Reminder Indicator This indicator comes on when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. It reminds you and your passengers to fasten your seat belts. A beeper also sounds if you have not fastened your seat belt.
If either of you do not fasten your seat belt while driving, the beeper will sound and the indicator will flash again at regular intervals, and you will also see a ‘‘FASTEN SEAT BELT’’ or ‘‘FASTEN PASSENGER SEAT BELT’’ message on the multiinformation display (see page 81 ).
If you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position before fastening your seat belts, the beeper sounds, and the indicator flashes. If you do not fasten your seat belts before the beeper stops, the indicator stops flashing but remains on.
For more information, see page 20 .
If your front passenger does not fasten their seat belt, the indicator comes on about 6 seconds after the ignition switch is turned to the ON (II) position.
64
07/07/09 09:30:02 31STX610 0070
Instrument Panel Indicators
Charging System Indicator If this indicator comes on when the engine is running, the battery is not being charged, and you will also see a ‘‘CHECK CHARGING SYSTEM’’ message on the multiinformation display. For more information, see page 436 . Malfunction Indicator Lamp You will also see a ‘‘CHECK EMISSION SYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display. For more information, see page 437 .
Parking Brake and Brake System Indicator This indicator has two functions: U.S.
Canada
1. It comes on when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. It is a reminder to check the parking brake. Driving with the parking brake not fully released can damage the rear brakes, axles, and tires.
2. If it stays on after you have fully released the parking brake while the engine is running, or if it comes on while driving, it can indicate a problem in the brake system. You will also see a ‘‘LOW BRAKE FLUID’’ or ‘‘CHECK BRAKE SYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see pages 81 ). For more information, see page 438 .
If you drive without releasing the parking brake, a beeper will sound, and you will also see a ‘‘RELEASE PARKING BRAKE’’ message on the multi-information display (see page 81 ).
65
Instruments and Controls
Low Oil Pressure Indicator The engine can be severely damaged if this indicator flashes or stays on when the engine is running, or if a ‘‘CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL’’ message is on the multi-information display. For more information, see page 436 .
07/07/09 09:30:10 31STX610 0071
Instrument Panel Indicators Supplemental Restraint System Indicator This indicator comes on briefly when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. If it comes on at any other time, it indicates a potential problem with your front airbags. This indicator will also alert you to a potential problem with your side airbags, passenger’s side airbag automatic cutoff system, side curtain airbags, or automatic seat belt tensioners. You will also see a ‘‘CHECK AIRBAG SYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page 81 ). For more information, see page 33 .
66
U.S.
Canada
Side Airbag Off Indicator This indicator comes on when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. If it comes on at any other time, it indicates that the passenger’s side airbag has automatically shut off. You will also see a ‘‘PASSENGER SIDE AIRBAG OFF’’ message on the multiinformation display (see page 81 ). For more information, see page 33 .
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) Indicator This indicator normally comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. If this indicator comes on at any other time, there is a problem in the ABS. If this happens, take the vehicle to your dealer to have it checked. With this indicator on, your vehicle still has normal braking ability but no anti-lock function. You will also see a ‘‘CHECK ABS SYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page 81 ). For more information, see page 357 .
07/07/09 09:30:23 31STX610 0072
Instrument Panel Indicators
If it comes on and stays on at any other time, or it does not come on when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, there is a problem with the VSA system. You will also see a ‘‘CHECK VSA SYSTEM’’ message on the multiinformation display (see page 81 ). Take your vehicle to a dealer to have it checked. Without VSA, your vehicle still has normal driving ability, but will not have VSA traction and stability enhancement. For more information, see page 359 . This indicator may also come on if there is a problem with the trailer stability assist function (see page 375 ).
VSA Activation Indicator
information display (see page 81 ).
This indicator normally comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. For more information, see page 359 . This indicator has four functions.
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Indicators The left or right turn signal indicator blinks when you signal a lane change or turn. If an indicator does not blink or blinks rapidly, it usually means one of the turn signal bulbs is burned out (see page 404 ). Replace the bulb as soon as possible, since other drivers cannot see that you are signaling.
1. It comes on as a reminder that you have turned off the vehicle stability assist (VSA) system. 2. It flashes when VSA is active (see page 359 ). 3. It flashes when trailer stability assist is activating (see page 375 ). 4. It comes on along with the VSA system indicator if there is a problem with the VSA system. You will also see a ‘‘CHECK VSA SYSTEM’’ message and a ‘‘CHECK TRAILER STABILITY ASSIST’’ message on the multi-
When you press the hazard warning button, both turn signal indicators and all turn signals on the outside of the vehicle flash.
67
Instruments and Controls
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System Indicator This indicator normally comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position.
07/07/09 09:30:33 31STX610 0073
Instrument Panel Indicators Low Tire Pressure/ TPMS Indicator This indicator normally comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. This indicator has two functions: 1. If it comes on while driving, it indicates that one or more of your vehicle’s tires are significantly low on pressure. You will also see a ‘‘CHECK TIRE PRESSURE’’ message on the multiinformation display (see page 82 ). Check the tire pressure monitor on the multi-information display and determine the cause (see page 352 ).
68
If this happens, pull to the side of the road when it is safe, check which tire has lost pressure on the multi-information display, and determine the cause. If it is because of a flat tire, have the flat tire repaired as soon as possible. If two or more tires are underinflated, call a professional towing service. For more information, see page 446 . 2. If this indicator begins to flash, there is a problem with the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS). You will also see a ‘‘CHECK TPMS SYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display. The indicator continues to flash for a while (approximately 1 minute), then stays on. If this happens, have your dealer check the system as soon as possible. For more information, see page 354 .
A/T Temperature Indicator This indicator monitors the temperature of the automatic transmission fluid. It should come on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. If it comes on while driving, it means the transmission fluid temperature is too high. Pull to the side of the road when it is safe, shift to Park, and let the engine idle until the indicator goes out. You will also see an ‘‘A/T TEMP HIGH’’ message on the multiinformation display (see page 82 ).
Continuing to drive with the A/T temperature indicator on may cause serious damage to the transmission.
07/07/09 09:30:42 31STX610 0074
Instrument Panel Indicators Message Indicator
Most of the time, this indicator comes on along with other indicators in the instrument panel such as the seat belt reminder indicator, SRS indicator, VSA system indicator, etc.
If the indicator blinks while driving, it indicates the differential temperature is too high. You will also see a ‘‘SH-AWD® DIFF TEMP. HIGH’’ message on the multi-information display (see page 82 ). Pull to the side of the road when it is safe, shift to Park, and let the engine idle until the indicator goes out.
Continuing to drive with the SH-AWD® indicator blinking may cause serious damage to the system.
69
Instruments and Controls
This indicator comes on when there is a system message on the multiinformation display. Press the INFO button on the steering wheel (see page 73 ) to see the message (see page 81 ).
Super Handling-All Wheel Drive (SH-AWD ®) Indicator This indicator normally comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. If this indicator comes on at any other time, there is a problem in the SH-AWD® system. You will also see a ‘‘CHECK SH-AWD® SYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page 82 ). Take your vehicle to a dealer to have it checked. For more information, see page 348 .
07/07/09 09:30:52 31STX610 0075
Instrument Panel Indicators Immobilizer System Indicator This indicator comes on briefly when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. It will then go off if you have inserted a properly-coded ignition key. If it is not a properlycoded key, the indicator will blink, and the engine’s fuel system will be disabled (see page128).
Lights On Indicator This indicator reminds you that the exterior lights are on. It comes on when the light switch is in either the or position. This indicator will also come on when the light switch is in AUTO and the lights turn on automatically. If you turn the ignition switch to the ACCESSORY (I) or the LOCK (0) position without turning off the light switch, this indicator will remain on. A reminder chime will also sound when you open the driver’s door. Fog Light Indicator This indicator comes on when you turn on the fog lights. For more information, see page 120 .
70
High Beam Indicator This indicator comes on with the high beam headlights. For more information, see page 118 . Cruise Main Indicator This indicator comes on when you turn on the cruise control system by pressing the CRUISE button (see page 270 ). Cruise Control Indicator This indicator comes on when you set the cruise control. See page 270 for information on operating the cruise control.
07/07/09 09:31:01 31STX610 0076
Instrument Panel Indicators Low Fuel Indicator
LOW FUEL INDICATOR
This indicator comes on as a reminder that you must refuel soon. When the indicator comes on, there is about 1.8 US gal (7.0 ) of fuel remaining in the tank before the needle reaches E. There is a small reserve of fuel remaining in the tank when the needle reaches E. You will also see a ‘‘LOW FUEL’’ message on the multi-information display (see page 82 ).
Security System Indicator
Instruments and Controls
Active Damper System Indicator This indicator normally comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. If this indicator comes on at any other time, there is a problem in the system. While this indicator is on, the comfort button will not work, and the system will remain in the sport mode. You will also see a ‘‘CHECK ADS SYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display. Have the vehicle checked by your dealer as soon as possible. For more information, see page 361 .
SECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR
This indicator comes on when the security system is set. See page 269 for more information on the security system.
71
07/07/09 09:31:08 31STX610 0077
Gauges
TACHOMETER TEMPERATURE GAUGE
SPEEDOMETER FUEL GAUGE
Fuel Gauge This shows how much fuel you have. It may show slightly more or less than the actual amount.
Avoid driving with an extremely low f uel level. Running out of f uel could cause the engine to misf ire, damaging the catalytic converter.
U.S. model is shown.
Temperature Gauge This shows the temperature of the engine’s coolant. During normal operation, the pointer should rise to about the middle of the gauge. In severe driving conditions, the pointer may rise to the upper zone. If it reaches the red (hot) mark, pull safely to the side of the road. For
72
instructions and precautions on checking the engine’s cooling system, see page 434 .
07/07/09 09:31:16 31STX610 0078
Multi-Information Display
When you open the driver’s door, a ‘‘Welcome’’ message is shown on the multi-information display. When you turn the ignition switch from the ON (II) position to the ACCESSORY (I) position, a ‘‘Goodbye’’ message is shown on the display.
With the ignition switch in the ON (II) position, the multi-information display changes as shown in the next page each time you press the INFO (▲/▼) button or SEL/RESET button.
INFO (▲/▼) BUTTON
SEL/ RESET BUTTON
To change the display, press the INFO (▲/▼) button on the steering wheel repeatedly until the main menu appears (see page 74 ).
When you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, what you last selected is displayed. In the multi-information display, the system message is also displayed (see page 80 ) and you can customize your vehicle control settings (see page 83 ).
CONTINUED
73
Instruments and Controls
The multi-information display in the instrument panel displays various information and messages when the ignition switch is in the ON (II) position. Some of the messages help you operate your vehicle more comfortably. Others help to keep you aware of the periodic maintenance your vehicle needs for continued trouble-free driving.
07/07/09 09:31:21 31STX610 0079
Multi-Information Display Main Menu Go to Customize Menu (See page 83)
INFO button SEL/RESET button
Go to HandsFreeLink Menu (See page 280)
(See page 75)
Trip Computer (See page 78)
(See page 75)
(See page 75)
Tire Pressure for each tire (See page 77)
74
07/07/09 09:31:31 31STX610 0080
Multi-Information Display Odometer
Trip Meter TRIP METER
ODOMETER
The odometer shows the total distance your vehicle has been driven. It measures miles in U.S. models and kilometers in Canadian models. It is illegal under U.S. federal law and Canadian provincial regulations to disconnect, reset, or alter the odometer with the intent to change the number of miles or kilometers indicated.
This meter shows the number of miles (U.S.) or kilometers (Canada) driven since you last reset it. There are two trip meters: Trip A and Trip B. Each trip meter works independently, so you can keep track of two different distances. To reset a trip meter, display it, and then press and hold the SEL/RESET button until the number resets to CONTINUED ‘‘0.0.’’
75
Instruments and Controls
When the main menu is blank, SH-AWD® or TIRE PRESSURE, pressing the SEL/RESET button changes the display to ‘‘trip meter/ odometer’’ ‘‘outside temperature/ odometer’’ and ‘‘engine oil life/ odometer’’.
07/07/09 09:31:38 31STX610 0081
Multi-Information Display When you reset Trip A, average fuel economy A is reset at the same time. When you reset Trip B, average fuel economy B is reset. In the customizing mode, you can set Trip A and average fuel economy A to reset at the same time when you refuel your vehicle (see page 92 ).
Outside Temperature OUTSIDE TEMPERATURE U.S.
CANADA
This shows the outside Fahrenheit temperature in U.S. models, and Centigrade temperature in Canadian models.
76
The temperature sensor is in the front bumper. The temperature reading can be affected by heat reflection from the road surface, engine heat, and the exhaust from surrounding traffic. This can cause an incorrect temperature reading when your vehicle speed is under 19 mph (30 km/h). When you start your trip, the sensor is not fully acclimatized, therefore it may take several minutes until the proper temperature is displayed. In certain weather conditions, temperature readings near freezing (32°F, 0°C) could mean that ice is forming on the road surface. You can adjust the outside temperature display (see page 91 ).
07/07/09 09:31:46 31STX610 0082
Multi-Information Display Engine Oil Life
SH-AWD® Torque Distribution Monitor
Tire Pressure Monitor
ENGINE OIL LIFE
Canada
This shows the remaining life of the engine oil. It shows 100% after the engine oil is replaced and the display is reset. The engine oil life is calculated based on engine operating conditions and accumulated engine revolutions. For more information, see page 383 .
This monitor shows how much torque is being delivered to each wheel. For more information, see page 348 .
When the tire pressure monitor is shown on the multi-information display, press the SEL/RESET button. The display changes as shown. You can see the pressure of each tire in this monitor. If one or more tires are low, inflate them to the correct pressure. For more information, see page 351 .
77
Instruments and Controls
U.S.
07/07/09 09:31:53 31STX610 0083
Multi-Information Display HandsFreeLinkTM
You can receive or make phone calls from your cell phone through your vehicle’s Bluetooth HandsFreeLink (HFL) system without touching your cell phone.
78
To use the system, your cell phone and the HFL system must be linked. Not all cell phones are compatible with this system. Refer to page 280 for instructions on how to link your cell phone to the HFL and how to receive or make phone calls, or visit the handsfreelink.com website.
Trip Computer
When the main menu displays ‘‘TRIP COMPUTER’’, pressing the SEL/ RESET button changes the display to ‘‘AVERAGE FUEL A/RANGE’’ to ‘‘AVERAGE FUEL B/RANGE’’ and to ‘‘AVERAGE SPEED/ELAPSED TIME’’.
07/07/09 09:32:02 31STX610 0084
Multi-Information Display AVERAGE FUEL A/B
You can customize the Trip A and AVERAGE FUEL A reset condition in the multi-information display (see page 92 ).
RANGE
This shows the estimated distance you can travel on the fuel remaining in the fuel tank. This distance is estimated from the fuel economy you received over the last several miles(U.S.) or kilometers (Canada), so it will vary with changes in speed, traffic, etc. AVERAGE SPEED
This shows the average speed you are traveling in miles per hour (mph) for U.S. models or kilometers per hour (km/h) for Canadian models.
ELAPSED TIME
This shows the time passed traveled since you last reset it. When you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, ELAPSED TIME is reset. If you want to reset the ELAPSED TIME manually, go to the trip computer’s ELAPSED TIME display, and press and hold the SEL/RESET button until the number resets. You can customize the ELAPSED TIME reset condition on the multiinformation display (see page 94 ).
To reset the AVERAGE SPEED you have traveled, press and hold the SEL/RESET button until the number resets.
79
Instruments and Controls
This shows your vehicle’s average fuel economy in mpg (U.S. models) or liter/100 km (Canadian models) since you last reset the Trip A or Trip B.
07/07/09 09:32:10 31STX610 0085
Multi-Information Display System Messages SYSTEM MESSAGE INDICATOR
The system message(s) triggers the appropriate indicator(s) on the instrument panel, including the system message indicator, to come on. The system message indicator does not go off until the problem(s) is corrected. You will also hear a beep when the system message comes on for the first time.
If there is a problem with your vehicle, for example, the engine oil level is low or a door is not fully closed, the multi-information display will show you the problem. It does this by interrupting the current display with one or more messages.
80
Most of the messages are displayed for about 5 seconds, and then the normal display returns. If there are several system messages to be shown, the display switches these messages every 5 seconds.
To cancel the message(s) before 5 seconds elapsed, press the INFO (▲/▼) button on the steering wheel. Even if you press the INFO (▲/▼) button, some messages stay on or come on again at regular intervals until the problem is corrected. You can see the message(s) again by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button repeatedly if the system message indicator remains lit on the instrument panel. Here is a list of all messages:
07/07/09 09:32:25 31STX610 0086
Multi-Information Display
See page 11
U.S.
Canada
See page 20
U.S.
Canada
See page 33 U.S.
U.S.
Canada
See page 438
See page 33
Canada
See page 438
See page 437 See page 436 See page 358 See page 359 See page 376 CONTINUED
81
Instruments and Controls
See page 20
See page 153
See page 436
07/07/09 09:32:39 31STX610 0087
Multi-Information Display
See page 353
See page 349
See page 354
See page 349
See page 354
See page 341
See page 68
See page 362
See page 384
See page 398
See page 324
U.S.
Canada
82
See page 134
See page 71
See page 340
See page 121
07/07/09 09:32:49 31STX610 0088
Multi-Information Display Customize Settings
If you turn the ignition switch to the ACCESSORY (I) or the LOCK (0) position, or move the shift lever out of Park, the display will change to the normal screen.
When the main menu displays ‘‘Keyless Memory SettingsTM,’’ you can customize some vehicle control settings. To enter the customizing mode, press the SEL/RESET button. To change the settings, the ignition switch must be in the ON (II) position, and the vehicle must be stopped with the transmission in Park.
To have the driver’s ID detected, make sure your remote transmitter is linked to the system (see Keyless Memory SettingsTM on page 139).
If you want the settings as they were when the vehicle left the factory, select DEFAULT ALL, as described on page 86 . If you want to change any vehicle control settings, select CHG SETTING, then press the SEL/ RESET button. Refer to the table on the following pages about the settings you want to CONTINUED customize.
83
Instruments and Controls
You can customize some vehicle control settings for ‘‘DRIVER 1’’ and ‘‘DRIVER 2’’ separately. If ‘‘DRIVER 1’’ or ‘‘DRIVER 2’’ is not displayed, customizing is not possible.
07/07/09 09:32:56 31STX610 0089
Multi-Information Display Group Setup METER SETUP (P.89)
POSITION SETUP (P.97)
Menu Item LANGUAGE SELECTION
ADJUST OUTSIDE TEMP. DISPLAY
Changes the outside temperature reading above or below its current reading.
TRIP A & AVG. FUEL RESET with REFUEL ADJUST ALARM VOLUME
Causes trip meter A and the average fuel economy to reset when you refuel. Changes the indicator alarm volumes into three levels.
ELAPSED TIME RESET
Resets the elapsed time of your current trip.
AUTO INTERIOR ILLUMINATION
Changes the interior light sensitivity to your liking.
MEMORY POSITION LINK
Changes the driver’s seat, the steering wheel, and the outside mirror positions to a stored setting. Moves the steering wheel fully in and up when the key is removed.
AUTO TILT & TELESCOPE STEERING WHEEL * : Default setting
84
Description Changes the language used in the display.
Setting Option ENGLISH* FRENCH SPANISH −5°F ∼ ±0°F* ∼ 5°F (U.S.) −3°C ∼ ±0°C* ∼ 3°C (Canada) ON OFF* HIGH MID* LOW MANUAL ONLY IGN OFF* TRIP B TRIP A MAX LOW HIGH MIN MID* OFF ON* OFF ON* OFF
Page 90
91
92
93
94
95 98 99
07/07/09 09:33:02 31STX610 0090
Multi-Information Display Group Setup LIGHTING SETUP (P.100)
Menu Item
Setting Option
Page
Changes how long (in seconds) the interior lights stay on after you close the doors and the tailgate. Changes how long (in seconds) the exterior lights stay on after you close the driver’s door.
101
AUTO LIGHT SENSITIVITY
Changes the timing of when the headlights come on. The headlight switch needs to be in the AUTO position. Changes the setting of when to automatically lock the doors.
15 sec 60 sec 30 sec* 60 sec 0 sec 30 sec 15 sec* LOW MAX MIN HIGH MID* SHIFT FROM P WITH VEH SPD* OFF SHIFT TO P* DRIVER DOOR/ IGN OFF ALL DOORS OFF DRIVER DOOR * ALL DOORS ON* OFF
AUTO DOOR LOCK
AUTO DOOR UNLOCK
KEY AND REMOTE UNLOCK MODE KEYLESS LOCK ACKNOWLEDGMENT SECURITY RELOCK TIMER WIPER SETUP (P.113) DEFAULT ALL (P.86) * : Default setting
WIPER ACTION
Changes the setting of when to automatically unlock the driver’s/all the doors. Changes which doors unlock with the remote transmitter in a first push. The exterior lights flash each time you press the LOCK or UNLOCK button. A beeper will also sound when you press the LOCK button twice. Changes how long it takes (in seconds) for the doors to relock and the security system to set after you unlock but do not open the door. Changes the wiper operation between two settings when the wiper switch is in the INT position. Set/Cancel all the customized settings as default.
90 sec 60 sec 30 sec* INTERMITTENT WITH VEH SPD* SET CANCEL
102
103
106
107 109
110
111 113 86
85
Instruments and Controls
DOOR/WINDOW SETUP (P.105)
Description
INTERIOR LIGHT DIMMING TIME HEADLIGHT AUTO OFF TIMER
07/07/09 09:33:10 31STX610 0091
Multi-Information Display DEFAULT ALL
If you want to set the default settings, press the INFO (▲/▼) button to select DEFAULT ALL, then press the SEL/RESET button.
86
To set the default settings, press the INFO (▲/▼) button to select SET then press the SEL/RESET button. If you want to cancel DEFAULT ALL, select CANCEL, then press the SEL/RESET button. The screen goes back to the previous display.
When DEFAULT ALL is set, you will see the above display for several seconds, then the screen returns to CUSTOMIZE ENTRY. If the setting is not successfully completed, ‘‘FAILED’’ is shown for several seconds, and then the screen goes back to the normal message mode. Repeat the same procedure to select DEFAULT ALL.
07/07/09 09:33:18 31STX610 0092
Multi-Information Display Customize Settings You can customize some of the vehicle control settings to your preference. Here are the settings you can customize: METER SETUP POSITION SETUP LIGHTING SETUP DOOR/WINDOW SETUP WIPER SETUP When you want to change the vehicle control settings, press the INFO (▲/▼) button to select CHG SETTING, then press the SEL/ RESET button.
CONTINUED
87
Instruments and Controls
Each time you press the INFO (▲/ ▼) button, the screen changes as shown on the next page. Press the INFO (▲/▼) button, until you see the setup you want to customize, then press the SEL/RESET button to enter your selection.
07/07/09 09:33:23 31STX610 0093
Multi-Information Display
METER SETUP see page 89
POSITION SETUP see page 97 Select ‘‘EXIT’’ LIGHTING SETUP see page 100
Select ‘‘CANCEL’’
Select ‘‘DEFAULT ALL’’
DOOR/WINDOW SETUP see page 105
WIPER SETUP see page 113 SEL/RESET BUTTON INFO (▲/▼) BUTTON
88
07/07/09 09:33:32 31STX610 0094
Multi-Information Display Meter Setup Here are the six custom settings for the meter setup: Instruments and Controls
LANGUAGE SELECTION ADJUST OUTSIDE TEMP. DISPLAY TRIP A & AVG. FUEL RESET with REFUEL ADJUST ALARM VOLUME ELAPSED TIME RESET AUTO INTERIOR ILLUMINATION While METER SETUP is shown, press the SEL/RESET button to enter the customize mode. Each time you press the INFO (▲/ ▼) button, the screen changes as shown in the illustration. Press the INFO (▲/▼) button until you see the setting you want to customize, then press the SEL/RESET button to enter your selection.
SEL/RESET BUTTON INFO (▲/▼) BUTTON
CONTINUED
89
07/07/09 09:33:40 31STX610 0095
Multi-Information Display Language Selection
There are three language selections you can make: English, French, and Spanish. To choose the language you want, follow these instructions: You can choose this customize item from ‘‘METER SETUP’’ by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button repeatedly.
90
Press the SEL/RESET button to see the selections. Select the desired language by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button, then enter your selection by pressing the SEL/RESET button.
When your selection is successfully completed, the display changes as shown above, and then goes back to the customize item screen. If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’ message appears, go back to ‘‘LANGUAGE SELECTION’’ and repeat the procedure again.
07/07/09 09:33:49 31STX610 0096
Multi-Information Display Adjust Outside Temp. Display
You can choose this customize item from ‘‘METER SETUP’’ by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button repeatedly.
U.S. models
Canadian models
Canadian models
Adjust the outside temperature value by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button repeatedly. Press the SEL/RESET button to set the desired value.
When your selection is successfully completed, the display changes as shown above, and then goes back to the customize item screen. If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’ message appears, go back to ‘‘ADJUST OUTSIDE TEMP. DISPLAY’’ and repeat the procedure again. CONTINUED
91
Instruments and Controls
If you sometimes find that the temperature reading is a few degrees above or below the actual temperature, you can adjust it by following these instructions:
U.S. models
07/07/09 09:33:58 31STX610 0097
Multi-Information Display Trip A & Avg. Fuel Reset With Refuel
To cause Trip A and AVG. FUEL to reset every time you refuel your vehicle, follow these instructions: You can choose this customize item from ‘‘METER SETUP’’ by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button repeatedly.
92
Press the SEL/RESET button to see the selections. Select ON or OFF by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button, then enter your selection by pressing the SEL/ RESET button.
When your selection is successfully completed, the display changes as shown above, and then goes back to the customize item screen. If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’ message appears, go back to ‘‘TRIP A & AVG. FUEL RESET with REFUEL’’ and repeat the procedure again.
07/07/09 09:34:06 31STX610 0098
Multi-Information Display Adjust Alarm Volume
Press the SEL/RESET button to see the selections.
You can choose this customize item from ‘‘METER SETUP’’ by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button repeatedly.
Select the desired level by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button, then enter your selection by pressing the SEL/ RESET button.
When your selection is successfully completed, the display changes as shown above, and then goes back to the customize item screen. If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’ message appears, go back to ‘‘ADJUST ALARM VOLUME’’ and repeat the procedure again. CONTINUED
93
Instruments and Controls
Select the warning alarm volume from three levels.
07/07/09 09:34:15 31STX610 0099
Multi-Information Display Elapsed Time Reset
There are four elapsed time reset choices you can make: MANUAL ONLY − You can reset the elapsed time, when Trip Computer’s Elapsed Time is displayed (see page 79 ). IGN OFF − The elapsed time is reset when you turn the ignition switch to the LOCK (0) position. TRIP A − The elapsed time is reset when the Trip A is reset. TRIP B − The elapsed time is reset when the Trip B is reset.
94
You can choose this customize item from ‘‘METER SETUP’’ by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button repeatedly.
Press the SEL/RESET button to see the selections. Select the desired setting by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button, then enter your selection by pressing the SEL/RESET button.
07/07/09 09:34:24 31STX610 0100
Multi-Information Display Auto Interior Illumination
There are MAX, HIGH, MID, LOW and MIN levels and OFF for the auto interior illumination settings.
When your selection is successfully completed, the display changes as shown above, and then goes back to the customize item screen. If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’ message appears, go back to ‘‘ELAPSED TIME RESET’’ and repeat the procedure again.
If you want the illuminations to start dimming as early as possible, select MAX. For illuminations to start dimming as late as possible, select MIN. Choose HIGH, MID, or LOW for levels in between.
You can choose this customize item from ‘‘METER SETUP’’ by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button repeatedly.
To disable the auto interior illumination function, select OFF.
CONTINUED
95
Instruments and Controls
While the headlight switch is turned on, the interior lights gradually dim, as the outside light level gets low. You can customize at which outside light level the lights start to dim.
07/07/09 09:34:30 31STX610 0101
Multi-Information Display
Press the SEL/RESET button to see the selections. Select the desired setting by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button, then enter your selection by pressing the SEL/RESET button.
96
When your selection is successfully completed, the display changes as shown above, and then goes back to the customize item screen. If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’ message appears, go back to ‘‘AUTO INTERIOR ILLUMINATION’’ and repeat the procedure again.
07/07/09 09:34:37 31STX610 0102
Multi-Information Display Position Setup Here are the two custom settings for the position setup: Instruments and Controls
MEMORY POSITION LINK AUTO TILT & TELESCOPE STEERING WHEEL While ‘‘POSITION SETUP’’ is shown, press the SEL/RESET button to enter the customize mode. Each time you press the INFO (▲/ ▼) button, the screen changes as shown in the illustration. Press the INFO (▲/▼) button until you see the setting you want to customize, then press the SEL/RESET button to enter your selection.
SEL/RESET BUTTON INFO (▲ or ▼) BUTTON
CONTINUED
97
07/07/09 09:34:46 31STX610 0103
Multi-Information Display Memory Position Link
If ‘‘MEMORY POSITION LINK’’ is set to ‘‘ON,’’ the driver’s seat, the steering wheel, and outside mirror positions move to the position stored in the memory when you open the driver’s door, using the remote transmitter. You can choose this customize item from ‘‘POSITION SETUP’’ by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button repeatedly.
98
Press the SEL/RESET button to see the selections. Select ON or OFF by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button, then enter your selection by pressing the SEL/ RESET button.
When your selection is successfully completed, the display changes as shown above, and then goes back to the customize item screen. If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’ message appears, go back to ‘‘MEMORY POSITION LINK’’ and repeat the procedure again.
07/07/09 09:34:54 31STX610 0104
Multi-Information Display Auto Tilt & Telescope Steering Wheel
You can choose this customize item from ‘‘POSITION SETUP’’ by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button repeatedly.
Press the SEL/RESET button to see the selections. Select ON or OFF by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button, then enter your selection by pressing the SEL/ RESET button.
When your selection is successfully completed, the display changes as shown above, and then goes back to the customize item screen. If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’ message appears, go back to ‘‘AUTO TILT & TELESCOPE STEERING WHEEL’’ and repeat the procedure again. CONTINUED
99
Instruments and Controls
When ‘‘AUTO TILT & TELESCOPE STEERING WHEEL’’ is set to ‘‘ON,’’ the steering wheel automatically moves fully in and up when you turn the ignition switch to the LOCK (0) position and remove the key.
07/07/09 09:35:02 31STX610 0105
Multi-Information Display Lighting Setup Here are the three custom settings for the lighting setup: INTERIOR LIGHT DIMMING TIME HEADLIGHT AUTO OFF TIMER AUTO LIGHT SENSITIVITY While ‘‘LIGHTING SETUP’’ is shown, press the SEL/RESET button to enter the customize mode. Each time you press the INFO (▲/ ▼) button, the screen changes as shown in the illustration. Press the INFO (▲/▼) button until you see the setting you want to customize, then press the SEL/RESET button to enter your selection.
100
SEL/RESET BUTTON INFO (▲ or ▼) BUTTON
07/07/09 09:35:11 31STX610 0106
Multi-Information Display Interior Light Dimming Time
You can choose this customize item from ‘‘LIGHTING SETUP’’ by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button repeatedly.
Press the SEL/RESET button to see the selections. Select the desired setting by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button, then enter your selection by pressing the SEL/RESET button.
When your selection is successfully completed, the display changes as shown above, and then goes back to the customize item screen. If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’ message appears, go back to ‘‘INTERIOR LIGHT DIMMING TIME’’ and repeat the procedure again. CONTINUED
101
Instruments and Controls
The interior lights fade out when you close all doors and tailgate. To change how long the lights stay on before they fade out, follow these instructions:
07/07/09 09:35:17 31STX610 0107
Multi-Information Display Headlight Auto Off Timer
The headlights, parking lights, side marker lights, taillights, and license plate lights go off after the selected time when you remove the key from the ignition switch and close the driver’s door. To change how long the lights stay on before they go off, follow these instructions:
You can choose this customize item from ‘‘LIGHTING SETUP’’ by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button repeatedly.
102
Press the SEL/RESET button to see the selections. Select the desired setting by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button, then enter your selection by pressing the SEL/RESET button.
07/07/09 09:35:27 31STX610 0108
Multi-Information Display Auto Light Sensitivity
When your selection is successfully completed, the display changes as shown above, and then goes back to the customize item screen. If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’ message appears, go back to ‘‘HEADLIGHT AUTO OFF TIMER’’ and repeat the procedure again.
HIGH − The headlights come on when it is somewhat bright. MID − The headlights come on when it is as bright as sunset or sunrise.
You can choose this customize item from ‘‘LIGHTING SETUP’’ by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button repeatedly.
LOW − The headlights come on when it is somewhat dark. MIN − The headlights come on when it is dark.
CONTINUED
103
Instruments and Controls
The headlights automatically come on when the headlight switch is in the AUTO position and the ambient light reaches a changeable level. You can select the auto light sensitivity from the following five levels: MAX − The headlights come on when it is bright.
07/07/09 09:35:33 31STX610 0109
Multi-Information Display
Press the SEL/RESET button to see the selections. Select the desired setting by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button, then enter your selection by pressing the SEL/RESET button.
104
When your selection is successfully completed, the display changes as shown above, and then goes back to the customize item screen. If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’ message appears, go back to ‘‘AUTO LIGHT SENSITIVITY’’ and repeat the procedure again.
07/07/09 09:35:43 31STX610 0110
Multi-Information Display Door/Window Setup Here are the five custom settings for the door/window setup: Instruments and Controls
AUTO DOOR LOCK AUTO DOOR UNLOCK KEY AND REMOTE UNLOCK MODE KEYLESS LOCK ACKNOWLEDGMENT SECURITY RELOCK TIMER While ‘‘DOOR/WINDOW SETUP’’ is shown, press the SEL/RESET button to enter the customize mode. Each time you press the INFO (▲/ ▼) button, the screen changes as shown in the illustration. Press the INFO (▲/▼) button until you see the setting you want to customize, then press the SEL/RESET button to enter your selection.
SEL/RESET BUTTON INFO (▲ or ▼) BUTTON
CONTINUED
105
07/07/09 09:35:51 31STX610 0111
Multi-Information Display Auto Door Lock
There are three settings you can choose from: SHIFT FROM P − The doors lock whenever you move the shift lever out of Park. WITH VEH SPD − The doors lock when the vehicle speed reaches about 10 mph (about 15 km/h). OFF − The auto door lock is deactivated all the time.
106
You can choose this customize item from ‘‘DOOR/WINDOW SETUP’’ by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button repeatedly.
Press the SEL/RESET button to see the selections. Select the desired setting by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button, then enter your selection by pressing the SEL/RESET button.
07/07/09 09:36:00 31STX610 0112
Multi-Information Display Auto Door Unlock
There are three settings you can choose from:
When your selection is successfully completed, the display changes as shown above, and then goes back to the customize item screen. If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’ message appears, go back to ‘‘AUTO DOOR LOCK’’ and repeat the procedure again.
IGN OFF − The driver’s door or all the doors, depending on the door lock mode setting ( see page 106 ), unlock when you turn the ignition switch to the LOCK (0) position. OFF − The auto door unlock is deactivated all the time. This is the factory default setting.
You can choose this customize item from ‘‘DOOR/WINDOW SETUP’’ by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button repeatedly.
CONTINUED
107
Instruments and Controls
SHIFT TO P − The driver’s door or all the doors, depending on the door lock mode setting ( see page 106 ), unlock when you move the shift lever to Park.
07/07/09 09:36:08 31STX610 0113
Multi-Information Display
Press the SEL/RESET button to see the selections.
If you choose ‘‘SHIFT TO P’’ or ‘‘IGN OFF’’, you will see the above display.
Select the desired setting by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button, then enter your selection by pressing the SEL/RESET button.
Press the INFO (▲/▼) button to switch the door lock mode setting between the driver’s door and all doors. Then, press the SEL/RESET button to enter your selection.
108
When your selection is successfully completed, the display changes as shown above, and then goes back to the customize item screen. If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’ message appears, go back to ‘‘AUTO DOOR UNLOCK’’ and repeat the procedure again.
07/07/09 09:36:17 31STX610 0114
Multi-Information Display Key and Remote Unlock Mode
You can choose this customize item from ‘‘DOOR/WINDOW SETUP’’ by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button repeatedly.
Press the SEL/RESET button to see the selections. Select the desired setting by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button, then enter your selection by pressing the SEL/RESET button.
When your selection is successfully completed, the display changes as shown above, and then goes back to the customize item screen. If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’ message appears, go back to ‘‘KEY AND REMOTE UNLOCK MODE’’ and repeat the procedure again. CONTINUED
109
Instruments and Controls
To select whether the driver’s door unlocks or all the doors unlock when you unlock the doors with the remote transmitter, follow these instructions.
07/07/09 09:36:23 31STX610 0115
Multi-Information Display Keyless Lock Acknowledgment
When you push the LOCK button on the remote transmitter, some exterior lights flash, and a beeper sounds when you push the LOCK button again within 5 seconds to verify that the doors and the tailgate are locked and the security system has set (see page 269 ). You can customize the exterior lights not to flash and the beeper not to sound. You can choose this customize item from ‘‘DOOR/WINDOW SETUP’’ by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button repeatedly.
110
Press the SEL/RESET button to see the selections. Select ON or OFF by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button, then enter your selection by pressing the SEL/ RESET button.
07/07/09 09:36:31 31STX610 0116
Multi-Information Display Security Relock Timer
You can change this relock time from 30 seconds to 60 or 90 seconds.
When your selection is successfully completed, the display changes as shown above, and then goes back to the customize item screen.
You can choose this customize item from ‘‘DOOR/WINDOW SETUP’’ by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button repeatedly.
If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’ message appears, go back to ‘‘KEYLESS LOCK ACKNOWLEDGMENT’’ and repeat the procedure again. CONTINUED
111
Instruments and Controls
If you unlock the doors and the tailgate with the remote transmitter, but do not open any of the doors or the tailgate within 30 seconds, the doors and the tailgate automatically relock and the security system sets.
07/07/09 09:36:37 31STX610 0117
Multi-Information Display
Press the SEL/RESET button to see the selections. Select the desired setting by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button, then enter your selection by pressing the SEL/RESET button.
112
When your selection is successfully completed, the display changes as shown above, and then goes back to the customize item screen. If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’ message appears, go back to ‘‘SECURITY RELOCK TIMER’’ and repeat the procedure again.
07/07/09 09:36:46 31STX610 0118
Multi-Information Display Wiper Setup
Wiper Action
You can select from these two settings when the wiper switch is in the INT (intermittent) position:
Here is one custom setting for the wiper setup: WIPER ACTION While ‘‘WIPER SETUP’’ is shown, press the SEL/RESET button to enter the customize mode.
Each time you press the INFO (▲/ ▼) button, the screen changes as shown in the illustration. Press the INFO (▲/▼) button until you see the setting you want to customize, then press the SEL/RESET button to enter your selection.
WITH VEH SPD − The intermittent operation varies according to vehicle speed.
CONTINUED
113
Instruments and Controls
SEL/RESET BUTTON INFO (▲/▼) BUTTON
INTERMITTENT − The intermittent operation varies according to the selection you make on the wiper lever’s intermittent control ring.
07/07/09 09:36:54 31STX610 0119
Multi-Information Display
You can choose this customize item from ‘‘WIPER SETUP’’ by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button repeatedly.
114
Press the SEL/RESET button to see the selections. Select the desired setting by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button, then enter your selection by pressing the SEL/RESET button.
When your selection is successfully completed, the display changes as shown above, and then goes back to the customize item screen. If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’ message appears, go back to ‘‘WIPER ACTION’’ and repeat the procedure again.
07/07/09 09:37:02 31STX610 0120
Controls Near the Steering Wheel
HEADLIGHT WASHER SWITCH*1 (P.117)
HEADLIGHT/TURN SIGNAL/ FRONT FOG LIGHTS (P.118)
STEERING WHEEL AUDIO CONTROLS (P.233)
WINDSHIELD WIPERS/WASHERS (P.116)
HAZARD WARNING BUTTON (P.122)
MIRROR CONTROLS (P.155)
REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER (P.122)
DRIVING POSITION MEMORY SYSTEM (P.157)
ACCESSORY POWER SOCKETS (P.166)
POWER DOOR LOCK MASTER SWITCH (P.130) POWER WINDOW SWITCHES (P.149)
SEAT HEATER SWITCHES (P.148)
HORN*2
FUEL FILL DOOR RELEASE BUTTON (P.323) HOOD RELEASE HANDLE (P.325)
STEERING WHEEL ADJUSTMENTS (P.124)
CRUISE CONTROL BUTTONS (P.270)
ACTIVE DAMPER SYSTEM SWITCH*1 (P.361)
*1: If equipped *2: To use the horn, press the center pad of the steering wheel.
115
Instruments and Controls
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF INDICATOR (P.34)
VEHICLE STABILITY ASSIST SYSTEM OFF SWITCH (P.360)
POWER TAILGATE BUTTON*1 (P.132)
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRIGHTNESS (P.123)
07/07/09 09:37:11 31STX610 0121
Windshield Wipers and Washers Push the right lever up or down to select a position. MIST − The wipers run at high speed until you release the lever. OFF − The wipers are not activated. INT − The length of the wipe interval is varied automatically according to vehicle speed. 1. MIST 2. OFF 3. INT − Intermittent 4. LO − Low speed 5. HI − High speed 6. Windshield washers
116
If you turn it to the shortest delay, the wipers change to low speed operation when the vehicle speed exceeds 12 mph (20 km/h). To change the ‘‘WIPER ACTION’’ setting, see page 113 .
LO − The wipers run at low speed. HI − The wipers run at high speed. Windshield Washer − Pull the wiper control lever toward you, and hold it. The washers spray until you release the lever. The wipers run at low speed, then complete one more sweep after you release the lever.
07/07/09 09:37:19 31STX610 0122
Windshield Wipers and Washers Headlight Washers (On Canadian models)
Rear Window Wiper and Washer
1. Rotate the switch clockwise to turn the rear window wiper ON. 2. Hold past ON to turn the rear window wiper on and to spray the rear window washer.
CONTINUED
117
Instruments and Controls
The headlight washers can be operated at any time by pressing the headlight washer button located next to the steering wheel column. The headlights must be turned on to use this button. In addition, the headlight washer operates without pressing the button, at the first time you turn on the windshield washers after you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position.
The headlight washers use the same fluid reservoir as the windshield washers.
07/07/09 09:37:28 31STX610 0123
Windshield Wipers and Washers, Turn Signal and Headlights 3. When you turn the wiper switch to the ‘‘OFF’’ position, the wiper will return to its parked position.
Turn Signal and Headlights
4. Rotate the switch counterclockwise to spray the window washer.
Headlights On − Turning the switch to the ‘‘ ’’ position turns on the parking lights, taillights, instrument panel lights, side-marker lights, and rear license plate lights.
When you shift the transmission to the reverse position with the front windshield wipers activated, the rear window wiper operates automatically. When the wiper control lever position is INT, the rear wiper operates intermittently. When it is LO or HI, the rear wiper operates continuously. The rear window washer uses the same fluid reservoir as the windshield washer.
118
Turn Signal − Push down on the lever to signal a left turn and up to signal a right turn. To signal a lane change, push lightly on the lever, and hold it. The lever will return to center when you release it or complete a turn.
1. Turn signal 2. Off 3. Parking and indicator lights 4. AUTO 5. Headlights on 6. High beams 7. Flash high beams 8. Fog lights off 9. Fog lights on
Turning the switch to the ‘‘ ’’ position turns on the headlights. If you leave the lights on with the key removed from the ignition switch, you will hear a reminder chime when you open the driver’s door.
07/07/09 09:37:36 31STX610 0124
Headlights When the light switch is in either of these positions, the lights on indicator comes on as a reminder.
High Beams − To switch from low beams to high beams, push the left lever forward until you hear a click. The blue high beam indicator will come on (see page 70 ). Pull it back to return to low beams. To flash the high beams, pull the lever back lightly, then release it. The high beams stay on as long as you hold the lever back.
To turn on automatic lighting, turn the light switch to AUTO at any time. The lights will come on automatically when the outside light level becomes low (at dusk, for example). The lights on indicator comes on as a reminder. The lights and indicator will turn off automatically when the system senses high ambient light. The lights will remain on when you turn off the ignition switch. They will turn off automatically when you remove the key and open the driver’s door. To turn them on again, either turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position or turn the light switch to the position.
Even with the automatic lighting feature turned on, we recommend that you turn on the lights manually when driving at night or in a dense fog, or when you enter dark areas such as long tunnels or parking facilities. To change the ‘‘AUTO LIGHT SENSITIVITY’’ setting, see page 103 . Do not leave the light switch in AUTO if you will not be driving the vehicle for an extended period (a week or more). You should also turn off the lights if you plan to leave the engine idling or off for a long time.
119
Instruments and Controls
This indicator stays on if you leave the lights on and turn the ignition switch to the ACCESSORY (I) or LOCK (0) position.
AUTO − The automatic lighting feature turns on the headlights and all other exterior lights, when it senses low ambient light.
07/07/09 09:37:44 31STX610 0125
Headlights LIGHT SENSOR
Fog Lights Turn the fog lights on and off by turning the switch next to the headlight switch. You can use the fog lights only when the headlights are on low beam. With the light switch in the AUTO position, you can also use the fog lights when the headlights turn on automatically. They will go off when the headlights turn off.
The automatic lighting feature is controlled by a sensor located on top of the dashboard. Do not cover this sensor or spill liquids on it.
120
Daytime Running Lights With the headlight switch off, the daytime running lights come on when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position and release the parking brake. They remain on until you turn the ignition switch off, even if you set the parking brake. When the headlights are on, the daytime running lights are off.
07/07/09 09:37:52 31STX610 0126
Headlights Automatic Lighting Off Feature This feature turns off the headlights, all other exterior lights, and the instrument panel lights within 15 seconds after you remove the key and close the driver’s door.
When the multi-information display shows a ‘‘DRL OFF’’ message, the daytime running lights are off. Follow the procedure in the left column to turn them on.
To change the ‘‘HEADLIGHT AUTO OFF TIMER’’ setting, see page 102 . The automatic lighting off feature activates if you leave the headlight switch in the ‘‘ ’’ or ‘‘ ’’ position or if the lights are turned on by setting the switch in the ‘‘AUTO’’ position, and you remove the key, then open and close the driver’s door.
If you turn the ignition switch to the LOCK (0) position with the headlight switch on, but do not open the door and get out, the lights turn off after 10 minutes (3 minutes, if the switch is in the ‘‘AUTO’’ position). The lights turn on again when you unlock or open the driver’s door. If you unlock the door, but do not open it within 15 seconds, the lights go off. With the driver’s door open, you will hear a lights-on reminder chime.
121
Instruments and Controls
If you see a ‘‘CHECK DRL SYSTEM’’ message on the multiinformation display, there is a problem with the daytime running light system. Take your vehicle to a dealer to have it checked.
07/07/09 09:37:59 31STX610 0127
Hazard Warning Button, Rear Window Defogger Hazard Warning Button
Rear Window Defogger
Make sure the rear window is clear and you have good visibility before starting to drive. The defogger wires on the inside of the rear window can be accidentally damaged. When cleaning the glass, always wipe side-to-side. Pushing this button also turns the mirror heaters on or off. For more information, see page 156 .
Push the button between the center vents to turn on the hazard warning lights (four-way flashers). This causes all four outside turn signals and both indicators in the instrument panel to flash. Use the hazard warning lights if you need to park in a dangerous area near heavy traffic, or if your vehicle is disabled.
122
The rear window defogger will clear fog, frost, and thin ice from the window. Push the defogger button to turn it on and off. The indicator in the button lights to show the defogger is on. If you do not turn it off, the defogger will shut itself off after about 15 minutes. It also shuts off when you turn off the ignition. You have to turn it on again when you restart the vehicle.
07/07/09 09:38:05 31STX610 0128
Instrument Panel Brightness
Adjust the brightness of the instrument panel by pressing the + or − button. Press the + button to increase the brightness and the − button to decrease it. You can adjust the brightness with the headlight switch on or off.
The level of brightness is shown on the multi-information display while you adjust it. It goes out 5 seconds after you finish adjusting.
You can customize when the glare reduction function starts. To change ‘‘AUTO INTERIOR ILLUMINATION’’, see page 95 for more information.
123
Instruments and Controls
To reduce glare at night, the instrument panel illumination dims when you turn the light switch to or . To cancel the glare reduction function, set the brightness to the highest level, then press the + button. You will hear a beep when it is canceled.
07/07/09 09:38:11 31STX610 0129
Steering Wheel Adjustments Make any steering wheel adjustment before you start driving.
ADJUSTMENT SWITCH
Adjusting the steering wheel position while driving may cause you to lose control of the vehicle and be seriously injured in a crash. Adjust the steering wheel only when the vehicle is stopped.
124
Move the steering wheel in, out, up, or down by pushing and holding the adjustment switch in that direction.
Release the switch when the steering wheel reaches the desired position. Make sure the steering wheel points towards your chest, not toward your face, and that you can see the instrument panel gauges and indicators.
07/07/09 09:38:17 31STX610 0130
Steering Wheel Adjustments When you remove the key from the ignition switch, the steering wheel automatically moves fully in and up.
The steering wheel then returns to its original position when you insert the key back in the ignition switch. Steering wheel movement is also controlled by the driving position memory system (see page 157 ).
Instruments and Controls
To change the ‘‘AUTO TILT & TELESCOPE STEERING WHEEL’’ setting, see page 99 .
If your vehicle’s battery is disconnected or goes dead, or the fuse for the power tilt and telescopic steering wheel is removed, the power tilt and telescopic steering wheel system needs to be reset when you reconnect the battery or install the fuse. Insert the key into the ignition switch, and remove it. The steering wheel automatically moves fully in and up to let you know the system is reset.
125
07/07/09 09:38:25 31STX610 0131
Keys and Locks KEY MASTER KEY VALET KEY NUMBER WITH REMOTE (Light Gray) TAG TRANSMITTER
KEY MASTER KEY VALET KEY NUMBER WITH REMOTE (Light Gray) TAG TRANSMITTER
These keys contain electronic circuits that are activated by the immobilizer system. They will not work to start the engine if the circuits are damaged. Protect the keys from direct sunlight, high temperature, and high humidity.
MDX, Technology, and Sport Packages models shown.
The master key fits all the locks on your vehicle. The valet key works only in the ignition and the driver’s door lock. You can keep the glove box locked when you leave your vehicle and the valet key at a parking facility.
126
U.S. Entertainment Packages and Canadian Elite Package models shown.
You should have received a key number tag with your keys. You will need this key number if you ever have to get a lost key replaced. Use only Acura-approved key blanks.
Do not drop the keys or set heavy objects on them. Keep the keys away from liquids. If they get wet, dry them immediately with a soft cloth. The valet key does not contain a battery. Do not try to take it apart.
07/07/09 09:38:31 31STX610 0132
Keys and Locks Retractable Master Key RELEASE BUTTON Push
The key may come in contact with your finger while being retracted or extended. Make sure your fingers do not touch the pivot of the key when retracting or extending the key. Instruments and Controls
Always use the fully-extended key when you insert it to the ignition switch. If the key does not fully extend, the immobilizer system may not operate properly and prevents from starting the engine.
U.S. Entertainment Packages and Canadian Elite Package models shown.
The master key can be retracted into the remote transmitter. To use the key, push the release button to release the key from the transmitter. The key should be fully extended. To retract the key, push the release button and at the same time push the key into the remote transmitter until it is securely latched.
127
07/07/09 09:38:39 31STX610 0133
Immobilizer System The Immobilizer System protects your vehicle from theft. If an improperly-coded key (or other device) is used, the engine’s fuel system is disabled. When you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, the immobilizer system indicator should come on briefly, then go off. If the indicator starts to blink, it means the system does not recognize the coding of the key. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK (0) position, remove the key, reinsert it, and turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position again. The system may not recognize your key’s coding if another immobilizer key or other metal object (i.e. key fob) is near the ignition switch when you insert the key.
128
If the system repeatedly does not recognize the coding of your key, contact your dealer. Do not attempt to alter this system or add other devices to it. Electrical problems could result that may make your vehicle undrivable. If you have lost your key and you cannot start the engine, contact your dealer.
Always take the ignition key with you whenever you leave the vehicle alone.
As required by the FCC: This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. This device complies with Industry Canada Standard RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.
07/07/09 09:38:47 31STX610 0134
Ignition Switch If the front wheels are turned, the anti-theft lock may make it difficult to turn the key. Firmly turn the steering wheel to the left or right as you turn the key.
The ignition switch has four positions: LOCK (0), ACCESSORY (I), ON (II), and START (III). LOCK (0) − You can insert or remove the key only in this position. To turn the key to the LOCK (0) position, the shift lever must be in Park, and you must push the key in slightly.
The shift lever must be in Park before you can remove the key from the ignition switch.
ON (II) − This is the normal key position when driving. Several of the indicators on the instrument panel come on as a test when you turn the ignition switch from the ACCESSORY (I) to the ON (II) position. START (III) − Use this position only to start the engine. The switch returns to the ON (II) position when you let go of the key.
129
Instruments and Controls
ACCESSORY (I) − You can operate the audio system and the accessory power sockets in this position.
You will hear a reminder beeper if you leave the key in the ignition switch in the LOCK (0) or the ACCESSORY (I) position and open the driver’s door. Remove the key to turn off the beeper.
07/07/09 09:38:57 31STX610 0135
Door Locks UNLOCK
LOCK
To change the ‘‘KEY AND REMOTE UNLOCK MODE’’ setting, see page 109 . When the vehicle speed reaches about 10 mph (about 15 km/h) or more, all the doors lock automatically. To change the ‘‘AUTO DOOR LOCK’’ setting, see page 106 .
LOCK
To lock all doors and the tailgate, press the bottom of the master door lock switch on either front door, pull the lock tab above the driver’s door handle, or use the key on the outside lock on the driver’s door. Pressing the top of either master door lock switch will unlock all doors and the tailgate.
130
UNLOCK
The lock tab on any passenger’s door locks and unlocks that door. All doors and the tailgate can be locked from the outside by using the key in the driver’s door lock. To unlock only the driver’s door, insert the key, turn the key, and release it. The remaining doors and the tailgate unlock when you turn the key a second time within a few seconds.
When you shift to P after driving, the driver’s door unlocks. To change the ‘‘AUTO DOOR UNLOCK’’ setting, see page 107 .
07/07/09 09:39:05 31STX610 0136
Door Locks, Tailgate Lockout Prevention
Childproof Door Locks
Tailgate
LOCK
The childproof door locks are designed to prevent children seated in the rear from accidentally opening the rear doors. Each rear door has a lock lever near the edge. With the lever in the LOCK position (lever is down), the door cannot be opened from the inside regardless of the position of the lock tab. To open the door, push the lock tab forward and use the outside door handle.
To open the tailgate, push up inside the handle, then lift up. To close the tailgate, use the inner handle to pull it down, then press down on the back edge. Keep the tailgate closed at all times while driving to avoid damaging the tailgate and to prevent exhaust gas from getting into the interior. See Carbon Monoxide Hazard on page 58 .
131
Instruments and Controls
With any door and the tailgate open and the key in the ignition, both master door lock switches are disabled. They are not disabled if all the doors and the tailgate are closed. If you try to lock an open driver’s door by pulling the lock tab rearward the lock tab on the driver’s door pops out.
07/07/09 09:39:12 31STX610 0137
Tailgate Power Tailgate
POWER TAILGATE SWITCH
U.S. Entertainment Packages and Canadian Elite Package models
The tailgate can be opened and closed with the remote transmitter (see page 135 ) or the switch in the driver’s door pocket when both front doors are unlocked.
132
Press and hold the tailgate button on the remote transmitter or the switch for about 1 second to open or close the tailgate. Each time you press the button on the remote transmitter or the switch, you will hear a beep, and some front and rear lights will flash. If you push the same button or switch again while the tailgate is opening or closing, you will hear three beeps, and the tailgate will stop moving, reverse direction, and stop at the fully opened or closed position.
TAILGATE SWITCH
The tailgate can also be closed by pressing the button on the tailgate. If you press the button again while the tailgate is closing, you will hear three beeps, and the tailgate will stop moving, reverse direction, and stop at the fully opened position.
07/07/09 09:39:22 31STX610 0138
Tailgate Auto-Reverse
Closing a power tailgate while anyone is in the path of the tailgate can cause serious injury. Make sure everyone is clear before closing the power tailgate.
Also check that passengers, especially children, do not have their hands on the edge of the tailgate or on the tailgate sill. The auto reverse feature stops working when the tailgate is about to latch so the motor can pull the tailgate shut. If your vehicle’s battery is disconnected, goes dead, or the fuse is removed while the tailgate is fully open, the power tailgate needs to be reset. After connecting the battery or installing the fuse, close the tailgate fully by hand. The power tailgate may not open or close under the these conditions: The vehicle is parked on a steep hill.
When the tailgate or the roof is covered with snow or ice. Do not install any accessories on the tailgate. It may cause the tailgate not to function properly. If there is snow or ice on the tailgate, make sure to remove it before you operate the tailgate. If you push the tailgate release button inside the handle while the tailgate is opening or closing, it will stop moving. You need to open or close it the rest of the way manually. The tailgate has sensors on both sides. Be careful not to damage them. If the sensors are damaged, the power tailgate does not function properly.
When the vehicle is swayed in a strong wind. CONTINUED
133
Instruments and Controls
The power tailgate has an autoreverse feature. If it meets resistance while opening or closing, it will beep three times and reverse direction. However, the tailgate may not reverse immediately. Always make sure passengers and objects are clear of the tailgate before opening or closing it.
07/07/09 09:39:31 31STX610 0139
Tailgate If you try to drive off with the tailgate not closed completely, a beeper sounds and a ‘‘DOOR & TAILGATE OPEN’’ message is shown on the multi-information display.
Unlocking the Tailgate
Keep the tailgate closed at all times while driving to avoid damaging the tailgate and to prevent exhaust gas from getting into the interior. See Carbon Monoxide Hazard on page 58 . If there is a problem in the power tailgate system, you will see a ‘‘CHECK POWER TAILGATE’’ message on the multi-information display. Have the system checked by your dealer. With this message shown on the multi-information display, you can still open or close the tailgate manually.
134
U.S. Entertainment Packages and Canadian Elite Package models
If the power door lock system cannot unlock the tailgate, unlock it manually. Use a small flat-tipped screwdriver to remove the cover on the back of the tailgate.
Push the release lever to the right as shown. If you need to unlock the tailgate manually, it means there is a problem with the tailgate. Have the vehicle checked by your dealer.
07/07/09 09:39:39 31STX610 0140
Tailgate, Remote Transmitter Remote Transmitter U.S. Entertainment Packages and Canadian Elite Package models UNLOCK BUTTON
LOCK BUTTON
TAILGATE BUTTON
MDX, Technology, and U.S. Sport Packages models
If you cannot open the tailgate, remove the cover on the back of the tailgate (see page 134 ). Push the release lever to the right as shown, then pull the outer handle to open the tailgate.
PANIC BUTTON
LOCK − Press this button once to lock all doors and the tailgate. Some exterior lights will flash. When you push LOCK twice within 5 seconds, you will hear a beep to verify that the doors and tailgate are locked and the security system has set. This button does not work if any door or tailgate is not fully closed.
PANIC BUTTON
To change the ‘‘KEYLESS LOCK ACKNOWLEDGEMENT’’ setting, see page 110 .
CONTINUED
135
Instruments and Controls
MDX, Technology, and U.S. Sport Packages models LOCK UNLOCK BUTTON BUTTON
07/07/09 09:39:46 31STX610 0141
Remote Transmitter UNLOCK − Press this button once to unlock the driver’s door. Push it twice to unlock the other doors. Some exterior lights will flash twice when you push the button. If you do not open any door or the tailgate within 30 seconds, they will automatically relock. To change the ‘‘KEY AND REMOTE UNLOCK MODE’’ setting, see page 109 . To change the ‘‘SECURITY RELOCK TIMER’’ setting, see page 111 .
When you press the UNLOCK button, the front and rear individual map lights and the cargo area light, depending on their switch positions, will come on (see page 160 ). If you do not open any door or the tailgate, the lights stay on for about 30 seconds, then go out. If you relock the doors and the tailgate with the remote transmitter before 30 seconds have elapsed, the lights will go off immediately. U.S. Entertainment Packages and Canadian Elite Package models
TAILGATE − Press and hold the TAILGATE button to open or close the power tailgate. When the tailgate begins to move, you will hear a beep, and some front and rear lights will flash. If you push the same button again while the tailgate is opening or closing, three beeps sound, the tailgate stops moving, reverses
136
direction and stops in the fully opened or fully closed position. PANIC − Press and hold this button for about 1 second to attract attention; the horn will sound, and the exterior lights will flash for about 30 seconds. To cancel panic mode, press any other button on the remote transmitter, or turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. Panic mode does not work when the key is in the ignition switch.
07/07/09 09:39:56 31STX610 0142
Remote Transmitter Remote Transmitter Care
Replacing the Transmitter Battery If it takes several pushes on the button to lock or unlock the doors and the tailgate, replace the battery as soon as possible. Battery type: CR1616
SCREW
KEYPAD
To replace the battery: 1. Remove the screw at the base of the transmitter with a small Phillips-head screwdriver. 2. Separate the keypad from the transmitter by pushing any button from outside.
CONTINUED
137
Instruments and Controls
Avoid dropping or throwing the transmitter. Protect the transmitter from extreme temperature. Do not immerse the transmitter in any liquid. If you lose a transmitter, the replacement needs to be reprogrammed by your dealer.
07/07/09 09:40:04 31STX610 0143
Remote Transmitter 4. Remove the old battery and note the polarity. Make sure the polarity of the new battery is the same (− side facing up), then insert it in the keypad. BATTERY
3. Place a cloth on the edge of the keypad, and remove the upper half by carefully prying on the edge with a small flat-tip screwdriver.
138
An improperly disposed of battery can hurt the environment. Always confirm local regulations for battery disposal. 5. Snap the two halves of the keypad, then install the parts in reverse order.
As required by the FCC: This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. This device complies with Industry Canada Standard RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.
07/07/09 09:40:15 31STX610 0144
Remote Transmitter Keyless Memory SettingsTM
Here are the settings activated with the remote; Customized settings (see page 83 ).
Audio system settings (see page 200 ).
When you unlock the driver’s door with your remote, each remote activates the keyless memory settings related to that remote. The driver’s ID (MEMORY 1 or MEMORY 2) is shown on the back of each remote.
Climate control settings (see page 171 ). When you unlock and open the driver’s door with the remote transmitter, the driver’s seat (except the power lumbar feature) and outside mirrors start to move to the positions stored in memory. The indicator in the related memory button to the remote comes on.
You will also see the ‘‘WELCOME DRIVER 1’’ or ‘‘WELCOME DRIVER 2’’ message on the multiinformation display, depending on which linked remote transmitter is used. To turn off this feature, press and hold the LOCK and UNLOCK buttons at the same time. The LED in the remote will blink twice. Then release the buttons. Doing this cancels the keyless memory settings for that remote and restores the default settings. To turn the keyless memory settings back on, repeat this procedure. The LED will blink once to indicate the feature has been turned on.
139
Instruments and Controls
Driving position memory (see page 157 ).
The steering wheel will move to the stored position when you insert the key into the ignition switch.
07/07/09 09:40:26 31STX610 0145
Seats Front Seat Power Adjustments
Moves the whole seat up and forward, or down and backward. The front of the seat also tilts up or down at the same time.
See pages 12 − 14 for important safety information and warnings about how to properly position the seats and seatbacks.
The controls for the power adjustable front seats are on the outside edge of each seat bottom. You can adjust the seats with the ignition switch in any position. Make all seat adjustments before you start driving. The passenger seat has the same adjustments as the driver’s seat but without any lumbar adjustment.
Adjusts the seat-back angle forward or backward.
Moves the seat forward and backward.
Moves the front of the seat up or down.
Raises or lowers the seat.
140
Increases or decreases the lumbar support. (Driver’s seat only)
07/07/09 09:40:34 31STX610 0146
Seats Head Restraints
FRONT
See page 14 for important safety information and a warning about improperly positioning head restraints.
CUSHION
SEATBACK
LEGS
They are most effective when you adjust them so the center of the back of the occupant’s head rests against the center of the restraint.
RELEASE BUTTON
Adjusting the Head Restraint
The head restraints adjust for height. You need both hands to adjust the restraint. Do not attempt to adjust it while driving. To raise it, pull upward. To lower the restraint, push the release button sideways, and push the restraint down.
CONTINUED
141
Instruments and Controls
Your vehicle is equipped with head restraints in all seating positions to help protect you and your passengers from whiplash and other injuries.
07/07/09 09:40:40 31STX610 0147
Seats SECOND CENTER AND THIRD ROW CUSHION
When reinstalling a head restraint, put the legs back in place. Then adjust it to the appropriate height while pressing the release button. Make sure the head restraint locks in position when you reinstall it.
LEGS
RELEASE BUTTON
Removing the Head Restraint
To remove a head restraint for cleaning or repair, pull it up as far as it will go. Push the release button, then pull the restraint out of the seatback.
142
Failure to reinstall the head restraints can result in severe injury during a crash. Always replace the head restraints before driving.
07/07/09 09:40:49 31STX610 0148
Seats Active Head Restraints
This reduces the distance between the restraint and the occupant’s head. It also helps protect the occupants against whiplash and injuries to the neck and upper spine.
The driver’s and front passenger’s seats have active head restraints. If the vehicle is struck severely from the rear, the occupant properly secured with the seat belt will be pushed against the seat-back and the head restraint will automatically move forward.
If the restraints do not return to their normal position, or in the event of a severe collision, have the vehicle inspected by an Acura dealer.
Do not hang any items on the head restraints, or from the restraint legs. Do not place any object between an occupant and the seat-back. Install each restraint in its proper location. Only use genuine Acura replacement head restraints.
CONTINUED
143
Instruments and Controls
After a collision, the activated restraint should return to its normal position.
For a head restraint system to work properly:
07/07/09 09:40:59 31STX610 0149
Seats Adjusting the Second Row Seats
Folding the Second Row Seats The left and right halves can be folded separately. 1. To unlatch the detachable anchor before folding the seat-back, insert the latch plate into the slot on the side of the anchor buckle (see page 146 ) and allow the seat belt to retract. Store the detachable anchor and seat belt latch plates in the retractor housing.
HANDLE
To change the seat-back angle of the seats in the second row, pull up on the handle on the outside of the seatback, and push the seat-back. Overall, the seat-back has six different positions.
144
2. Lower the head restraints to their lowest positions. 3. Pull up the handle on the outside of the seat-back. 4. Fold the seat-back forward. Reverse this procedure to return the seat to the upright position. Make sure the seat is locked securely before driving.
Make sure that the folded seat-back does not press against the front passenger’s seat, as this could cause the weight sensors to work improperly.
07/07/09 09:41:08 31STX610 0150
Seats Third Row Access
Folding the Third Row Seat 1. Use the latch plate to release the seat belt from the detachable anchor (see page 146 ).
NOTE: To fold the third row seat, the second row seat-back must be folded down or in the full up right position. RELEASE LEVER
To get into the third row seats, pull up the lever on the side of the passenger’s side second row seatback. The seat-back will tilt forward, and then can be slid forward. After you return the seat-back to the upright position, push the whole seat backwards until it latches. Make sure the seat is fully latched before sitting in it.
THIRD SEAT
HANDLE
3. Unlock the seat-back by pulling the handle. Push the seat-back forward. Make sure the outer shoulder belts are positioned on each hook on the side panel whenever the third seat is folded.
CONTINUED
145
Instruments and Controls
2. Lower the head restraints to their lowest positions.
07/07/09 09:41:15 31STX610 0151
Seats Reverse this procedure to return the seat to the upright position. Make sure the seat is locked securely before driving. Reconnect the seat belts to the detachable anchors.
Detachable Anchor
Make sure all items in the cargo area are secured. Loose items can fly forward and cause injury if you have to brake hard (See Carrying Cargo on page 332 ).
Using a seat belt with the detachable anchor unlatched increases the chance of serious injury or death in a crash. LATCH PLATE
The seat belts in the second row center seat and the third row seats are equipped with detachable anchors. To unlatch the detachable anchor, insert the latch plate into the slot on the side of the anchor buckle. Store the detachable anchor and seat belt latch plates in the retractor housing.
146
When the seats are returned to the upright position, these detachable anchors should be latched back properly.
Before using the seat belt, make sure the detachable anchor is correctly latched.
07/07/09 09:41:23 31STX610 0152
Seats SECOND ROW CENTER SEAT
THIRD ROW SEATS
SMALL LATCH PLATE
LATCH PLATE
HOOK SMALL LATCH PLATE
Pull out the small latch plate and the latch plate from each holding slot in the ceiling, and pull out the seat belt to extend it.
ANCHOR BUCKLE
Pull out the outer shoulder belts from the hook. Both of the third-row hooks should only be used when the seat belt is detached.
Line up the triangle marks on the small latch plate and anchor buckle when reattaching the belt and buckle. Tug on the seat belt to verify that the detachable anchor is securely latched. Make sure the seat belt is not twisted.
147
Instruments and Controls
TRIANGLE MARKS
07/07/09 09:41:30 31STX610 0153
Seat Heaters
Passenger’s Seat HI
HEATERS
Driver’s Seat
Both front seats are equipped with seat heaters. Because of the sensors for the side airbag cutoff system, there is no heater in the passenger’s seat-back. The ignition switch must be in the ON (II) position to use the heaters.
148
Front seat
LOW
Push the front of the switch, HI, to rapidly heat up the seat. After the seat reaches a comfortable temperature, select LO by pushing the back of the switch. This will keep the seat warm.
Second row seat
U.S. Entertainment Packages and Canadian models
The outer second row seat cushions and seat-backs are equipped with seat heaters. Turning the switch on the driver side warms the outer seat behind the driver’s seat only. The passenger side switch warms the outer seat behind the front passenger seat.
07/07/09 09:41:40 31STX610 0154
Seat Heaters, Power Windows In the HI setting, the heater turns off when the seat gets warm, and turns back on after the seat’s temperature drops.
Power Windows DRIVER’S WINDOW SWITCH
MAIN SWITCH
Closing a power window on someone’s hands or fingers can cause serious injury.
Follow these precautions when using the seat heaters: Use the HI setting only to heat the seats quickly, because it draws large amounts of current from the battery. If the engine is left idling for an extended period, do not use the seat heaters even on the LO setting. It can weaken the battery, causing hard starting.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position to raise or lower any window. To open a window, push the switch down and hold it. Release the switch when you want the window to stop. Pull back on the switch and hold it to close the window.
Make sure your passengers are away from the windows before closing them. AUTO − To open either front window fully, push the window switch firmly down to the second detent, then release it. The window automatically goes down all the way. To stop the window from going all the way down, pull back on the window switch briefly. CONTINUED
149
Instruments and Controls
In the LO setting, the heater runs continuously. It does not cycle with temperature changes.
The windows will operate for up to 10 minutes after you turn off the ignition switch. Opening either front door cancels this function.
07/07/09 09:41:47 31STX610 0155
Power Windows To close either front window fully, pull back the window switch firmly to the second detent, then release it. The window automatically goes all the way up. To stop the window from going all the way up, push down on the window switch briefly.
AUTO REVERSE − If either front window senses any obstacle while it is closing automatically, it will reverse direction and then stop. To close the window, remove the obstacle, then use the window switch again.
When you push the MAIN switch in, the switch is off, and the passengers’ windows cannot be raised or lowered. To cancel this feature, push on the switch again to get it to pop out. Keep the MAIN switch pushed in when you have children in the vehicle so they do not injure themselves by operating the windows unintentionally.
Auto reverse stops sensing when the window is almost closed. You should always check that all passengers and objects are away from the window before closing it.
150
If your vehicle’s battery is disconnected or goes dead, or the driver’s window fuse is removed, the AUTO function may be disabled. If the AUTO function is disabled, the power window system will need to be reset after reconnecting the battery or installing the fuse. 1. Start the engine. Push down and hold the driver’s window switch until the window is fully open. 2. Pull and hold the driver’s window switch to close the window completely, then hold the switch for about 2 seconds. If the power windows do not operate properly after resetting, have your vehicle checked by your dealer.
07/07/09 09:42:01 31STX610 0156
Power Windows
2. Press the UNLOCK button a second time, and hold it. All the doors unlock, and all four windows and moonroof start to open. To stop the windows and moonroof, release the button. 3. To open the windows and moonroof further, press the button again (within 10 seconds of step 1) and hold it. If the windows and the moonroof stop before the desired position, repeat steps 1 and 2. You cannot close the windows or the moonroof with the remote transmitter.
Opening/Closing the Windows and Moonroof with the Key
3. Turn the key clockwise again, and hold it. All four windows and the moonroof start to open. To stop the windows and the moonroof, release the key. 4. To open the windows and the moonroof further, turn and hold the key again (within 10 seconds of step 2). To close: 1. Insert the key in the driver’s door lock.
You can open and close the windows and moonroof with the key in the driver’s door lock. To open: 1. Insert the key in the driver’s door lock. 2. Turn the key clockwise, then release it.
2. Turn the key counterclockwise, then release it. 3. Turn the key counterclockwise again, and hold it. All four windows and the moonroof start to close. To stop the windows and the moonroof, release the key. CONTINUED
151
Instruments and Controls
Opening the Windows and Moonroof with the Remote Transmitter You can open all of the windows and the moonroof from outside with the remote transmitter. 1. Press the UNLOCK button once to unlock the driver’s door.
07/07/09 09:42:09 31STX610 0157
Power Windows, Moonroof 4. To close the windows and the moonroof further, turn and hold the key again (within 10 seconds of step 2).
Moonroof
To close the moonroof fully, firmly push the moonroof switch forward, then release it. The moonroof automatically closes all the way. To stop the moonroof from closing, push the switch briefly.
Auto reverse does not work when closing the windows and moonroof with the key. NOTE: If the windows and the moonroof stop before the desired position, repeat steps 2 and 3. MOONROOF SWITCH
To open the moonroof fully, pull back the moonroof switch firmly. The moonroof opens all the way. To stop the moonroof from opening fully, push the switch briefly.
152
To tilt up the moonroof, push on the center of the moonroof switch. To stop the moonroof from tilting up fully, push the switch briefly.
To open or close the moonroof partially, pull back or push forward the moonroof switch lightly and hold it. The moonroof will stop when you release the switch.
07/07/09 09:42:18 31STX610 0158
Moonroof, Parking Brake You can open and close the moonroof for up to 10 minutes after you turn off the ignition switch. Opening either front door cancels this function.
Auto reverse stops sensing when the moonroof is almost closed. You should always check that all passengers and objects are away from the moonroof before closing it.
If you try to open the moonroof in below-f reezing temperatures, or when it is covered with snow or ice, you can damage the moonroof panel or its motor.
Opening or closing the moonroof on someone’s hands or fingers can cause serious injury. Make sure all hands and fingers are clear of the moonroof before opening or closing it.
Parking Brake RELEASE HANDLE
PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
To apply the parking brake, push the pedal down with your foot. To release it, pull the release handle fully. The parking brake indicator on the instrument panel should go out when the parking brake is fully released (see page 65 ). You will also see a ‘‘RELEASE PARKING BRAKE’’ message on the multi-information display (see page CONTINUED 81 ).
153
Instruments and Controls
Auto Reverse If the moonroof runs into any obstacle while it is closing automatically, it will reverse direction, and then stop. To close the moonroof, remove the obstacle, then use the moonroof switch again.
07/07/09 09:42:24 31STX610 0159
Parking Brake, Mirrors
Driving the vehicle with the parking brake applied can damage the rear brakes and axles. A beeper will sound if the vehicle is driven with the parking brake on.
Mirrors Keep the inside and outside mirrors clean and adjusted for best visibility. Be sure to adjust the mirrors before you start driving.
SENSOR INDICATOR AUTO BUTTON
The inside mirror can automatically darken to reduce glare. To turn on this feature, press the button on the bottom of the mirror. The AUTO indicator comes on as a reminder. When it is on, the mirror darkens when it senses the headlights of a vehicle behind you, then returns to normal visibility when the lights are gone. Press the button again to turn off this feature.
154
07/07/09 09:42:31 31STX610 0160
Mirrors Adjusting the Power Mirrors SELECTOR SWITCH
4. When you finish, move the selector switch to the center (off) position. This turns the adjustment switch off to keep your settings.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. 2. Move the selector switch to L (driver’s side) or R (passenger’s side).
155
Instruments and Controls
There is also a sensor on the back of the mirror. Items hung on the mirror may block this sensor and af f ect its perf ormance.
3. Push the appropriate edge of the adjustment switch to move the mirror right, left, up, or down.
07/07/09 09:42:38 31STX610 0161
Mirrors Reverse Tilt Door Mirror Both outside door mirrors have a reverse tilt feature. When in reverse, the selected mirror will tilt down slightly to improve your view as you parallel park. Shifting out of reverse will return the mirrors to their original position.
Heated Mirrors HEATED MIRROR BUTTON
To tilt the driver’s mirror, place the selector switch in the left position. To tilt the passenger’s mirror, place the switch in the right position. To turn the feature off, place the switch in the center position. Outside mirror positions can be stored in the driving position memory system (see page 157 ).
156
The outside mirrors are heated to remove fog and frost. With the ignition switch in the ON (II) position, turn on the heaters by pressing the button. The indicator in the button comes on as a reminder. Press the button again to turn the heaters off. Pressing this button also turns the rear window defogger on and off.
07/07/09 09:42:47 31STX610 0162
Driving Position Memory System Your vehicle has a memory feature for the steering wheel, driver’s seat, and outside mirror positions.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. You cannot add a new driving position to the memory unless the ignition switch is in the ON (II) position. You can recall a memorized position with the ignition switch in any position. 2. Adjust the seat to a comfortable position (see page 140 ). Adjust the steering wheel to a comfortable position (see page 124). Adjust the outside mirrors for best visibility (see page 155 ).
MEMORY BUTTONS
MEMO BUTTON
3. Press and release the MEMO button on the control panel. You will hear a beep. Immediately press and hold one of the memory buttons (1 or 2) until you hear two beeps. The indicator in the memory button will come on. The current positions of the driver’s seat, steering wheel, and outside mirrors are now stored. CONTINUED
157
Instruments and Controls
Seat, except for power lumbar, steering wheel and outside mirror positions can be stored in separate memories. You select a memorized position by pushing the appropriate button or using the appropriate remote transmitter (Driver 1 or Driver 2). For more information see page 139 .
Storing a Driving Position in Memory Store a driving position only when the vehicle is parked.
07/07/09 09:42:58 31STX610 0163
Driving Position Memory System Doing any of the following after pressing the MEMO button will cancel the storing procedure. Not pressing a memory button within 5 seconds. Readjusting the seat position. Readjusting the outside mirror position. Each memory button stores only one driving position. Storing a new position erases the previous setting stored in that button’s memory. If you want to add a new position while retaining the current one, use the other memory button.
158
Selecting a Memorized Position To select a memorized position, do this: 1. Make sure the vehicle is parked. 2. Press the desired memory button (1 or 2) until you hear a beep, then release the button. The system will move the seat, steering wheel, and outside mirrors to the memorized positions. The indicator in the selected memory button will flash during movement. When the adjustments are complete, you will hear two beeps, and the indicator will remain on. To change the ‘‘MEMORY POSITION LINK’’ setting, see page 98 .
To stop the system’s automatic adjustment, do any of these actions: Press any button on the control panel: MEMO, 1, or 2. Push any of the adjustment switches for the seat. Shift out of Park. Adjust the outside mirrors. If desired, you can use the adjustment switches to change the positions of the seat, steering wheel or outside mirrors after they are in their memorized position. If you change the memorized position, the indicator in the memory button will go out. To keep this driving position for later use, you must store it in the driving position memory.
07/07/09 09:43:10 31STX610 0164
Interior Lights Light Control Switch DOOR ACTIVATED POSITION
The individual map lights in the second row and the cargo area light in the third row cannot be turned on.
To change the ‘‘INTERIOR LIGHT DIMMING TIME’’ setting, see page 101 .
ON
The light control switch has three positions: OFF, Door Activated, and ON. When the switch is in the OFF position:
The individual door lights or the tailgate lights will operate when a door or the tailgate is opened.
The individual map lights in the front can be turned on and off by pressing the lenses.
The individual map lights in the front and second rows come on when any door or the tailgate is opened, or when the remote transmitter is used to unlock the doors (see page 136 ). When the doors and the tailgate are closed, each light can be turned on and off by pushing the lens. The cargo area light comes on when any door or the tailgate is opened if the light control switch is in the door activated (center) position. When the doors and the tailgate are closed, the cargo area light can be turned on with the switch in the light.
With any door or the tailgate left open, the lights stay on about 3 minutes, then go out. The lights also come on when the key is removed from the ignition switch.
CONTINUED
159
Instruments and Controls
When the switch is in the door activated position:
OFF
After all doors are closed tightly, the lights dim slightly, then fade out in about 30 seconds.
07/07/09 09:43:17 31STX610 0165
Interior Lights When the light control switch is in the
ON position:
Individual Map Lights FRONT
All the individual map lights come on and stay on as long as the switch remains in the ON position. The cargo (3rd row) area light comes on if the switch is in the door activated position. COURTESY LIGHT
Turn on the front row individual map lights by pushing the lens. Push the lens again to turn it off. With the light control switch in the door activated position, the second row map lights can be turned on by pushing the lens. Push the lens again to turn it off.
160
The courtesy light between the map lights comes on when you turn the parking lights on. To adjust its brightness, press either of the instrument panel brightness control buttons (+ or −).
07/07/09 09:43:24 31STX610 0166
Interior Lights Cargo Area Light
OFF
Individual Interior Lights The courtesy lights in all four doors come on when you open any door. The light around the ignition switch comes on when any door is opened. After you close the door, the ignition switch light stays on for about 30 seconds regardless of the interior light dimming time setting (see page 101 ).
The cargo area light has a threeposition switch. In the OFF position, the light does not come on. In the center position, it comes on when you open the tailgate. In the ON position, it stays on continuously.
161
Instruments and Controls
ON
Tailgate Lights The lights in the tailgate have an onoff switch to control if the lights come on when the tailgate is opened. The tailgate lights do not come on when any other doors are opened.
07/07/09 18:13:22 31STX610 0167
Interior Convenience Items
SUNGLASSES HOLDER SUN VISOR
COAT HOOK
VANITY MIRROR
STORAGE COMPARTMENTS GROCERY HOOK
GLOVE BOX
CENTER POCKET
ACCESSORY POWER SOCKET
CONSOLE COMPARTMENT ARMREST/BEVERAGE HOLDER
162
BEVERAGE HOLDER ACCESSORY POWER SOCKET
07/07/09 09:43:36 31STX610 0168
Interior Convenience Items Beverage Holders Be careful when you are using the beverage holders. A spilled liquid that is very hot can scald you or your passengers. Liquid can also spill from the door pocket beverage holders when you open or close the doors. Use only resealable containers in the door pockets.
Open the front beverage holder by sliding the lid.
ARMREST
The center seat-back in the second is equipped with an armrest that provides the beverage holder. Pivot down the seat-back to use them.
BEVERAGE HOLDER
To open the beverage holder, press and release the front lid. To close, press the lid again until it latches. When you put back the armrest in the center seat-back, make sure the lid is closed properly.
163
Instruments and Controls
Spilled liquids can damage the upholstery, carpeting, and electrical components in the interior.
FRONT LID
07/07/09 09:43:45 31STX610 0169
Interior Convenience Items Console Compartment
Storage Compartment
Glove Box Open the glove box by pulling the handle to the left. Close it with a firm push. Lock or unlock the glove box with the master key.
LIDS
BUTTONS
LID
Your vehicle is equipped with a front seat armrest pad that is also a console compartment. To open the console compartment fully, push both buttons at the front of the compartment.
164
The storage compartment with a sliding lid is at the left-side foot of the front passenger seat. For the third row, a storage compartment is located in the passenger side armrest. To open the compartment, push the button and lift the lid.
An open glove box can cause serious injury to your passenger in a crash, even if the passenger is wearing the seat belt. Always keep the glove box closed while driving.
07/07/09 09:43:52 31STX610 0170
Interior Convenience Items Sunglasses Holder
Cargo Hooks
SUNGLASSES HOLDER
To open the sunglasses holder, push then release the raised detent. It will unlatch and swing down. To close it, push it until it latches. Make sure the holder is closed while you are driving.
Some larger styles of sunglasses may not fit in the holder. You may also store small items in this holder. Make sure they are small enough to let the holder close and latch, and that they are not heavy enough to cause the holder to pop open while driving.
The hooks on the floor of the cargo area enable you to tie down items stored in the back. Make sure all stored items are secured before driving.
165
Instruments and Controls
HOOK PUSH
07/07/09 09:44:01 31STX610 0171
Interior Convenience Items Sun Visor
Vanity Mirror
Slide
SUN VISOR
To use the sun visor, pull it down. When using the sun visor for the side window, remove the support rod from the clip, and swing it out. In this position, the sun visor can be adjusted by moving it on its slider. Do not use the extended sun visor over the inside mirror. Make sure you put the sun visor back in place when you are getting into or out of the vehicle.
166
To use the vanity mirror on the back of the sun visor, pull up the cover. The vanity mirror light will not come on if the sun visor is slid outward.
Accessory Power Sockets Your vehicle has two or three accessory power sockets, depending on the model. All models have the front accessory power socket under the audio system and rear socket behind the third row seat on the driver’s side.
07/07/09 09:44:09 31STX610 0172
Interior Convenience Items Each socket is intended to supply power for 12 volt DC accessories that are rated 120 watts or less (10 amps).
AC Power Outlet
MDX, Technology, and U.S. Sport Packages models
The accessory power socket is located at the back of the front console compartment.
To use an accessory power socket, the ignition switch must be in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position.
Instruments and Controls
None of the sockets will power an automotive type cigarette lighter element.
U.S. Entertainment Packages and Canadian Elite Package models
There is a 115 volt AC power outlet inside the front console compartment. To use the AC power outlet, open the lids and open the outlet cover. Insert the plug into the receptacle slightly, turn it 90° clockwise, then push in the plug all the way. CONTINUED
167
07/07/09 09:44:13 31STX610 0173
Interior Convenience Items Always run the engine when you use the AC power outlet. The maximum capacity for this power outlet is 115 volt AC at 100 watts or less. If you use an appliance which requires more than 100 watts, it automatically stops supplying the power. If this happens, turn the ignition switch off and turn it on again.
168
NOTE: The AC power outlet is not designed for electric appliances which require high initial peak wattage such as cathode-ray tube type televisions, refrigerators, electric pumps, etc. It is also not suitable for devices that process precise data such as medical equipment or measuring instruments. Any appliances that require an extremely stable power supply such as microcomputer-controlled electric blankets, touch sensor lamps, etc., should not be connected to this outlet.
07/07/09 09:44:19 31STX610 0174
Features The climate control system in your vehicle provides a comfortable driving environment in all weather conditions.
Your vehicle has an anti-theft audio system that requires a code number to enable it.
HomeLink Universal Transceiver................................. 276 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink ........ 280 AcuraLink ....................................... 308 Rearview Camera and Monitor .... 320 Features
The standard audio system has many features. This section describes those features and how to use them.
Climate Control System ................ 170 Rear Climate Controls............... 175 Audio System ................................. 180 Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models without navigation system) ................................... 181 Playing the XM Satellite Radio .. 185 Playing Discs .................................. 190 Disc Changer Error Messages .... 199 Audio System (Models with navigation system) .................... 200 Playing the AM/FM Radio ........... 201 AM/FM Radio Reception ............. 205 Playing the XM Satellite Radio .. 210 Playing Discs .................................. 218 Disc Changer Error Messages .... 228 Protecting Your Discs ................... 229 Auxiliary Input Jack ....................... 232 Remote Audio Controls................. 233 Radio Theft Protection.................. 235 Setting the Clock and Calendar ... 236 Rear Entertainment System ......... 237 Security System ............................. 269 Cruise Control ................................ 270 Compass.......................................... 273
169
07/07/09 09:44:27 31STX610 0175
Climate Control System FRONT CONTROL PANEL
OFF BUTTON
AUTO BUTTON
DRIVER’S SIDE TEMPERATURE AUTO INDICATOR
FRONT PASSENGER’S SIDE TEMPERATURE FAN CONTROL BUTTONS
DRIVER’S SIDE TEMPERATURE CONTROL BUTTONS
FRONT PASSENGER’S SIDE TEMPERATURE CONTROL BUTTONS
DUAL BUTTON REAR BUTTON WINDSHIELD DEFROSTER BUTTON
REAR CONTROL PANEL
RECIRCULATION BUTTON REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER/HEATED MIRROR BUTTON
REAR PASSENGER COMPARTMENT TEMPERATURE
AUTO SYNC INDICATOR
REAR PASSENGER COMPARTMENT TEMPERATURE CONTROL BUTTONS
FAN CONTROL BUTTONS
AUTO BUTTON
MODE BUTTON OFF BUTTON
170
MODE BUTTON AIR CONDITIONING BUTTON
07/07/09 09:44:37 31STX610 0176
Climate Control System Using Automatic Climate Control The automatic climate control system in your vehicle picks the proper combination of air conditioning, heating, and ventilation to maintain the interior temperature you select. The system also adjusts the fan speed and airflow levels.
Voice Control System
1. Press the Auto button on the front control panel.
On vehicles with navigation system
The climate control system can also be operated by voice control. See the Navi section in your quick start guide for an overview of this system, and the navigation system manual for complete details.
2. Set the desired temperature with the temperature control buttons. You will see AUTO in the system’s display. 3. You can set the driver’s side temperature, the passenger’s side temperature, and the temperature of the rear passenger compartment separately.
The system automatically selects the proper mix of conditioned and/or heated air that will, as quickly as possible, raise or lower the interior temperature to your preference. Temperature Control
The driver’s side temperature, the passenger’s side temperature and the rear passenger compartment temperature can be set separately. Press the ▲ button of the appropriate temperature control to increase the temperature of airflow. Press the ▼ button to decrease it. Each set temperature is shown in the display. The rear temperature is shown in the display on the back of the center console.
CONTINUED
171
Features
Personalization Setting When you unlock the doors with your remote, the driver’s ID (Driver 1 or Driver 2) is detected, and the climate control settings are turned to the respective mode automatically when the ignition is turned to the ON (II) position.
07/07/09 09:44:46 31STX610 0177
Climate Control System When you set the temperature to its lower limit ( ) or its upper limit ( ), the system runs at full cooling or heating only. It does not regulate the interior temperature. When you press a fan control button, the fan is taken out of AUTO mode. When the indicator in the dual button is on, the driver’s side and passenger’s side temperature can be controlled independently (see page 177 ). When the indicator in the rear button is on, the temperature of the rear passenger compartment can be controlled independently (see page 177 ). On vehicles with navigation system
In the Auto mode, the vehicle’s interior temperature is independently regulated for the driver, front passenger, and rear
172
passengers according to each adjusted temperature. The system also regulates each temperature based on the information of the sun light sensor and the sun position which is updated automatically by the navigation’s global positioning system (GPS). For example, if the driver’s side of the vehicle getting too much sun, the system will adjust to a lower temperature. Dual Button
You can set the temperatures for the driver’s side and the passenger’s side separately when this button is pressed (indicator is on). When the indicator in the DUAL button is off, the temperatures for both sides are synchronized to the driver’s side set temperature. When defrost mode is selected, dual mode operation is canceled.
Rear Button
When you press this button, the indicator in the button comes on, and the temperature of the rear passenger compartment can be adjusted separately with the temperature control buttons on the back of the center console. With the indicator off, the temperature of the rear passenger compartment is synchronized to the driver’s side set temperature. You will see the AUTO SYNC on the system display of the rear control panel. Changing the temperature of the rear passenger compartment also makes the indicator to turn on, and takes the system out of synchronized mode. This causes the word SYNC in the display to go out.
07/07/09 09:44:58 31STX610 0178
Climate Control System To Turn Everything Off If you press the OFF button, the climate control system shuts off completely. Keep the system completely off for short periods only.
Fan Control ▲ button to increase Press the the fan speed and airflow. Press the ▼ button to decrease it. Air Conditioning (A/C) Button
This button turns the air conditioning on and off. You will see A/C ON or A/C OFF in the display. When you turn the A/C off, the system cannot regulate the inside temperature if you set the temperature control below the outside temperature.
Recirculation Button
When the indicator in the button is on, air from the vehicle’s interior is sent throughout the system again. When the indicator is off, air is brought in from the outside of the vehicle (fresh air mode). The outside air intakes for the climate control system are at the base of the windshield. Keep this area clear of leaves and other debris. The system should be left in fresh air mode under almost all conditions. Keeping the system in recirculation mode, particularly with the A/C off, can cause the windows to fog up. Switch to recirculation mode when driving through dusty or smoky conditions, then return to fresh air mode.
173
Features
To keep stale air and mustiness from collecting, you should have the fan running at all times.
Semi-automatic Operation You can manually select various functions of the climate control system when it is in fully automatic mode. All other features remain automatically controlled. Making any manual selection causes the word AUTO in the display to go out.
07/07/09 09:45:11 31STX610 0179
Climate Control System Rear Window Defogger Button
This button turns the rear window defogger off and on (see page 122 ). Pushing this button also turns the power mirror heaters on and off. Mode Control
Use the mode control button to select the vents the air flows from. Some air will flow from the dashboard vents in all modes. Air flows from the center and corner vents in the dashboard. Airflow is divided between the vents in the dashboard and the floor vents. vents.
174
Air flows from the floor
Airflow is divided between the floor and corner vents and the defroster vents at the base of the windshield. Windshield Defroster Button
This button directs the main airflow to the windshield for faster defrosting. It also overrides any mode selection you may have made. When you select , the system automatically switches to fresh air mode and turns on the A/C. For faster defrosting, manually set the fan speed to high. You can also increase airflow to the windshield by closing the corner vents on the dashboard. To close the vents, rotate the wheel under each corner vent. When you turn off by pressing the button again, the system returns to its former settings.
For your safety, make sure you have a clear view through all the windows before driving. When the indicator in the button is on, the front passenger’s and rear passenger compartment temperatures cannot be set separately from the driver’s.
07/07/09 09:45:18 31STX610 0180
Climate Control System Rear Climate Controls REAR CONTROL PANEL
REAR PASSENGER COMPARTMENT TEMPERATURE FAN CONTROL BUTTONS
AUTO BUTTON REAR BUTTON
Rear Button
When the indicator in this button is off, the temperature of the rear passenger compartment is synchronized to the driver’s side set temperature. If the AUTO mode is selected on the front control panel, you will see the AUTO SYNC on the rear system display. When the indicator in this button is on, the temperature of the rear passenger compartment can be adjusted with
the rear temperature control buttons. A passenger can also adjust the fan speed and airflow.
MODE BUTTON OFF BUTTON
You can use the rear control panel when the indicator in the REAR button on the front control panel is on. Pressing any control button on the rear control panel turns on the rear button indicator on the front control panel.
CONTINUED
175
Features
REAR PASSENGER COMPARTMENT TEMPERATURE CONTROL BUTTONS
07/07/09 09:45:29 31STX610 0181
Climate Control System Temperature Control
Press the ▲ temperature control button to increase the temperature of airflow, and the ▼ button to decrease it. The temperature you adjust is shown in the system display.
Fan Control
Press the ▲ fan control button to increase the fan speed and airflow. ▼ button to Press the decrease it. The level of the fan speed is shown in the display. Mode Control
Each time you press the mode button, the mode display changes from to . When is selected, air flows from the upper vents on the back of the center console. When is selected, air flows from the lower vents.
176
Automatic Operation
Pressing the AUTO button puts the system in automatic operation mode. The rear system automatically adjusts the fan speed and airflow levels to maintain the selected temperature of the rear passenger compartment. You will see AUTO in the display. Pressing the OFF button shuts off the rear climate control system.
07/07/09 09:45:36 31STX610 0182
Climate Control System Triple Zone Temperature Control The temperatures of the driver’s side and the front passenger’s side can be controlled independently when the indicator in the DUAL button is on.
Driver’s Side
Passenger’s Side
Features
When the indicator in the REAR button is on, the temperature of the rear passenger compartment can be controlled independently. To adjust each temperature, press either of the temperature control buttons (▲or▼) on the climate control panel.
Rear Passenger Compartment
CONTINUED
177
07/07/09 09:45:42 31STX610 0183
Climate Control System Push AUTO or . The selected temperatures appear in the display. When the indicator in the DUAL button is off, you can adjust both sides to the same temperature by adjusting the driver’s temperature control buttons.
When the indicator in the REAR button is off, the temperature of the rear passenger compartment is synchronized to the driver’s side set temperature. You will see the AUTO SYNC on the system display of the rear control panel.
To set the driver’s side temperature to a different value than the passenger’s side, press the DUAL button, then press either of the driver’s temperature control button (▲or▼). To set the passenger’s side to a different value than the driver’s side, press either of the front passenger’s temperature control button (▲or▼). You can adjust the passenger’s side without pressing the DUAL button first.
To set the temperature of the rear passenger compartment to a different value than the driver’s side, press the REAR button, then press either temperature control buttons on the back of the center console. The word ‘‘SYNC’’ in the display goes out. You can also adjust the rear temperature without pressing the REAR button first. Pressing either button causes the indicator of the REAR button to turn on. When you set each temperature to its lower limit or its upper limit, it will be displayed as ‘‘ ’’ or ‘‘ ’’.
178
07/07/09 09:45:47 31STX610 0184
Climate Control System Sunlight and Temperature Sensors TEMPERATURE/HUMIDITY SENSOR
Features
SUNLIGHT SENSOR
To regulate the interior temperature and humidity, the climate control system has two sensors. A sunlight sensor is located in the top of the dashboard and a temperature/ humidity sensor is next to the steering column. Do not cover the sensors or, spill liquid or spray chemical cleaners on the sensors.
179
07/07/09 09:46:00 31STX610 0185
Audio System An audio system is standard on all models. Read the appropriate pages (as shown below) to use your vehicle’s audio system.
With navigation system
With rear entertainment system
For vehicles without navigation system, see pages 181 through 199 . For vehicles with navigation system, see pages 200 through 227 .
Without navigation system
180
07/07/09 09:46:07 31STX610 0186
Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models without navigation system)
Features
SEEK BUTTONS
AUTO SELECT BUTTON FM BUTTON SCAN BUTTON
TUNE KNOB
POWER/VOLUME KNOB AM BUTTON
PRESET BUTTONS
181
07/07/09 09:46:14 31STX610 0187
Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models without navigation system) To Play the Radio The ignition switch must be in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position. Turn the system on by pushing the power/volume knob or the AM or FM button. Adjust the volume by turning the power/volume knob. The band and frequency that the radio was last tuned to are displayed. To change bands, press the AM or FM button. On the FM band, ST will be displayed if the station is broadcasting in stereo. Stereo reproduction in AM is not available. On the AM band, AM noise reduction turns on automatically.
182
To Select a Station You can use any of five methods to find radio stations on the selected band: tune, seek, scan, the preset buttons, and auto select. TUNE − Use the TUNE knob to tune the radio to a desired frequency. Turn the knob right to tune to a higher frequency, or left to tune to a lower frequency. SEEK − The SEEK function searches up and down from the current frequency to find a station with a strong signal. To activate it, press the + or − SEEK button, then release it.
SCAN − The scan function samples all stations with strong signals on the selected band. To activate it, press the SCAN button, then release it. You will see SCAN in the display. The system will scan for a station with a strong signal. When it finds one, it will stop and play that station for about 10 seconds. If you do nothing, the system will scan for the next strong station and play it for 10 seconds. When it plays a station that you want to listen to, press the SCAN button again.
07/07/09 09:46:23 31STX610 0188
Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models without navigation system) Preset − Each preset button can store one frequency on AM and two frequencies on FM.
2. Use the tune, seek, or scan function to tune the radio to a desired station. 3. Pick a preset button, and hold it until you hear a beep. 4. Repeat steps 1 through 3 to store a total of six stations on AM and twelve stations on FM.
Press the A. SEL button. ‘‘A. SEL’’ flashes in the display, and the system goes into scan mode for several seconds. It stores the frequencies of six AM and twelve FM stations in the preset buttons. You will see a ‘‘0’’ displayed after pressing a preset button if auto select cannot find a strong station for that preset button.
To turn off auto select, press the A. SEL (auto select) button. This restores the presets you originally set.
The presets may be lost if your vehicle’s battery goes dead, is disconnected, or the radio fuse is removed. For information on AM/FM radio frequencies and reception, see page 205 .
If you do not like the stations auto select has stored, you can store other frequencies on the preset buttons as previously described.
183
Features
1. Select the desired band, AM or FM. FM1 and FM2 let you store two frequencies with each preset button.
AUTO SELECT − If you are traveling far from home and can no longer receive your preset stations, you can use the auto select feature to find stations in the local area.
07/07/09 09:46:35 31STX610 0189
Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models without navigation system) Adjusting the Sound Press the TUNE (SOUND) knob repeatedly to display the BASS, TREBLE, FADER, BALANCE, SUBWOOFER, and SVC (speedsensitive volume compensation) settings. BASS − Adjusts the bass. TREBLE − Adjusts the treble. FADER − Adjusts the front-to-back strength of the sound. BALANCE − Adjusts the side-toside strength of the sound. SUBWOOFER − Adjusts the strength of sound from the subwoofer speaker. CENTER − Adjusts the strength of sound from the center speaker.
184
SVC − Adjusts the volume level based on the vehicle speed.
choose low. If you feel the sound is too quiet, choose high.
Each mode is shown in the display as it changes. Turn the TUNE knob to adjust the setting to your liking. When the level reaches the center, you will see ‘‘C’’ in the display.
This function is set to MID as the default setting when the vehicle leaves the factory.
The system will return to the audio display about 5 seconds after you stop adjusting a mode. Speed-sensitive Volume Compensation (SVC)
The SVC mode controls the volume based on vehicle speed. The faster you go, the louder the audio volume becomes. As you slow down, the audio volume decreases. The SVC has four modes; SVC OFF, SVC LOW, SVC MID, and SVC HIGH. Turn the TUNE knob to adjust the setting to your liking. If you feel the sound is too loud,
Audio System Lighting You can use the instrument panel brightness control buttons to adjust the illumination of the audio system (see page123 ). The audio system illuminates when the parking lights are on, even if the radio is off.
07/07/09 09:46:42 31STX610 0190
Playing the XM Satellite Radio (Models without navigation system)
SCAN BUTTON TUNE KNOB
POWER/VOLUME KNOB
DISP/MODE BUTTON
PRESET BUTTONS
CONTINUED
185
Features
CATEGORY BUTTONS
XM RADIO BUTTON
07/07/09 18:13:33 31STX610 0191
Playing the XM Satellite Radio (Models without navigation system) Your vehicle is capable of receiving XM Satellite Radio anywhere in the United States, except Hawaii and Alaska. On Canadian models, you can also receive XM Satellite Radio in Canada. XM is a registered trademark of XM Satellite Radio, Inc. XM satellite radio receives signals from two satellites to produce clear, high-quality digital reception. It offers many channels in several categories. Along with a large selection of different types of music, XM satellite radio allows you to view channel and category selections in the display. Operating the Satellite Radio To listen to XM satellite radio, turn the ignition switch to the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position. Push the power/volume knob to turn on the audio system, and press the
186
button. The last channel you listened to will show in the display. Adjust the volume by turning the power/volume knob. MODE − To switch between channel mode and category mode, press and hold the DISP/MODE button until the mode changes. In the channel mode, you can select all of the available channels. In the category mode, such as Jazz, Rock, Classical, etc., you can select all of the channels within that category. Each time you press and release the DISP/MODE button, the display changes in the following sequence: channel name, channel number, category, artist name, and music title. You may experience periods when XM Radio does not transmit the artist’s name and song title information. If this happens, there is
nothing wrong with your system. TUNE − Turn the TUNE knob to change channel selections. Turn the knob right for higher numbered channels and left for lower numbered channels. In the category mode, you can only select channels within that category. CATEGORY (− or +) − Press either button to select another category.
07/07/09 09:47:03 31STX610 0192
Playing the XM Satellite Radio (Models without navigation system)
Preset − You can store up to 12 preset channels using the six preset buttons. Each button stores one channel from the XM1 band and one channel from the XM2 band. To store a channel: 1. Press the XM button. Either XM1 or XM2 will show in the display.
2. Use the TUNE knob, the CATEGORY buttons, or the SCAN buttons to tune to a desired channel.
The presets may be lost if your vehicle’s battery goes dead, is disconnected, or the radio fuse is removed.
In category mode, only channels within that category can be selected. In channel mode, all channels can be selected.
XM Radio Display Messages LOADING − XM is loading the audio or program information.
3. Pick the preset button you want for that channel. Press and hold the button until you hear a beep.
OFF AIR − The channel currently selected is no longer broadcasting.
4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 to store the first six channels.
UPDATING − The encryption code is being updated. Wait until the encryption code is fully updated. Channels 0 and 1 should still work normally.
5. Press the XM button again. The other XM band will show. Store the next six channels using steps 2 and 3. Once a channel is stored, simply press and release the proper preset button to tune to it.
CONTINUED
187
Features
SCAN − The SCAN function gives you a sampling of all channels while in the channel mode. In the category mode, only the stations within that category are scanned. To activate scan, press the SCAN button. The system plays each channel in numerical order for a few seconds, then selects the next channel. When you hear a channel you want to continue listening to, press the button again.
07/07/09 09:47:09 31STX610 0193
Playing the XM Satellite Radio (Models without navigation system) NOSIGNAL − The signal is currently too weak. Move the vehicle to an area away from tall buildings, and with an unobstructed view of the southern horizon.
Signal may be blocked by mountains or large obstacles to the south.
Signal weaker in these areas.
- - - - − The selected channel number does not exist, or is not part of your subscription, or this channel has no artist or title information at this time. ANTENNA − There is a problem with the XM antenna. Please consult your dealer.
SATELLITE
GROUND REPEATER
The XM satellites are in orbit over the equator; therefore, objects south of the vehicle may cause satellite reception interruptions. To help compensate for this, ground-based repeaters are placed in major metropolitan areas.
188
Satellite signals are more likely to be blocked by tall buildings and mountains the farther north you travel from the equator. Carrying large items on a roof rack can also block the signal.
07/07/09 09:47:20 31STX610 0194
Playing the XM Satellite Radio (Models without navigation system) Depending on where you drive, you may experience reception problems. Interference can be caused by any of these conditions:
There may be other geographic situations that could affect XM radio reception.
Receiving Satellite Radio Service If your XM Radio service has expired or you purchased your vehicle from a previous owner, you can listen to a sampling of the broadcasts available on XM Satellite Radio. With the ignition switch in the ACCESSORY (I) or the ON (II) position, push the power/volume knob to turn on the audio system, and press the button. A variety of music types and styles will play. If you decide to purchase XM satellite radio service, contact XM Radio at www.xmradio.com, or at 1-800-852-9696. In Canada, contact XM Canada at www.xmradio.ca, or at 1-877-438-9677. You will need to give them your radio I.D. number and
your credit card number. To get your radio I.D. number, turn the TUNE knob until ‘‘0’’ appears in the display. Your I.D. will appear in the display. After you’ve registered with XM Radio, keep your audio system in the Satellite Radio mode while you wait for activation. This should take about 30 minutes. While waiting for activation, make sure your vehicle remains in an open area with good reception. Once your audio system is activated, ‘‘CATEGORY’’ or ‘‘CH’’ will appear in the display, and you’ll be able to listen to XM Radio broadcasts. XM Radio will continue to send an activation signal to your vehicle for at least 12 hours from the activation request. If the service has not been activated after 36 hours, contact XM Radio.
189
Features
Driving on the north side of an east/west mountain road. Driving on the north side of a large commercial truck on an east/west road. Driving in tunnels. Driving on a road beside a vertical wall, steep cliff, or hill to the south of you. Driving on the lower level of a multi-tiered road. Driving on a single lane road alongside dense trees taller than 50 ft. (15 m) to the south of you. Large items carried on a roof rack.
As required by the FCC: Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.
07/07/09 18:13:42 31STX610 0195
Playing Discs (Models without navigation system)
TRACK/FILE NUMBER
MP3/WMA INDICATOR FOLDER NUMBER
DISC SLOT
SEEK BUTTONS
DISC LOAD BUTTON
DISC EJECT BUTTON
POWER/VOLUME KNOB
TUNE (FOLDER) KNOB PRESET BUTTONS
RANDOM BUTTON SCAN BUTTON
190
REPEAT BUTTON
07/07/09 09:47:37 31STX610 0196
Playing Discs (Models without navigation system) To Play a Disc To load or play discs, the ignition switch must be in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position.
Do not use discs with adhesive labels. The label can curl up and cause the disc to jam in the unit.
Video CDs and DVD discs do not work in this unit.
The specifications of the compatible WMA file are: Sampling frequency: 22.05/32/44.1/48 kHz Bit rate: 48/64/80/96/128/160/192 kbps Compatible with variable bit rate and multi-session Maximum layers (including ROOT): 8 layers
The specifications of the compatible MP3 file are: Sampling frequency: 32/44.1/48 kHz (MPEG1) 16/22.05/24 kHz (MPEG2) Bit rate: 32/40/48/56/64/80/96/ 112/128/160/192/224/256/320 kbps Compatible with variable bit rate and multi-session Maximum layers (including ROOT): 8 layers CONTINUED
191
Features
You operate the disc changer with the same controls used for the radio. To select the disc changer, press the DISC button. You will see ‘‘DISC’’ in the display. The disc and track numbers, and the elapsed time are shown in the display. You can also select the displayed information with the DISP button (see page 193 ). The system will continuously play a disc until you change modes.
This audio system can also play CD-Rs and CD-RWs compressed in MP3 or WMA formats. When playing a disc in MP3, you will see ‘‘MP3’’ in the display. In WMA format, ‘‘WMA’’ will appear in the display. The disc, folder and track numbers are displayed. You can select up to 255 folders or tracks.
07/07/09 09:47:46 31STX610 0197
Playing Discs (Models without navigation system) NOTE: If a file on an MP3 or WMA disc is protected by digital rights management (DRM), the audio unit displays CD FORMAT, and then skips to the next file.
Loading Discs
Your vehicle’s in-dash disc changer holds up to six discs. 1. Press the LOAD button until you hear a beep and see ‘‘LOAD’’ in the display. To load only one disc, press and release the LOAD button. 2. The disc number for an empty position begins blinking. 3. Insert the disc into the disc slot when the green disc load indicator comes on. Insert it only about halfway; the drive will pull it in the rest of the way. You will see ‘‘BUSY’’ in the display while the disc load indicator turns red and blinks as the disc is loaded.
192
You cannot load and play 3-inch (8-cm) discs in this unit. 4. When the disc load indicator turns green and ‘‘LOAD’’ appears in the display again, insert the next disc in the slot. Do not try to insert a disc until ‘‘LOAD’’ appears. You could damage the audio unit. 5. Repeat this until all six positions are loaded. If you are not loading all six positions, the system begins playing the last disc loaded. You can also load a disc into an empty position while a disc is playing by pressing the appropriate preset button. The system stops playing the current disc and starts the loading sequence. It then plays the disc just loaded.
07/07/09 09:47:57 31STX610 0198
Playing Discs (Models without navigation system) Text Data Display Function
Each time you press the DISP button, the display shows you the text data on a disc, if the disc was recorded with text data.
If you press and hold the DISP button again, the display shows the first 16 characters again.
With the folder name, you will see the FOLDER indicator in the display. The TRACK indicator is shown with the file or track name.
If any letter is not available, it is replaced with ‘‘ . ’’ (dot) in the display. When the disc has no text data, you will see ‘‘NO INFO’’ on the display.
When you press and release the DISP button while a disc without text data is playing, you will see ‘‘NO INFO’’ on the display.
You will also see some text data under these conditions:
The display shows up to about 16 characters of selected text data (the folder name, file name, etc.).
When you insert a disc, and the system begins to play. When playing a CD-DA with text data, the album and track name are shown in the display. With a disc in MP3 or WMA, the display shows the folder and file name. When you turn on the audio system next time, the system keeps your selection with the DISP button.
When a new folder, file, or track is selected. When you change the audio mode to play a disc with text data or in MP3 or WMA.
CONTINUED
193
Features
You can see the album, artist, and track name in the display. If a disc is recorded in MP3 or WMA, you can see the folder and file name, and the album, artist, and track tag.
If the text data has more than 16 characters, you will see the first 15 characters and the > indicator in the display. Press and hold the DISP button until the next 16 characters are shown. You can see up to about 31 characters of the text data.
07/07/09 09:48:05 31STX610 0199
Playing Discs (Models without navigation system) To Change or Select Tracks/Files
Use the seek buttons while a disc is playing to select passages and change tracks (files in MP3 or WMA mode). In MP3 or WMA mode, use the TUNE knob to select folders in the disc and use either seek button to change files. To select a different disc, use the appropriate preset buttons (1 through 6). If you select an empty position, the system will go into the loading sequence (see page 192 ). SEEK/SKIP − Each time you press and release the + seek button, the player skips forward to the beginning of the next track (file in MP3 or WMA mode). Press and release the − seek button to skip backward to the beginning of the current track. Press it again to skip to the beginning of the previous
194
track. To move rapidly within a track or file, press and hold the + or − seek button. In MP3 or WMA mode
FOLDER SELECTION − To select a different folder, turn the TUNE knob to move to the beginning of the next folder. Turn the knob to the right until it clicks once to skip to the next folder, and to the left to move to the beginning of the current folder. Turn it again to skip to the beginning of the previous folder. Turning the TUNE knob more than two clicks skips several folders.
REPEAT (Track Repeat) − To continuously replay a track (file in MP3 or WMA mode), press and release the RPT button. You will see RPT in the display. Press and hold the RPT button to turn it off. Pressing either seek button also turns off the repeat feature.
07/07/09 09:48:12 31STX610 0200
Playing Discs (Models without navigation system) In MP3 or WMA mode
DISC REPEAT − This feature continuously replays the current disc. To active disc repeat, press and release the RPT button repeatedly until you see D-RPT in the display. Press and hold the RPT button again to turn it off.
Each time you press and release the RPT button, the mode changes from file repeat to folder repeat, to disc repeat then to normal playing. RANDOM (Random within a disc) − This feature plays the tracks within a disc (the files in MP3 or WMA mode) in random order. To activate random play, press and release the RDM button. In MP3 or WMA mode, press the RDM button repeatedly to select RDM (within a disc random play). You will see RDM in the display. Press the RDM button for 2 seconds to return to normal play.
In MP3 or WMA mode
FOLDER RANDOM − This feature, when activated, plays the files within a current folder in random order, rather than in the order they are compressed in MP3 or WMA. To activate folder random play, press and release the RDM button repeatedly. You will see F-RDM in the display. The system will then select and play files randomly. This continues until you deactivate folder random play by pressing and holding the RDM button again, or you select a different folder with the TUNE knob. Each time you press and release the RDM button, the mode changes from folder random play, to within a disc random play, then to normal play.
195
Features
FOLDER REPEAT − This feature, when activated, replays all the files on the selected folder in the order they are compressed in MP3 or WMA. To activate folder repeat mode, press and release the RPT button repeatedly until you see F-RPT in the display. The system continuously replays the current folder. Press and hold the RPT button to turn it off. Pressing the RDM button, or selecting a different folder with the TUNE knob also turns off the repeat feature.
07/07/09 09:48:16 31STX610 0201
Playing Discs (Models without navigation system) SCAN − The SCAN function samples all the tracks on the disc in the order they are recorded on the disc (all files in the selected folder in MP3 or WMA mode). To activate the scan feature, press and release the SCAN button. You will see SCAN in the display. You will get a 10 second sampling of each track/file in the disc/folder. Press and hold the SCAN button to get out of scan mode and play the last track sampled.
196
In MP3 or WMA mode
F-SCAN − This feature, when activated, samples the first file in each folder on the disc in the order they are recorded. To activate the folder scan feature, press and release the SCAN button repeatedly. You will see F-SCAN in the display. The system will then play the first file in the main folders for about 10 seconds. If you do nothing, the system will then play the following first files for 10 seconds each. When it plays a file that you want to continue listening to, press and hold the SCAN button.
Pressing either seek button, or selecting a different disc (using the preset buttons) or folder (using the TUNE knob) turns off the SCAN or F-SCAN feature.
07/07/09 09:48:24 31STX610 0202
Playing Discs (Models without navigation system) When the first track in the last disc, or the first file in the last main folder in the last disc begins to play, the disc scan mode will be canceled. Pressing either seek button or selecting a different folder with the TUNE knob also turns off the scan feature. Each time you press and release the SCAN button, the mode changes from scan, disc scan, then to normal playing. In MP3 or WMA mode
Each time you press and release the SCAN button, the mode changes from file scan, folder scan, disc scan, then to normal playing.
To Stop Playing a Disc Press the eject button ( ) to remove the disc. If you eject the disc, but do not remove it from the slot, the system will automatically reload the disc after 10 seconds. To begin playing, press the DISC button. You can also eject the disc when the ignition switch is off. To play the radio when a disc is playing, press the AM or FM button. Press the DISC button again to switch back to the disc changer.
CONTINUED
197
Features
D-SCAN − This feature, when activated, samples the first track in each disc in order (the first file in the main folder on each disc in MP3 or WMA mode). To activate the disc scan feature, press and release the SCAN button repeatedly until D-SCAN shows in the display. The system will then play the first track/ file in the first main folder in the first disc for about 10 seconds. If you do nothing, the system will then play the following first tracks/files for 10 seconds each. When it plays a track/ file that you want to continue listening to, press and hold the SCAN button again.
07/07/09 09:48:31 31STX610 0203
Playing Discs (Models without navigation system) If you turn the system off while a disc is playing, either with the power/volume knob or by turning off the ignition switch, the disc will stay in the drive. When you turn the system back on, the disc will begin playing where it left off.
To remove a different disc from the changer, first select it with the appropriate preset button. When that disc begins playing, press the eject button. Continue pressing the eject button to remove all the discs from the changer.
Removing Discs from the In-dash Disc Changer
You can also eject discs when the ignition switch is off. The disc that was last selected is ejected first.
To remove the disc currently in play, press the eject button. When a disc is removed from a slot, the system automatically begins the load sequence so you can load another disc in that position. If you do not remove the disc from the changer within 10 seconds, the disc will reload into the slot. Then the system returns to the previous mode (AM, FM, or XM).
198
Protecting Discs For information on how to handle and protect compact discs, see page 229 .
07/07/09 09:48:38 31STX610 0204
Disc Changer Error Message (Models without navigation system) The chart on the right explains the error messages you may see in the display while playing a disc.
Error Massage HEAT ERROR
For the additional information on damaged discs, see page 230 . The audio system will try to play the disc. If there is still a problem, the error message will reappear. Press the eject button, and pull out the disc. Insert a different disc. If the new disc plays, there is a problem with the first disc. If the error message cycle repeats and you cannot clear it, take your vehicle to a dealer.
FORMAT BAD DISC − PLEASE CHECK OWNER’S MANUAL PUSH EJECT BAD DISC − PLEASE CHECK OWNER’S MANUAL
High temperature Track/File format not supported
Mechanical Error
Servo Error
Solution Will disappear when the temperature returns to normal. Current track will be skipped. The next supported track or file plays automatically. Press the EJECT button and pull out the disc(s). Check the disc for serious damage, signs of deformation, excessive scratches, and/or dirt (see page 230). Insert the disc again. If the code does not disappear, or the disc(s) cannot be removed, consult your dealer. Do not try to force the disc out of the player.
199
Features
If you see an error message in the display while playing a disc, press the eject button. After ejecting the disc, check it for damage or deformation. If there is no damage, insert the disc again.
Cause
07/07/09 09:48:47 31STX610 0205
Audio System (Models with navigation system) Interface Dial
On models with navigation system
Most audio system functions can still be controlled by standard buttons, dials, and knobs, but some functions can only be accessed using the interface dial. The interface dial has two parts, a knob and a selector. KNOB
ENTER
SELECTOR
200
The knob turns left and right. Use it to make selections or adjustments to a list or menu on the screen. The selector can be pushed left, right, up, down, and in. Use the selector to scroll through lists, to select menus, and to highlight menu items. When you make a selection, push the center of the selector (ENTER) to go to that selection.
Personalization Setting When you unlock the doors with your remote and turn the audio system on, the driver’s ID (Driver 1 or Driver 2) is detected, and the radio presets and sound level settings (see page 207 ) are turned to the respective memorized mode automatically. Voice Control System The audio system can also be operated by voice control. See the Navi section in your quick start guide for an overview of this system, and the navigation system manual for complete details.
07/07/09 09:48:57 31STX610 0206
Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models with navigation system)
Without rear entertainment system
With rear entertainment system
AUDIO DISPLAY
AUDIO DISPLAY AUTO SELECT BUTTON
SEEK BUTTONS
AM/FM BUTTON
AUTO SELECT BUTTON SEEK BUTTONS
SCAN BUTTON AM/FM BUTTON
TUNE KNOB
POWER/ VOLUME KNOB
PRESET BUTTONS
POWER/ VOLUME KNOB
TUNE KNOB
AUDIO BUTTON
AUDIO BUTTON
INTERFACE DIAL
INTERFACE DIAL
201
Features
SCAN BUTTON
PRESET BUTTONS
07/07/09 09:49:05 31STX610 0207
Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models with navigation system)
STEREO ICON
BAND
To Play the AM/FM Radio The ignition switch must be in the ACCESSORY (I) or the ON (II) position. Press the AUDIO button to view the audio control display. Turn the system on by pressing the power/volume knob or the AM/FM button. Adjust the volume by turning the power/volume knob.
202
The band and frequency that the radio was last tuned to are shown on the display. To change bands, press the AM/FM button. You can also change bands by pushing the interface selector up. Each time you push it up, the band will change to FM1, FM2, or AM. On the FM bands, STEREO will be shown on the navigation screen and ST on the audio display, if the station is broadcasting in stereo. Stereo reproduction on AM is not available. To Select a Station You can use any of five methods to find radio stations on the selected band: TUNE, SEEK, SCAN, the preset buttons, and AUTO SELECT .
TUNE ICON
TUNE − Use the TUNE knob to tune the radio to a desired frequency. Turn the knob right to tune to a higher frequency, or left to tune to a lower frequency. To tune with the interface dial, push the selector down, and turn the knob to TUNE. Then press ENTER on the selector, and turn the knob to the desired frequency. To exit the TUNE mode, press ENTER on the selector.
07/07/09 09:49:11 31STX610 0208
Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models with navigation system)
SCAN ICON
SCAN − The SCAN function samples all stations with strong signals on the selected band. To activate it, press the SCAN button, then release it.
To scan with the interface dial, push the selector down, and then push it to the right. You will see SCAN flashing on the screen. The system will scan for a station with a strong signal. When it finds one, it will stop and play that station for about 10 seconds. If you do nothing, the system will then scan for the next strong station and play it for 10 seconds. When it plays a station that you want to listen to, press the scan button again, or push the interface selector to the right again.
CONTINUED
203
Features
SEEK − The SEEK function searches up and down from the current frequency to find a station with a strong signal. To activate it, press the − or + SEEK button, then release it. You can also activate SEEK by pushing the interface selector to the right or left.
07/07/09 09:49:21 31STX610 0209
Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models with navigation system) Preset − Each preset button or preset icon can store one frequency on AM and two frequencies on FM.
AUTO SEL ICON
To store a preset memory location:
1. Select the desired band, AM or FM. FM1 and FM2 let you store two sets of FM frequencies with the preset buttons (on-screen icons). 2. Use the tune, seek, or scan function to tune the radio to a desired station. 3. Press the preset button, and hold it until you hear a beep. You can also store frequencies with the interface dial. Select the preset icon you want to store the frequency on, then press ENTER on the interface selector, and hold it for more than 2 seconds. 4. Repeat steps 1 through 3 to store a total of six stations on AM and twelve stations on FM.
204
AUTO SELECT − If you are traveling far from home and can no longer receive your preset stations, you can use the auto select feature to find stations in the local area. Push the interface selector down to scroll down the screen, highlight A.SEL, then press ENTER on the interface selector. You will see AUTO SEL on the screen, and the system goes into scan mode for several seconds.
You can also press the A.SEL button. You will see AUTO SEL on the screen, and the system goes into scan mode for several seconds. The system stores the frequencies of six AM and twelve FM stations in the preset buttons. You will see ‘‘0’’ displayed if auto select cannot find a strong station for every preset button. If you do not like the stations auto select has stored, you can store other frequencies on the preset buttons (icons) as previously described. To turn off auto select, press ENTER on the interface selector or press the A.SEL button again. This restores the presets you originally set.
07/07/09 09:49:30 31STX610 0210
AM/FM Radio Reception Radio Frequencies The radio can receive the complete AM and FM bands. Those bands cover these frequencies:
Radio stations on the AM band are assigned frequencies at least 10 kHz apart (530, 540, 550). Stations on the FM band are assigned frequencies at least 0.2 MHz apart (87.9, 88.1, 88.3). Stations must use these exact frequencies. It is fairly common for stations to round-off the frequency in their advertising, so your radio could display a frequency of 100.9 even though the announcer may identify the station as ‘‘FM101.’’
A radio station’s signal gets weaker as you get farther away from its transmitter. If you are listening to an AM station, you will notice the sound volume becoming weaker, and the station drifting in and out. If you are listening to an FM station, you will see the stereo indicator flickering off and on as the signal weakens. Eventually, the stereo indicator will go off and the sound will fade completely as you get out of range of the station’s signal.
Features
AM band: 530 to 1,710 kHz FM band: 87.7 to 107.9 MHz
Radio Reception How well the radio receives stations is dependent on many factors, such as the distance from the station’s transmitter, nearby large objects, and atmospheric conditions.
Driving very near the transmitter of a station that is broadcasting on a frequency close to the frequency of the station you are listening to can also affect your radio’s reception. You may temporarily hear both stations, or hear only the station you are close to.
205
07/07/09 09:49:35 31STX610 0211
AM/FM Radio Reception As required by the FCC: Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.
Radio signals, especially on the FM band, are deflected by large objects such as buildings and hills. Your radio then receives both the direct signal from the station’s transmitter, and the deflected signal. This causes the sound to distort or flutter. This is a main cause of poor radio reception in city driving.
206
Radio reception can be affected by atmospheric conditions such as thunderstorms, high humidity, and even sunspots. You may be able to receive a distant radio station one day and not receive it the next day because of a change in conditions. Electrical interference from passing vehicles and stationary sources can cause temporary reception problems.
07/07/09 09:49:44 31STX610 0212
Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models with navigation system)
These adjustments can be made by the SOUND button or the interface dial.
Features
Adjusting the Sound BASS, TREBLE, BALANCE, and FADER are each adjustable. You can also adjust the strength of the sound coming from the center and subwoofer speakers. In addition, you can set the Dolby PL (ProLogic) II and Speed-sensitive volume compensation (SVC). SOUND ICON
To adjust them, press the AUDIO button, push the interface selector down, and turn the interface knob to SOUND. Then press ENTER on the selector.
Select the mode you want to adjust by turning the interface dial. You can also adjust the sound by pushing the SOUND button repeatedly. Each mode is shown in the audio display as it changes. Turn the TUNE knob to adjust the setting to your liking.
CONTINUED
207
07/07/09 09:49:49 31STX610 0213
Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models with navigation system) BASS/TREBLE − To adjust bass and treble, select BASS or TREBLE, and press ENTER on the interface selector. The current setting is shown on the display. Turn the interface knob to the desired level, and enter your selection by pressing ENTER on the interface selector.
208
FADER/BALANCE − These modes adjust the strength of the sound coming from each speaker. Fader adjusts the front-to-back strength, while balance adjusts the side-to-side strength. To adjust fader and balance, select FADER or BALANCE, then press ENTER on the interface selector. The current setting is shown on the screen. Turn the interface knob to the desired level, and enter your selection by pressing ENTER on the interface selector. To equalize the fader or balance, turn the interface knob until the marks on the sound grid come to the center of the adjustment bar.
CENTER/SUBWOOFER − To adjust the strength of the sound from the center or subwoofer speaker, select it and press ENTER on the interface selector. Turn the interface knob to the desired level, and enter your selection by pressing ENTER on the interface selector.
07/07/09 09:49:55 31STX610 0214
Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models with navigation system)
ProLogic ON/OFF settings are independently controlled for DISC, XM and AUX sources.
To set this feature on or off, select Dolby PL II, and press ENTER on the interface selector. Rotate the interface dial to ON or OFF, and press ENTER. Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. ‘‘Dolby’’, ‘‘ProLogic’’, and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
Speed-sensitive Volume Compensation (SVC)
The SVC mode controls the volume based on vehicle speed. The faster you go, the louder the audio volume becomes. As you slow down, the audio volume decreases. The SVC has four modes; SVC OFF, SVC LOW, SVC MID, and SVC HIGH. The default setting is MID. To change the SVC mode, select SVC, then press ENTER on the interface selector. The current setting is shown on the screen. Turn the interface knob to the desired level, and enter your selection by pressing ENTER on the interface selector. If you feel the sound is too loud, choose low. If you feel the sound is too quiet, choose high.
209
Features
Dolby PL (ProLogic) II − Dolby PL (ProLogic) II signal processing creates multi-channel surround sound from 2 channel stereo audio sources. Dolby ProLogic II can only activate when listening to DISC (CDDA, MP3/WMA), XM radio, and AUX. When ProLogic II is active, ‘‘PL II’’ is shown in the audio display.
07/07/09 09:50:06 31STX610 0215
Playing the XM Satellite Radio (Models with navigation system)
Without rear entertainment system
With rear entertainment system
AUDIO DISPLAY
AUDIO DISPLAY CATEGORY BUTTONS
XM BUTTON
SCAN BUTTON
SCAN BUTTON POWER/ VOLUME KNOB
TUNE KNOB DISPLAY/ MODE BUTTON
PRESET BUTTONS
CATEGORY BUTTONS TUNE KNOB
POWER/ VOLUME KNOB
DISPLAY/ MODE BUTTON
XM BUTTON AUDIO BUTTON
AUDIO BUTTON
INTERFACE DIAL
210
PRESET BUTTONS
INTERFACE DIAL
07/07/09 09:50:13 31STX610 0216
Playing the XM Satellite Radio (Models with navigation system) Your vehicle is capable of receiving XM Satellite Radio anywhere in the United States, and Canada, except Hawaii and Alaska. XM is a registered trade mark of XM Satellite Radio, Inc.
Push the AUDIO button to display XM information on the screen. You can operate the XM Satellite Radio system with the interface dial.
Features
XM Satellite Radio receives signals from two satellites to produce clear, high-quality digital reception. It offers many channels in several categories. Along with a large selection of different types of music, XM Satellite Radio also allows you to view channel and category selections in the audio display.
Operating the XM Radio
To listen to XM satellite radio, turn the ignition switch to the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position. Push the power/volume knob to turn on the audio system, and press the button. The last channel you listened to will show in the display. Adjust the volume by turning the power/volume knob. CONTINUED
211
07/07/09 09:50:19 31STX610 0217
Playing the XM Satellite Radio (Models with navigation system) MODE − To switch between the category mode and channel mode, press and hold the DISP/MODE button until the mode changes. The CATEGORY or CHANNEL mode is displayed on the screen. To switch the mode with the interface dial, scroll down, select MODE, and press ENTER on the selector.
In the category mode, such as Jazz, Rock, Classical, etc., you can navigate through all of the channels within that category. In the channel mode, you can select all of the available channels. Each time you press and release the DISP/MODE button, the audio display changes in the following sequence: channel name, channel number, category, artist name, and music title. On the screen, you will see the selected CHANNEL (number), CATEGORY, NAME (artist name), and TITLE (music title).
212
TUNE − Turn the TUNE knob to change channel selections. Turn the knob right for higher numbered channels and left for lower numbered channels. You can also change channels with the interface selector, push down the interface selector to choose TUNE and press ENTER on the selector. Turn the interface knob to the same directions. In the category mode, you can only select channels within that category.
07/07/09 09:50:24 31STX610 0218
Playing the XM Satellite Radio (Models with navigation system) CATEGORY (− or +) − Press either button to select another category. You can also change a category by pushing the interface selector left or right.
The system plays each channel in numerical order for a few seconds, then selects the next channel. When you hear a channel you want to continue listening to, push the interface selector to the right again or press the SCAN button to cancel. Features
SCAN − The scan function gives you a sampling of all channels while in the channel mode. In the category mode, only the channels within that category are scanned. To activate SCAN, press the SCAN button. To scan with the interface dial, scroll down, and push interface selector to the right. You will see SCAN on the screen and audio display.
CONTINUED
213
07/07/09 09:50:34 31STX610 0219
Playing the XM Satellite Radio (Models with navigation system) 2. Use the tune or scan function to tune to a desired channel. XM BAND
Preset − You can store up to 12 preset channels using the six preset buttons. Each button stores one channel from the XM1 band and one channel from the XM2 band. To store a channel: button or scroll 1. Press the up by pushing the interface selector up. Either XM1 or XM2 will be shown on the display.
214
In category mode, only channels within that category can be selected. In channel mode, all channels can be selected. 3. Pick the preset button you want for that channel. Press and hold the preset button until you hear a beep. You can also pick the number with the interface dial. Select your desired number and press and hold ENTER on the interface selector. 4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 to store the first six channels.
button or scroll 5. Press the up again. The other XM band will be shown. Store the next six channels using steps 2 and 3. Once a channel is stored, press and release the proper preset button to tune to it.
07/07/09 09:50:41 31STX610 0220
Playing the XM Satellite Radio (Models with navigation system) XM Radio Display Messages LOADING − XM is loading the audio or program information.
UPDATING − The encryption code is being updated. Wait until the encryption code is fully updated. Channels 0 and 1 should still work normally.
Features
OFF AIR − The channel currently selected is no longer broadcasting.
NOSIGNAL − The signal is currently too weak. Move the vehicle to an area away from tall buildings, and with an unobstructed view of the southern horizon. - - - - − The selected channel number does not exist, or is not part of your subscription, or this channel has no artist or title information at this time. ANTENNA − There is a problem with the XM antenna. Please consult your dealer. CONTINUED
215
07/07/09 09:50:45 31STX610 0221
Playing the XM Satellite Radio (Models with navigation system)
Signal may be blocked by mountains or large obstacles to the south.
Signal weaker in these areas.
SATELLITE
GROUND REPEATER
216
The XM satellites are in orbit over the equator; therefore, objects south of the vehicle may cause satellite reception interruptions. To help compensate for this, ground-based repeaters are placed in major metropolitan areas. Satellite signals are more likely to be blocked by tall buildings and mountains the farther north you travel from the equator.
07/07/09 09:50:56 31STX610 0222
Playing the XM Satellite Radio (Models with navigation system) Depending on where you drive, you may experience reception problems. Interference can be caused by any of these conditions:
There may be other geographic situations that could affect satellite radio reception.
them your radio I.D. number and your credit card number. To get your radio I.D. number, turn the TUNE knob until ‘‘0’’ appears in the display. Your I.D. will appear in the display.
Receiving XM Satellite Radio Service If your XM Radio service has expired or you purchased your vehicle from a previous owner, you can listen to a sampling of the broadcasts available on XM Satellite Radio. With the ignition switch in the ACCESSORY (I) or the ON (II) position, push the power/volume knob to turn on the audio system, and press the button. A variety of music types and styles will play.
After you’ve registered with XM Radio, keep your audio system in the Satellite Radio mode while you wait for activation. This should take about 30 minutes.
If you decide to purchase XM satellite radio service, contact XM Radio at www.xmradio.com, or at 1-800-852-9696. In Canada, contact XM Canada at www.xmradio.ca, or at 1-877-438-9677. You will need to give
While waiting for activation, make sure your vehicle remains in an open area with good reception. Once your audio system is activated, ‘‘category’’ or ‘‘CH’’ will appear in the display, and you’ll be able to listen to XM Radio broadcasts. XM Radio will continue to send an activation signal to your vehicle for at least 12 hours from the activation request. If the service has not been activated after 36 hours, contact XM Radio. CONTINUED
217
Features
Driving on the north side of an east/west mountain road. Driving on the north side of a large commercial truck on an east/west road. Driving in tunnels. Driving on a road beside a vertical wall, steep cliff, or hill to the south of you. Driving on the lower level of a multi-tiered road. Driving on a single lane road alongside dense trees taller than 50 ft. (15 m) to the south of you.
As required by the FCC: Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.
07/07/09 09:51:08 31STX610 0223
Playing Discs (Models with navigation system)
Without rear entertainment system
With rear entertainment system
AUDIO DISPLAY REPEAT BUTTON RANDOM BUTTON
AUDIO DISPLAY PRESET BUTTONS
SEEK BUTTONS
SCAN BUTTON LOAD BUTTON
EJECT BUTTON
POWER/ VOLUME KNOB
FOLDER KNOB DISPLAY/ MODE BUTTON
DISC BUTTON PRESET BUTTONS
RANDOM BUTTON SEEK BUTTONS
SCAN BUTTON LOAD BUTTON POWER/ VOLUME KNOB REPEAT BUTTON
EJECT BUTTON FOLDER KNOB
DISC BUTTON
AUDIO BUTTON AUDIO BUTTON INTERFACE DIAL
218
INTERFACE DIAL
DISPLAY/MODE BUTTON
07/07/09 09:51:20 31STX610 0224
Playing Discs (Models with navigation system) Your vehicle’s audio system has an in-dash disc changer with the same controls used for the radio. To operate the disc changer, the ignition switch must be in the ACCESSORY (I) or the ON (II) position.
The changer can also play MP3 or WMA format (see page 224 ).
The disc changer can play these disc formats: CD (CD-DA) CD-R/RW DVD-A DVD-R/RW MP3/WMA
The changer cannot play DVD-V format. Some CD-DA and CD-ROM mixed discs are not playable. ‘‘DTS’’ and ‘‘DTS Digital Surround’’ are registered trademarks of Digital Theater Systems, Inc. You cannot load and play 3-inch (8-cm) discs in this system.
Do not use discs with adhesive labels. The label can curl up and cause the disc to jam in the unit.
219
Features
The disc packages or jackets should have one of these marks.
DVD-A discs not meeting DVD verification standards may not be playable.
07/07/09 09:51:30 31STX610 0225
Playing Discs (Models with navigation system) Loading Discs in the Changer To load multiple discs in one operation: 1. With the ignition in the ACCESSORY (I) or the ON (II) position, press and hold the LOAD button until you hear a beep and see ‘‘LOAD’’ in the upper display, then release the button. 2. Insert a disc into the slot. Insert it only about halfway; the drive will pull it in the rest of the way. You will see ‘‘BUSY’’ in audio display. When you insert the first disc, the changer will start to play the disc. 3. When ‘‘LOAD’’ appears in the audio display again, insert the next disc into the slot. Do not try to insert a disc until ‘‘LOAD’’ appears. You could damage the audio unit.
220
4. Repeat this until all six positions are loaded. If you are not loading all six positions, the system will then begin playing the last disc loaded. If you stop loading discs before all six positions are filled, the system will wait for 10 seconds, stop the load operation, and begin playing the last disc loaded. To load a single disc: 1. Press and release the LOAD button. 2. ‘‘NO DISC’’ is shown on the screen for an empty position in the changer. When the green load indicator comes on and you see the ‘‘LOAD’’ in the audio display, insert the disc into the slot. Insert it only about halfway; the drive will pull it in the rest of the way.
You can select the position to load a disc. Turn the interface knob or press a preset button to select the position, then press ENTER on the selector. This starts the loading sequence. If you do not select the position, the system loads the disc to the first empty position in numerical order. If you press the LOAD button while a disc is playing, the system will stop playing that disc and start the loading sequence. It will then play the disc just loaded.
07/07/09 09:51:39 31STX610 0226
Playing Discs (Models with navigation system) To Play a Disc
The player can play CD-TEXT, MP3, and WMA formats.
CURRENT DISC
Select the changer by pressing the DISC button. The system will begin playing the last selected disc in the disc changer. You will see the current disc position highlighted. To select a different disc, press the corresponding number on the preset buttons, or turn the interface knob to highlight the desired disc, then press ENTER on the interface selector.
Each time you press the DISP button, the audio display changes from album name, to track name, to artist name, and then to normal display that shows the track number and the current time. When playing a disc in MP3/WMA, the display mode changes from folder name, to file name, to artist tag, to album tag, to track tag, and then to normal display.
To Change Tracks Each time you press and release the SEEK (+) button or push the interface selector to the right, the player skips forward to the beginning of the next track. Press and release the SEEK (−) button or push the interface selector to the left to skip backward to the beginning of the current track. Press the SEEK (−) button or push the interface selector to the left again to skip to the previous track. To move rapidly within a track, press and hold the SEEK (−) or SEEK (+) button.
221
Features
When you play CD-TEXT, you will see the track name, artist name, and album name on the screen. When you play MP3/WMA discs, you will see the track name and folder name on the screen. If the disc was not recorded with this information, it will not be displayed.
If the disc does not carry album, track, or artist name, pressing the DISP button changes the display from normal display to ‘‘NO INFO’’.
07/07/09 09:51:47 31STX610 0227
Playing Discs (Models with navigation system) To Choose a Track
CURRENT TRACK
You can also choose a track directly from a track list. Press ENTER on the interface selector, and the track list screen will be shown. If there are no track names, track numbers are displayed. You will see the current track is highlighted. Turn the interface knob to select the desired track, then press ENTER on the interface selector.
222
To exit the track list display, press the AUDIO button, or push the interface selector to the left. Track Scan When you press the SCAN button or scroll down and push the interface selector to the left, the next track of the current track plays for about 10 seconds. You will see SCAN next to TRACK on the screen and audio display. To listen to the rest of the track, press and hold the SCAN button until you hear a beep or push the interface selector to the left again within 10 seconds. If you don’t, the system advances to the next track, plays about 10 seconds of it, and continues through the rest of the tracks the same way.
Disc Scan When you press the SCAN button repeatedly until you see D-SCAN in the audio display, or push down the interface selector to the right, the first track of the current disc plays for about 10 seconds. You will see SCAN next to DISC on the screen and D-SCAN in the audio display. To listen to the rest of the disc, press and hold the SCAN button until you hear a beep, or push down the interface selector to the right again within 10 seconds. If you don’t, the system advances to the next disc, plays about 10 seconds of its first track, and continues through the rest of the discs the same way. When the system reaches the last disc, DISC SCAN is canceled, and that disc continues to play.
07/07/09 09:51:53 31STX610 0228
Playing Discs (Models with navigation system) Disc Repeat To replay the current disc continuously, press the RPT button repeatedly until you see D-RPT in the audio display, or use the interface selector to scroll down, select DISC REPEAT, and press ENTER on the interface selector. As a reminder, you will see REPEAT next to DISC on the screen and D-RPT in the audio display. To turn this feature off, press and hold the RPT button until you hear a beep, or highlight DISC REPEAT (if not already highlighted), and press ENTER on the interface selector again.
Random Play To play the tracks of the current disc in random order, press and release the RDM button, or use the interface selector to scroll down, select TRACK RANDOM, and press ENTER on the interface selector. As a reminder, you will see RANDOM next to TRACK on the screen and RDM in the audio display. To turn this feature off, press and hold the RDM button until you hear a beep, or highlight TRACK RANDOM (if not already highlighted), and press ENTER on the interface selector again.
223
Features
Track Repeat To replay the current track continuously, press and release the RPT button, or use the interface selector to scroll down, select TRACK REPEAT, and press ENTER on the interface selector. As a reminder, you will see REPEAT next to TRACK on the screen and RPT in the audio display. To turn this feature off, press and hold the RPT button until you hear a beep, or highlight TRACK REPEAT (if not already highlighted), and press ENTER on the interface selector again.
07/07/09 09:52:06 31STX610 0229
Playing Discs (Models with navigation system) To Pause a Disc To pause a disc, press the preset button which corresponds to the current disc. To play the disc again, press the preset button again. To Stop Playing a Disc To take the system out of disc mode, press the AM/FM button the button, or the AUX button. To return to disc mode, press the DISC button. If you turn the system off while a disc is playing, either with the power/volume knob or the ignition switch, play will continue at the same point when you turn it back on.
224
Playing a DVD-A Disc Use the disc controls previously described. Playing an MP3/WMA Disc The changer plays MP3/WMA files in recorded order. Each disc can hold up to 400 playable files within 8 folder layers. When playing MP3 discs, a disc can support a maximum number of 100 folders, and each folder can hold 255 playable files. The specifications of the compatible MP3 file are: Sampling frequency: 32/44.1/48 kHz (MPEG1) 16/22.05/24 kHz (MPEG2) Bit rate: 32/40/48/56/64/80/96/ 112/128/160/192/224/256/320 kbps Compatible with variable bit rate and multi-session
The specifications of the compatible WMA file are: Sampling frequency: 22.05/32/44.1/ 48 kHz Bit rate: 48/64/80/96/128/160/192 kbps Compatible with variable bit rate and multi-session To play an MP3/WMA disc, use the disc controls previously described, along with the following information.
07/07/09 09:52:14 31STX610 0230
Playing Discs (Models with navigation system) Changing and Selecting the Folders/ Files
Features
Changing the Folders While playing an MP3/WMA disc, you can select a folder within the disc by turning the TUNE knob. Each time you rotate the knob, the folder title and its first file’s information appear in the audio display in recorded order.
If you use the interface selector, you can see the list of all the files and folders within a disc. While playing a MP3/WMA disc, press the AUDIO button. The currently playing folder and file information comes on the screen. Turn the selector knob, highlight the folder you want to see the information within, and press ENTER.
Repeat the procedure to go into a lower folder. If you highlight a file and press ENTER, the system starts to play your selected file.
225
07/07/09 09:52:21 31STX610 0231
Playing Discs (Models with navigation system) Folder Scan This feature, when activated, samples the first file of each folder for 10 seconds. To scan a folder, press the SCAN button repeatedly until you see F-SCAN in the audio display. You will see SCAN next to FOLDER and F-SCAN in the audio display. To listen to the rest of the folder, press and hold the SCAN button until you hear a beep. If you do not, the system advances to the next folder, plays 10 seconds of it, and continues throughout the rest of the folder same way. When the system samples the first file of all folders, folder scan is canceled, and the last file played comes back.
226
Folder Repeat This feature, when activated, replays all files on the selected folder. To activate folder repeat mode, press and hold the RPT button repeatedly until you see F-RPT in the audio display, or use the interface selector to scroll down, select FOLDER REPEAT by interface knob, and press ENTER on the interface selector. You will see REPEAT next to FOLDER on the screen and F-RPT in the audio display. To turn this feature off, press and hold the PRT button until you hear a beep, or highlight FOLDER REPEAT (if not already highlighted), and press ENTER on the interface selector again.
Folder Random This feature, when activated, plays in the current folder in random order. To activate folder random play, press the RDM button twice, or use the interface selector to scroll down, select FOLDER RANDOM by interface knob, and press ENTER on the interface selector. You will see RANDOM next to FOLDER on the screen and F-RDM in the audio display. To turn this feature off, press and hold the RDM button until you hear a beep, or highlight FOLDER RANDOM (if not already highlighted), and press ENTER on the interface selector again.
07/07/09 09:52:28 31STX610 0232
Playing Discs (Models with navigation system)
If you do not remove the disc from the slot, the system will reload the disc after 10 seconds. To begin playing the disc, press the disc button.
To remove a different disc from the changer, first select it by pressing the corresponding number on the preset button or turning the interface knob, and pressing ENTER on the interface selector. When that disc begins playing, press the eject button.
Features
Removing Discs from the Changer To remove the disc that is currently playing, press the eject button. You will see ‘‘EJECT’’ in the audio display. When you remove the disc from the slot, the system automatically enters the previous mode AM, FM1, FM2, or XM Satellite Radio. The system also begins the load sequence so you can load another disc. If you do not load another disc, the load sequence is canceled, and the system continues playing in the previous mode.
When you press the eject button while listening to the radio, or with the audio system turned off, the disc that was last selected is ejected. After that disc is ejected, pressing the eject button again will eject the next disc in numerical order. By doing this six times, you can remove all the discs from the changer. You can also eject discs when the ignition switch is off: To eject one disc, press and release the eject button. To eject all discs, press and hold the eject button.
227
07/07/09 09:52:35 31STX610 0233
Disc Changer Error Messages The chart on the right explains the error messages you may see in the display while playing a disc.
Error Message HEAT ERROR
If you see an error message in the display while playing a disc, press the eject button. After ejecting the disc, check it for damage or deformation. If there is no damage, insert the disc again. For the additional information on damaged discs, see page 228 . The audio system will try to play the disc. If there is still a problem, the error message will reappear. Press the eject button, and pull out the disc. Insert a different disc. If the new disc plays, there is a problem with the first disc. If the error message cycle repeats and you cannot clear it, take your vehicle to a dealer.
228
FORMAT BAD DISC − PLEASE CHECK OWNER’S MANUAL PUSH EJECT BAD DISC − PLEASE CHECK OWNER’S MANUAL
Cause High Temperature Track/File format not supported
Mechanical Error
Servo Error
Solution Will disappear when the temperature returns to normal. Current track will be skipped. The next supported track or file plays automatically. Press the EJECT button and pull out the disc(s). Check the disc for serious damage, signs of deformation, excessive scratches, and/or dirt (see page 228). Insert the disc again. If the code does not disappear, or the disc(s) cannot be removed, consult your dealer. Do not try to force the disc out of the player.
07/07/09 09:52:45 31STX610 0234
Protecting Your Discs General Information When using CD-R or CD-RW discs, use only high quality discs labeled for audio use.
Play only standard, round, 5-inch (12 cm) discs. Smaller or oddshaped discs may jam in the drive or cause other problems. Handle your discs properly to prevent damage and skipping.
Do not use discs with adhesive labels. The label can curl up and cause the disc to jam in the unit.
To clean a disc, use a clean soft cloth. Wipe across the disc from the center to the outside edge. A new disc may be rough on the inner and outer edges. The small plastic pieces causing this roughness can flake off and fall on the recording surface of the disc, causing skipping or other problems. Remove these pieces by rubbing the inner and outer edges with the side of a pencil or pen. Never try to insert foreign objects in the disc changer.
Features
When recording a CD-R or CD-RW, the recording must be closed for it to be used by the disc changer.
Protecting Discs When a disc is not being played, store it in its case to protect it from dust and other contamination. To prevent warpage, keep discs out of direct sunlight and extreme heat.
Handle a disc by its edges; never touch either surface. Do not place stabilizer rings or labels on the disc. These, along with contamination from finger prints, liquids, and felttip pens, can cause the disc to not play properly, or possibly jam in the drive.
229
07/07/09 09:52:56 31STX610 0235
Protecting Your Discs Additional Information of Recommended Discs The in-dash disc player/changer has a sophisticated and delicate mechanism. If you insert a damaged disc as indicated in this section, it may become stuck inside and damage the audio unit. Examples of these discs are shown to the right:
1. Bubbled, wrinkled, labelled, and excessively thick discs
Bubbled/ Wrinkled
With Label/ Sticker
2. Damaged discs
Chipped/ Cracked
230
Using Printer Label Kit
Sealed
3. Poor quality discs
Warped
Burrs
With Plastic Ring
07/07/09 09:53:07 31STX610 0236
Protecting Your Discs 4. Small, irregular shaped discs
5. Discs with scratches, dirty discs
Recommended discs are printed with the following logo. For the rear entertainment system, see page 264 .
Features
3-inch (8-cm) CD
Triangle Shape Fingerprints, scratches, etc.
CD-R or CD-RW may not play due to the recording conditions.
Audio unit may not play the following formats.
Scratches and fingerprints on the discs may cause the sound to skip.
Can Shape
Arrow Shape
This audio unit cannot play a Dualdisc .
231
07/07/09 09:53:13 31STX610 0237
Auxiliary Input Jack All models except U.S. Entertainment Package and Canadian Elite Package models
The auxiliary input jack is inside the front console compartment. The system will accept auxiliary input from standard audio accessories. When a compatible audio unit is connected to the jack, press the AUX button to select it.
232
U.S. Entertainment Package and Canadian Elite Package models
Auxiliary input jacks and headphone connectors for the rear entertainment system are on the back of the center console compartment. For more information, see page 267 .
07/07/09 09:53:21 31STX610 0238
Remote Audio Controls
MODE BUTTON
VOL BUTTON
Three controls for the audio system are mounted in the steering wheel hub. These let you control basic functions without removing your hand from the wheel.
The MODE button changes the mode. Pressing the button repeatedly selects FM1, FM2, AM, DISC (if a disc is loaded), DVD video (if equipped), XM1, XM2, or AUX. If you are listening to the radio, use the CH button to change stations. Each time you press the top (+) of the button, the system goes to the next preset station on the band you are listening to. Press the bottom (−) to go back to the previous station. To search up and down from the current frequency and find a station with a strong signal, press the top (+) or bottom (−) of the button for 1 second.
If you are playing a disc, the system skips to the beginning of the next track each time you press the top (+) of the CH button. Press the bottom (−) to return to the beginning of the current track. Press it again to return to the previous track. You will see the disc and track numbers in the upper display. To go to the next disc, press the top (+) of the button. Press the bottom (−) to go back to the previous disc. When you play an MP3/WMA disc, press the top (+) of the button for 1 second to go to the next folder. Press the bottom (−) for 1 second to go back to the previous folder.
CONTINUED
233
Features
CH BUTTON
The VOL button adjusts the volume up (▲) or down (▼). Press the top or bottom of the button, hold it until the desired volume is reached, then release it.
07/07/09 09:53:26 31STX610 0239
Remote Audio Controls If you are listening to XM Satellite Radio, use the CH button to change channels. Each time you press the top (+) of the button, the system goes to the next preset channel. Press the bottom (−) to go back to the previous preset channel. To go to the next channel of the category you are listening to, press the top (+) of the button for 1 second. Press the bottom (−) for 1 second to go back to the previous channel.
234
If you are playing a DVD video, use the channel button to change chapters. Each time you press the top (+) of the button, the system goes to the next chapter. Press the bottom (−) to return to the beginning of the current chapter. Press it again to return to the previous chapter.
07/07/09 09:53:32 31STX610 0240
Radio Theft Protection
You should have received a card that lists your audio system code number and serial number. It is best to store this card in a safe place at home. In addition, you should write the audio system’s serial number in this owner’s manual. If you lose the card, you must obtain the code number from your dealer. To do this, you will need the audio system’s serial number.
If your vehicle’s battery is disconnected or goes dead, or the radio fuse is removed, the audio system will disable itself. If this happens, you will see ‘‘ ’’ in the audio display the next time you turn on the system. Use the preset buttons to enter the five-digit code. The code is located on the radio code card included in your owner’s manual kit. When it is entered correctly, the radio will start playing.
The system will retain your AM and FM presets even if power is disconnected.
Features
Your vehicle’s audio system may disable itself if it is disconnected from electrical power for any reason. To make it work again, you must enter a specific five-digit code with the preset buttons. Because there are hundreds of number combinations possible from the five digits, making the system work without knowing the exact code is nearly impossible.
If you make a mistake entering the code, do not start over; complete the five-digit sequence, then enter the correct code. You have 10 tries to enter the correct code. If you are unsuccessful in 10 attempts, you must then leave the system on for 1 hour before trying again.
235
07/07/09 09:53:42 31STX610 0241
Setting the Clock and Calendar 4. After you set the day information, pressing the SET button again will cancel this setting mode and the system shows the adjusted display. The system will also automatically return to the normal display about 10 seconds after you stop adjusting a mode. U.S. model is shown
On models without navigation system
: Press SET
You can see the clock and calendar information on the upper display. To set the clock and the calendar: 1. Press and hold the SET button until the clock display begins to blink.
236
2. Press and release the SET button repeatedly. The mode switches from hours, minutes, AM/PM, year, month, then to day as shown above. 3. Select the desired mode by pressing the SET button, then press either ▼ or ▲ button to change the setting.
On models with navigation system
The navigation system receives signals from the global positioning system (GPS), and the displayed time is updated automatically by the GPS. Refer to the navigation system manual for how to adjust the time.
07/07/09 09:53:51 31STX610 0242
Rear Entertainment System Available on U.S. Entertainment Package and Canadian Elite Package models
Your vehicle is equipped with a rear entertainment system that includes a DVD player for the enjoyment of the rear passengers.
The ignition switch must be in the ACCESSORY (I) or the ON (II) position to operate the rear entertainment system.
you will see ‘‘DVD EJECT’’ in the display. You should select another source or insert a DVD. Rear Speakers When you turn on the system, the rear speakers are automatically turned off if the rear system selects a different entertainment source than the front system. You will see the Rear Speakers Off icon both in the audio display and the overhead screen. The sound for the rear system is sent to the wireless headphones. If you want to turn the rear speakers on again, press and hold the REAR PWR button until the Rear Speakers Off icon goes off. NOTE: The rear speakers are connected to the front system, so they will always play the source that the front system is set to.
CONTINUED
237
Features
With this system, the rear passengers can enjoy a different entertainment source (radio, disc changer, DVD player, XM Radio, or optional CD changer/tape player) than the front seat occupants. The audio is broadcast through the supplied wireless headphones.
To Turn On the System Press the REAR PWR button. The indicator on the REAR PWR button will come on, as well as the indicator on the FRONT SOURCE button. The rear seat passengers can then operate the rear system from the control panel in the ceiling. The rear control panel can also be detached and used as a remote control, by pushing the RELEASE button, and pulling the remote toward you. Pressing the REAR CTRL OFF button disables rear control. The indicator in the button comes on and your passengers can no longer operate the system with the rear control panel. When the button is pressed, the ‘‘CTRL OFF’’ message appears in the overhead screen to let your passengers know that the control panel is disabled. The rear system selects the source it was last set to. If that source has been removed (the DVD has been ejected from the player, for example),
07/07/09 09:53:56 31STX610 0243
Rear Entertainment System U.S. Entertainment Package and Canadian Elite Package models
238
REAR PWR BUTTON
REAR CTRL OFF BUTTON
FRONT SOURCE BUTTON
REAR SOURCE BUTTON
Overhead Screen Unit
07/07/09 09:54:04 31STX610 0244
Rear Entertainment System
If you do not operate the rear entertainment system from the front panel within 10 seconds, the indicator goes off and the FRONT SOURCE indicator comes on automatically. To play the radio, the buttons for the front entertainment system have the same functions. If discs are loaded in the disc changer of the upper part, select the 6 DISC button. If a disc is loaded in the lower player, select the DVD button.
Operating the DVD Player from the Front Control Panel The DVD player in your rear entertainment system can play DVD video discs, audio CDs MP3/WMA discs and DTS CDs.
REAR CONTROL PANEL
OPEN BUTTON OVERHEAD SCREEN
Open the overhead screen by pushing the OPEN button. The screen will swing down part-way. Pivot the screen the rest of the way. If you pivot the screen too far forward, past the second detent, the display will turn off. Pivot the screen back to the second or first detent to turn the display back on. To close the screen, pivot it up until it latches. CONTINUED
239
Features
To Select Rear Entertainment from the Front Control Panel To operate the rear entertainment system from the front panel, press the REAR SOURCE button. You will hear two beeps and the indicator in the button comes on to show that the control panel is enabled.
07/07/09 09:54:13 31STX610 0245
Rear Entertainment System Insert a DVD into the lower DVD/ CD slot in the audio unit.
U.S. Entertainment Package and Canadian Elite Package models SEEK/SKIP BUTTONS
Push the DVD in halfway, the drive will pull it in the rest of the way. PLAY − Press the DVD ( ) button if the DVD does not start playing automatically. PAUSE − Press the DVD ( ) button to pause the DVD. Press the button again or press PLAY to resume. Pause works only with the DVD player.
EJECT BUTTON PLAY/PAUSE BUTTON
240
07/07/09 09:54:19 31STX610 0246
Rear Entertainment System
Each time you press the + button and release it, the system skips forward to the beginning of the next track or chapter. Press and release the − button to skip backward to the beginning of the current track. Press and release it again to skip to the beginning of the previous track or chapter.
EJECT − Press the eject button to remove the DVD from the drive. To Return to Front Audio Controls To return front panel control to the front audio system. Press the FRONT SOURCE button. You will hear a beep and the indicator in the button comes on. The indicator also comes on automatically, when you do not operate the rear entertainment system for 10 seconds.
Using the Rear Control Panel To turn on the rear entertainment system from the rear control panel, press the PWR button. Use the AM/ FM button, XM RADIO button, 6 DISC button, DVD button, or AUX button to select the entertainment source. The selected source will be shown in the display. Make sure the rear control operation has not been disabled with the REAR CTRL button on the front panel. When the audio system is off or the front side rear power is off, the rear control panel cannot be turned on.
241
Features
SEEK/SKIP − Press and hold the + button to move forward; you will see the time elapsed shown in the overhead screen advances rapidly. Press and hold the − button to move backward; you will see the time elapsed shown in the overhead screen decreases. Release the button when the system reaches the point you want.
07/07/09 09:54:28 31STX610 0247
Rear Entertainment System To Play the Radio from the Rear Control Panel Use the ▲ , ▼ , , or button to highlight SEEK, TUNE, AUTO SELECT, SCAN, or one of the preset radio stations on the overhead screen. You can enter the highlighted function by pressing the ENT button. These functions have the same features as those of the front audio system. You can also use the or buttons to seek up/down and or to tune up/down.
REAR CONTROL PANEL
To Play the XM Radio from the Rear Control Panel You can also use the or buttons to change categories up/down and or to change channels up/down within a category (in CATEGORY mode) or up/down for all channels (in CH mode). Use the ▲ , ▼ , , or button to highlight CATE (to change categories), CHAN (to change channels), MODE (to
242
change category or channel mode), SCAN, or one of the preset channels on the overhead screen. You can enter the highlighted function by pressing the ENT button. These functions have the same features as those of the front audio system.
07/07/09 09:54:36 31STX610 0248
Rear Entertainment System
To change mode, press and hold the DISP MODE button for 5 seconds.
To Play a Disc in the 6-Disc Changer from the Rear Control Panel If discs are loaded in the disc changer, select them by pressing the 6 DISC button. Use the ▲ , ▼ , , or button to highlight REPEAT, RANDOM, SCAN, , (skip), , or (cue) on the overhead screen. You can enter the highlighted function by pressing the ENT button. These functions have the same features as those of the front audio system.
To change the disc currently playing, use the ▲ , ▼ , , or button to highlight your selected disc icon, and press ENT. If CDs are loaded in the CD changer and the overhead screen is not open, pressing the ▲ or ▼ button changes the discs.
243
Features
While the overhead screen is closed, you can see the XM radio information in the subsidiary display in the ceiling. Pressing the DISP MODE button repeatedly changes the subsidiary display from the channel number, to the category name, to the music title, to the artist name, and to the channel name, and then back to the channel number.
07/07/09 09:54:48 31STX610 0249
Rear Entertainment System To Play a DVD from the Rear Control Panel The video screen is for use by rear seat passengers only. The driver and front seat passenger should not try to view the screen while driving. Open the overhead screen by pushing the OPEN button. The screen will swing down part-way. Pivot the screen the rest of the way. If you pivot the screen too far forward, past the second detent, the display will turn off. Pivot the screen back to the second or first detent to turn the display back on. To close the screen, pivot it up until it latches. Press the button when you want to pause the DVD. Press this button again to go back to PLAY. Press the button to skip to the beginning of the next chapter. Press the button to return to the beginning of the current chapter.
244
REAR CONTROL PANEL
OPEN BUTTON OVERHEAD SCREEN
Press the button again quickly to go to the previous chapter. To move rapidly within a chapter, press and hold the or button. The system will continue to move through the chapter. Press the button to move forward, or the button to move backward. Release the button when the system reaches the point you want.
To select the menu on the DVD, press the MENU/SCROLL button. Use the , , , and buttons to move to the desired menu selection, then press the ENT button to enter your selection.
07/07/09 09:54:57 31STX610 0250
Rear Entertainment System MENU SCROLL Button
Top Menu
When you press the DISP button while a DVD is playing, the current status of title, chapter, elapsed time, angle, subtitle, audio, and sound characteristics, with the personal surround logo are displayed. To return to the DVD video screen, press the DISP button again.
When you press the MENU SCROLL button while a DVD is playing, the DVD Menu appears. The menu options are TOP MENU, MENU, PLAY MODE, SEARCH, and NumInput.
When you select ‘‘TOP MENU’’, the screen changes to the DVD’s title menu. This menu also appears when you press the MENU SCROLL button while a DVD is not playing. To go back to play, press the RETURN button.
Features
DISP Button
If you do not press the DISP button, the screen returns to the DVD video screen after several seconds.
To go to your selected menu, use the or button to highlight the icon and press the ENT button. To return to the DVD video screen, select EXIT.
CONTINUED
245
07/07/09 09:55:06 31STX610 0251
Rear Entertainment System Menu
Play Mode
‘‘Audio’’
When you select ‘‘MENU’’ with the or button, the screen changes to the DVD’s title menu.
When you select ‘‘PLAY MODE’’ with the or button, you can change the DVD’s Audio, Subtitle or Angle setting.
To change the Audio setting, highlight ‘‘Audio’’ from the play mode menu with the ▼ or ▲ button and press the ENT button. A submenu of the dubbed language appears. You can select another language by pressing the or button. The sound characteristics (Dolby Digital, LPCM, MPEG Audio, dts) recorded with the selected language is also displayed next to the language.
246
07/07/09 09:55:13 31STX610 0252
Rear Entertainment System The selectable languages vary from DVD to DVD, and this feature may not be available on some DVDs.
‘‘Subtitle’’
Features
Press the RETURN button or cursor back with the ▼ or ▲ button to go back to the top of the Play Mode menu. Press the RETURN button again to exit completely.
After selecting your desired subtitle, press the RETURN button or cursor back with the ▼ or ▲ button to go back to the top of the Play Mode menu. Press the RETURN button again to exit completely.
To change the DVD’s subtitle, highlight ‘‘Subtitle’’ from the play mode menu with the ▼ or ▲ button and press the ENT button. You can see the available subtitles with the or button. Press the ENT button when your desired subtitle is highlighted. CONTINUED
247
07/07/09 09:55:22 31STX610 0253
Rear Entertainment System ‘‘Angle’’
If there are no multiple angles available on the DVD, you cannot change from ‘‘Angle 1’’.
Search
Press the RETURN button or cursor back with the ▼ or ▲ button to go back to the top of the Play Mode menu. Press the RETURN button again to exit completely.
To change the view angle, highlight ‘‘Angle’’ from the play mode menu with the ▼ or ▲ button and press the ENT button. You can see the available angle options with the or button. Press the ENT button when your desired subtitle is highlighted.
248
When you highlight ‘‘Search’’ with the or button, the ‘‘Jump to chapter and title number input’’ message appears. To select ‘‘Chapter’’ or ‘‘Title’’ search, press the ENT button.
07/07/09 09:55:30 31STX610 0254
Rear Entertainment System NumInput
With ‘‘Title’’ highlighted, use the or button to jump to your desired title and press the ENT button. When ‘‘Chapter’’ is highlighted, follow the same procedure for the chapter search.
A numerical command can be issued to a DVD by inputting a two digit number, and a button number can be selected on the screen.
Features
‘‘Title/Chapter Search’’
When you highlight, ‘‘NumInput’’ with the or button, the ‘‘Jump to keypad’’ message appears. Press the ENT button to go to the NumInput selection screen.
Select the first digit number using the ▼ , ▲ , , or button, and enter it by pressing the ENT button. If you want to change the number, select ‘‘DEL,’’ and press the ENT button, then select and enter the new number.
CONTINUED
249
07/07/09 09:55:38 31STX610 0255
Rear Entertainment System Select and enter the second digit number the same way. The cursor will automatically move to the ‘‘ENT’’ icon when you press the ENT button. Press the ENT button to enter the number command. To go back to the DVD screen, press the RETURN button or select EXIT and press the ENT button.
SETUP Button
When you press the SETUP button while a DVD is playing, the setup menu appears. The menu options are DISP ADUSTMENT, ASPECT RATIO, and PERSONAL SURROUND. To change a setup, use the or button to highlight your selection and press the ENT button. To return to the DVD video screen, select EXIT.
250
Disp Adjust
To adjust the display, highlight ‘‘Disp Adjust’’ from the setup menu with the ▼ or ▲ button and press the ENT button. You can adjust these display settings: Brightness Contrast Black Level Tint Color
07/07/09 09:55:46 31STX610 0256
Rear Entertainment System
Features
Select the quality you want to adjust by pressing the ▼ or ▲ button. Adjust the setting by pressing the or button. When you are finished with your adjustment, cursor back to the top of the setup menu, or press the RETURN button to exit.
If you want to set the display to the default setting, select ‘‘Reset’’ by pressing the ▼ or ▲ button, and, then pressing the ENT button.
The display changes as shown above. Select ‘‘Yes,’’ and press the ENT button. You will see the message ‘‘Default display settings applied’’ on the display for 5 seconds.
CONTINUED
251
07/07/09 09:55:54 31STX610 0257
Rear Entertainment System The selected setting will be highlighted in blue for one second, and the screen returns to the play mode in the selected setting.
Aspect Ratio
You can set the screen mode to these settings: Normal Wide Zoom Full
Select the ‘‘Aspect Ratio’’ by pressing the or button, then press the ENT button. The selectable setting menu is displayed, and the current setting is highlighted in blue. Select the desired setting by pressing the or button, then press the ENT button.
252
07/07/09 09:56:01 31STX610 0258
Rear Entertainment System Personal Surround
Select ‘‘Cinema,’’ ‘‘Music,’’ or ‘‘Voice’’ by pressing the or button, and enter your selection by pressing the ENT button. The ‘‘PERSONAL SURROUND’’ logo is displayed in the upper right corner of the screen.
If you select ‘‘Off,’’ the logo disappears, and there will be no special sound effect.
Features
To change the Personal Surround setting, highlight ‘‘PERSONAL SURROUND’’ from the setup menu with the ▼ or ▲ button and press the ENT button. The effect selection appears.
CONTINUED
253
07/07/09 09:56:10 31STX610 0259
Rear Entertainment System INITIAL SETTINGS Menu
INITIAL SETTINGS (Language)
Menu Language
When you press the SETUP button on the rear control panel when a DVD is not playing, the ‘‘INITIAL SETTINGS’’ menu is displayed.
When you select ‘‘Language’’ with the or button, the menu shown above appears.
To select the language used in the DISC menus, select ‘‘Menu Language’’ by pressing the ▼ or ▲ button.
There are two selectable menus: ‘‘Language’’ and ‘‘Others.’’
254
To return to the stop or prestop screen, select ‘‘Exit’’ using the or button, and then press the ENT, or the SETUP button.
07/07/09 09:56:18 31STX610 0260
Rear Entertainment System
Features
Select the desired language by pressing the or button, and then pressing the ENT button. The selectable languages are, English, French, Spanish, German, Italian, Dutch, Chinese, Korean, Thai, Japanese or others.
If you want another language than those listed, you need to enter the code number of the desired language. Select ‘‘other,’’ and press the ENT button. The display changes as shown in the next column.
If you select ‘‘No,’’ and press the ENT button, the display returns to the initial screen of the ‘‘Language’’ menu.
CONTINUED
255
07/07/09 09:56:26 31STX610 0261
Rear Entertainment System Audio Language
If you select ‘‘Yes,’’ the display changes to the language code input mode. Select the first number digit using the , , , or button, and press the ENT button to enter it. Repeat this until all four digits are filled. When the fourth digit is entered, the cursor automatically moves to ‘‘ENT’’ on the display. Press the ENT button on the control panel to enter the new language code.
256
If you made a mistake entering a number digit, select ‘‘DEL’’ on the display with the , , , or button, and press the ENT button on the control panel. Then select and enter the correct number digit as described. The display returns to the initial ‘‘Language’’ menu screen.
You can select the dubbed language before playing DVDs. Select ‘‘Audio Language’’ by pressing the ▼ or ▲ button. You will see the submenu next to ‘‘Audio Language.’’ Follow the same instructions you used to set the menu language.
07/07/09 09:56:35 31STX610 0262
Rear Entertainment System INITIAL SETTINGS (Others)
You can select the subtitle language before playing DVDs. Select ‘‘Subtitle Language’’ by pressing the ▼ or ▲ button. You will see the submenu next to the ‘‘Subtitle Language.’’
When you select ‘‘Others’’ at the top of the ‘‘INITIAL SETTINGS’’ screen, the above menu appears on the screen.
Dynamic Range ‘‘Dynamic Range’’ reduces the differences between the loud and quiet sound levels throughout the disc. When this is on, the louder sounds are lowered, and quieter sounds are increased. Features
Subtitle Language
Follow the same instructions you used to set the menu language. CONTINUED
257
07/07/09 09:56:43 31STX610 0263
Rear Entertainment System Angle Mark ANGLE MARK
When you select the ‘‘Dynamic Range’’ by pressing the ▼ or ▲ button, you will see the submenu next to the ‘‘Dynamic Range’’ as shown above. To turn ‘‘Dynamic Range’’ on or off, select ‘‘ON’’ or ‘‘OFF’’ by pressing the or button.
258
When you switch to another angle while playing a DVD, the angle mark is displayed in the upper right corner of the screen. You can set the system to display or not display this angle mark.
Select ‘‘Angle Mark’’ by pressing the ▼ or ▲ button. The above submenu appears. If you want the angle mark to be displayed, select ‘‘ON’’ with the or button.
07/07/09 09:56:51 31STX610 0264
Rear Entertainment System Parental Level You can place an auditory restriction by changing the parental control level. The higher the level number, the lower the restriction. Features
Highlight ‘‘Parental Level’’ and press ENT button. You will see the submenu. If you select ‘‘No’’ and press the ENT button, the screen goes back to the ‘‘Others’’ menu.
When you select and enter ‘‘Yes,’’ the display changes as shown above. To change the level, you need to enter your four digit password. Select the number for the first digit by pressing the , , , or button, and enter it by pressing the ENT button. Repeat this until all four digits are filled. When you enter the fourth number, the cursor automatically moves to ‘‘ENT’’ on the display. Press the ENT button on the CONTINUED control panel.
259
07/07/09 09:56:59 31STX610 0265
Rear Entertainment System Changing the Password
If the system does not recognize the password you entered, you will see the above display. Repeat the parental control level steps until you enter the correct password.
260
If you enter the password correctly, you can then change the parental control level. Once you correctly enter the password, press the or button to change the level, and then press the ENT button to enter your selection.
The password was set to ‘‘1111’’ when the vehicle left the factory.
07/07/09 09:57:08 31STX610 0266
Rear Entertainment System
Features
To change the password, select ‘‘Password.’’ You will see the above menu displayed. Select ‘‘Yes’’ by pressing the or button, then press the ENT button. If you select ‘‘No,’’ and press the ENT button, the display returns to the ‘‘Others’’ menu.
Select the first digit by pressing the , , , or button, and enter it by pressing the ENT button. Repeat this until all four digits are entered. When you enter the fourth number, the cursor automatically moves to ‘‘ENT’’ on the display. Press the ENT button on the control panel.
If the system does not recognize the password you entered, you will see the above display. Repeat the password setting steps until you enter the correct password.
CONTINUED
261
07/07/09 09:57:15 31STX610 0267
Rear Entertainment System Remote Control
RELEASE BUTTON
If you forget the password, select ‘‘Password,’’ and press the ▲ button 10 times.
The display changes as shown above. If you want to use the default password (1111), select ‘‘Yes,’’ and press the ENT button. The message ‘‘Default password setting applied’’ is displayed for 5 seconds.
262
The rear control panel can be detached from the ceiling unit and used as a remote control. To remove it from the ceiling unit, press the release button. The control panel will swing down partway. Pivot it down further past the detent until it detaches from the hinge. To reinstall it, reverse the procedure.
07/07/09 09:57:22 31STX610 0268
Rear Entertainment System Replacing the Remote Control Batteries COVER
An improperly disposed of battery can hurt the environment. Always confirm local regulations for battery disposal.
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.
If it takes several pushes on the button to operate the rear entertainment system, have your dealer replace the batteries as soon as possible. Battery type: BR3032
This device complies with Industry Canada Standard RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.
263
Features
As required by the FCC: This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
07/07/09 09:57:31 31STX610 0269
Rear Entertainment System Playable DVDs
The DVD player can also play discs recorded in MP3/WMA formats and DTS CDs. Those packages or jackets should also bear the designation of ‘‘1’’ or ‘‘ALL’’. DVD-ROMs cannot be played in this system. This product incorporates copyright protection technology that is protected by U.S. patents and other intellectual property rights.
There are various types of DVDs available. Some of them are not compatible with your system. The DVD player in your rear entertainment system can play DVDs and CDs bearing the above marks on their packages or jackets.
264
Use of this copyright protection technology must be authorized by Macrovision, and is intended for home and other limited viewing uses only unless otherwise authorized by Macrovision. Reverse engineering or disassembly is prohibited.
Protecting DVDs The tips on how to handle and protect DVDs are basically the same as those for compact discs. Refer to ‘‘Protecting Your CDs’’ on page 229 .
07/07/09 09:57:38 31STX610 0270
Rear Entertainment System DVD Player Error Messages The chart on the right explains the error messages you may see in the display while playing a disc.
The audio system will try to play the disc. If there is still a problem, the error message will reappear. Press the eject button, and pull out the disc. Insert a different disc. If the new disc plays, there is a problem with the first disc. If the error message cycle repeats and you cannot clear it, take your vehicle to a dealer.
Cause
DISC ERROR
FOCUS Error
MECH ERROR
Mechanical Error
HEAT ERROR
High Temperature
REGION ERR
Invalid region code
PARENT ERR
Invalid parental control level
Solution Press the disc eject button, and remove the disc. Check for an error indication. Insert the disc again. If the code does not disappear or the disc cannot be removed, consult your dealer. Press the disc eject button, and remove the disc. Check for an error indication. Insert the disc again. If the code does not disappear or the disc cannot be removed, consult your dealer. Will disappear when the temperature returns to normal. The disc is not playable in this unit. Eject the disc, and insert a disc compatible with this system. Reinsert the disc, and increase the parental control level (see page 259 ).
265
Features
If you see an error message in the display while playing a disc, press the eject button. After ejecting the disc, check it for damage or deformation. If there is no damage, insert the disc again.
Error Massage
07/07/09 09:57:44 31STX610 0271
Rear Entertainment System Wireless Headphones
To use the headphones, pivot the earpieces outward. This turns them on. To adjust the volume, turn the dial on the bottom of the right earpiece. When you remove the headphones, the earpieces automatically pivot inward, and the headphones turn off. When not in use, store the headphones in the pocket of either front seat.
VOLUME DIAL
Some state and local government agencies prohibit the use of headphones by the driver of a motor vehicle. Always obey applicable laws and regulations.
266
The audio for the rear entertainment system is sent to the wireless headphones that come with the system. When using the headphones, make sure you wear them correctly: L (left) and R (right) are marked on the sides of the frame. Wearing the headphones backwards may affect audio reception, limiting the sound quality and range.
07/07/09 09:57:52 31STX610 0272
Rear Entertainment System Auxiliary Input Jacks
Replacing Batteries COVER
Features
TAB
Each headphone uses one AAA battery. The battery is under the cover on the left earpiece. To remove the cover, insert a coin in the slot and twist it slightly to pry the cover away from the earpiece. Pull the cover outward, and pivot it out of the way.
BATTERY
Remove the battery. Install the new battery in the earpiece as shown in the diagram next to the battery slot. Slide the cover back into place on the earpiece, then press down on the back edge to lock it in place.
Auxiliary input jacks and headphone connectors for the rear entertainment system are on the back of the center console compartment.
CONTINUED
267
07/07/09 09:57:58 31STX610 0273
Rear Entertainment System
VOLUME DIALS
AUXILIARY INPUT JACKS
The system will accept auxiliary inputs from standard video games and video equipment. Some video game power supplies may cause poor picture quality. V = Video jack L = Left audio jack R = Right audio jack
268
HEADPHONE CONNECTORS
There are three headphone connectors for the third seat passengers. Each connector has its own volume control.
07/07/09 09:58:05 31STX610 0274
Security System The security system will not set if the hood, tailgate, or any door is not fully closed. If the system will not set, check that the doors, the tailgate and the hood are fully closed. Do not attempt to alter this system or add other devices to it.
SECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR
Once the security system is set, opening any door, the tailgate, or the hood without using the key or the remote transmitter, will cause it to alarm. It also alarms if the radio is removed from the dashboard or the wiring is cut.
269
Features
The security system helps to protect your vehicle and valuables from theft. The horn sounds and a combination of headlights, position lights, side marker lights and taillights flashes if someone attempts to break into your vehicle or remove the audio unit. This alarm continues for 2 minutes, then the system resets. To reset an alarming system before the 2 minutes have elapsed, unlock the driver’s door with the key or the remote transmitter. The security system automatically sets 15 seconds after you lock the doors, hood, and the tailgate. For the system to activate, you must lock the doors and the tailgate from the outside with the key, driver’s lock tab, door lock master switch, or remote transmitter. The security system indicator on the instrument panel starts blinking immediately to show you the system is setting itself.
07/07/09 09:58:13 31STX610 0275
Cruise Control Cruise control allows you to maintain a set speed above 25 mph (40 km/h) without keeping your foot on the accelerator pedal. It should be used for cruising on straight, open highways. It is not recommended for city driving, winding roads, slippery roads, heavy rain, or bad weather.
Improper use of the cruise control can lead to a crash. Use the cruise control only when traveling on open highways in good weather.
Using Cruise Control CRUISE BUTTON RES/ACCEL BUTTON
CANCEL BUTTON
SET/DECEL BUTTON
1. Push in the CRUISE button on the steering wheel. The CRUISE MAIN indicator on the instrument panel comes on. The cruise control system can be left on, even when it is not in use. 2. Accelerate to the desired cruising speed above 25 mph (40 km/h).
270
3. Press and release the SET/ DECEL button on the steering wheel. The CRUISE CONTROL indicator on the instrument panel comes on to show the system is now activated.
07/07/09 09:58:21 31STX610 0276
Cruise Control
When climbing a steep hill, the automatic transmission may downshift to hold the set speed.
Changing the Set Speed You can increase the set cruising speed in any of these ways: Press and hold the RES/ACCEL button. When you reach the desired cruising speed, release the button. Push on the accelerator pedal. Accelerate to the desired cruising speed, then press the SET/ DECEL button. To increase the speed in very small amounts, tap the RES/ ACCEL button. Each time you do this, your vehicle will speed up about 1 mph (1.6 km/h).
You can decrease the set cruising speed in any of these ways: Press and hold the SET/DECEL button. Release the button when you reach the desired speed. To slow down in very small amounts, tap the SET/DECEL button. Each time you do this, your vehicle will slow down about 1 mph (1.6 km/h). Tap the brake pedal lightly with your foot. The CRUISE CONTROL indicator on the instrument panel will go out. When the vehicle slows to the desired speed, press the SET/ DECEL button.
CONTINUED
271
Features
Cruise control may not hold the set speed when you are going up and down hills. If your vehicle speed increases going down a hill, use the brakes to slow down. This will cancel the cruise control. To resume the set speed, press the RES/ACCEL button. The CRUISE CONTROL indicator on the instrument panel will come back on.
07/07/09 09:58:30 31STX610 0277
Cruise Control Even with cruise control turned on, you can still use the accelerator pedal to speed up for passing. After completing the pass, take your foot off the accelerator pedal. The vehicle will return to the set cruising speed.
Cancelling Cruise Control CRUISE BUTTON
Resting your foot on the brake pedal causes cruise control to cancel.
CANCEL BUTTON
You can cancel cruise control in any of these ways: Tap the brake pedal. Push the CANCEL button on the steering wheel. Push the CRUISE button on the steering wheel.
272
Resuming the Set Speed When you push the CANCEL button or tap the brake pedal, the system remembers the previously set speed. To return to that speed, accelerate to above 25 mph (40 km/h), then press and release the RES/ACCEL button. The CRUISE CONTROL indicator comes on. The vehicle accelerates to the same speed as before. Pressing the CRUISE button turns the system completely off and erases the previous cruising speed.
07/07/09 09:58:42 31STX610 0278
Compass Canadian MDX model
Compass Calibration If you see ‘‘−−’’ in the compass display and ‘‘CAL’’ and ‘‘ ’’ are shown in the calendar display, the compass is self-calibrating. The compass may need to be manually calibrated after exposure to a strong magnetic field. If the compass seems to be continually showing the wrong direction and is not self-calibrating, do the following.
Press and hold SET Press SET Press ▼ COMPASS DISPLAY
1. Press and hold the SET button for five seconds until the Clock display changes to ‘‘ZON ? N.’’ (Clock adjustment mode will be started after the first two seconds.) 2. Press the SET button. ‘‘CAL ? N’’ will be displayed. At this point, pressing SET button will exit calibration mode.
3. Press the ▼ button. ‘‘CAL ? Y’’ will be displayed. 4. Press the SET button. The compass display will change to ‘‘−−’’ and ‘‘CAL’’ and ‘‘ ’’ are shown. 5. Drive the vehicle slowly in two complete circles. CONTINUED
273
Features
Compass Operation Compass operation can be affected by driving near power lines or stations, across bridges, through tunnels, over railroad crossings, past large vehicles, or driving near large objects that can cause a magnetic disturbance. It can also be affected by accessories such as antennas and roof racks that are mounted by magnets.
07/07/09 09:58:52 31STX610 0279
Compass 6. When the display goes from ‘‘−−’’ to an actual heading, the unit is calibrated and the display returns to normal.
4. Find the zone for your area on the map. 5. If the zone is incorrect, press the ▼ button to cycle the count down, or the ▲ button to cycle the count up. Once the correct zone is displayed, continue to step 6.
NOTE: Do this procedure in an open area, away from buildings, power lines, and other vehicles.
6. Press the SET button to set the zone selection.
Compass Zone Selection
In most areas, there is a variation between magnetic north and true north. Zone selection is required so the compass can compensate for this variation. To check and select the zone, do this:
1. Press and hold the SET button for five seconds until the Clock display changes to ‘‘ZON ? N.’’ (Clock adjustment mode will be started after the first two seconds.) 2. Press the ▼ button. ‘‘ZOY ? Y’’ will be displayed. 3. Press the SET button. The zone the compass is currently in will be displayed.
274
7. Press and hold the SET button for about 5 seconds to exit the zone selection and return display to normal.
07/07/09 09:58:56 31STX610 0280
Compass
Zone Map
Features
275
07/07/09 09:59:05 31STX610 0281
HomeLink Universal Transceiver The HomeLink Universal Transceiver built into your vehicle can be programmed to operate up to three remote controlled devices around your home, such as garage doors, lighting, or home security systems. General Safety Information Before programming your HomeLink to operate a garage door opener, confirm that the opener has an external entrapment protection system, such as an ‘‘electronic eye,’’ or other safety and reverse stop features. If your garage door was manufactured before April 1, 1982, you may not be able to program HomeLink to operate it. These units do not have safety features that cause the motor to stop and reverse it if an obstacle is detected during closing, increasing the risk of injury. Do not use HomeLink with any
276
garage door opener that lacks safety stop and reverse features. Units manufactured between April 1, 1982 and January 1, 1993 may be equipped with safety stop and reverse features. If your unit does not have an external entrapment protection system, an easy test to confirm the function and performance of the safety stop and reverse feature is to lay a 2 × 4 under the closing door. The door should stop and reverse upon contacting the piece of wood. As an additional safety feature, garage door openers manufactured after January 1, 1993 are required to have external entrapment protection systems, such as an electronic eye, which detect an object obstructing the door. Important Safety Precautions Refer to the safety information that came with your garage door opener
to test that the safety features are functioning properly. If you do not have this information, contact the manufacturer of the equipment. Before programming HomeLink to a garage door or gate opener, make sure that people and objects are out of the way of the device to prevent potential injury or damage. When programming a garage door opener, park just outside the garage. Training HomeLink Before you begin − If you just received your vehicle and have not trained any of the buttons in HomeLink before, you should erase any previously learned codes before training the first button. To do this, press and hold the two outside buttons on the HomeLink transceiver for about 20 seconds, until the red indicator flashes. Release the buttons, then proceed to step 1.
07/07/09 09:59:17 31STX610 0282
HomeLink Universal Transceiver If you are training the second or third buttons, go directly to step 1.
RED INDICATOR
2. Press and hold the remote transmitter button and one of the HomeLink buttons at the same time.
3. Press and hold the remote transmitter button and one of the HomeLink buttons at the same time. While continuing to hold the HomeLink button, press and release the remote transmitter button every 2 seconds. If the red indicator in HomeLink begins to flash slowly at first, then rapidly, release both buttons, and go to step 4.
If the red indicator in HomeLink continues to flash slowly (does not begin to flash rapidly), repeat steps 1 thru 3. 4. Test the HomeLink button by pushing it for about 1 second. If the button works, programming is complete. If the button does not work go to step 5. 5. Push and hold the HomeLink button and watch the red indicator on HomeLink. If the indicator stays on, press the HomeLink button again; the remotely controlled device should operate. If the indicator flashes rapidly for 2 seconds then stays on, you have a rolling code transmitter: go to ‘‘Training with a Rolling Code System’’ (see page 278 ). CONTINUED
277
Features
1. Hold the end of the garage door opener remote transmitter 1 to 3 inches from HomeLink. Make sure you are not blocking your view of the red indicator in HomeLink.
If the red indicator in HomeLink begins to flash slowly at first, then rapidly, release both buttons, and go to step 4. If the red indicator in HomeLink continues to flash slowly (does not flash rapidly), your remote transmitter may stop transmitting after a short time. Go to step 3.
07/07/09 09:59:26 31STX610 0283
HomeLink Universal Transceiver 6. Repeat these steps to train the other two HomeLink buttons to operate any other compatible remotely controlled devices around your home (lighting, automatic gate, security system, etc.). Training With a Rolling Code System For security purposes, newer garage door opening systems use a ‘‘rolling’’ or variable code. Information from the remote control and the garage door opener is needed before HomeLink can operate the garage door opener. The ‘‘Training HomeLink’’ procedure trains HomeLink to the proper garage door opener code. The following procedure synchronizes HomeLink to the garage door opener so it sends and receives the correct codes.
278
1. Make sure you have properly completed the ‘‘Training HomeLink’’ procedure. 2. Find the ‘‘training’’ button on your garage door opener unit. The location will vary, depending on the manufacturer. TRAINING BUTTON
have approximately 30 seconds to complete the following steps. 4. Press and hold the button on HomeLink for 3 to 4 seconds. 5. Press and hold the HomeLink button again for 3 to 4 seconds. This should turn off the training indicator on the garage door opener unit. (Some systems may require you to press the button up to three times.) 6. Press the HomeLink button again for about 1 second. It should operate the garage door.
3. Press the training button on the garage door opener unit until the indicator next to the button comes on. The indicator may blink, or come on and stay on. You then
07/07/09 09:59:37 31STX610 0284
HomeLink Universal Transceiver Erasing Codes To erase the codes stored in all three buttons, press and hold the two outside buttons until the red indicator begins to flash, then release the buttons.
Retraining a Button If you want to retrain a programmed button for a new device, you do not have to erase all button memory. You can replace the existing memory code using this procedure: 1. Press and hold the HomeLink button to be trained until the HomeLink indicator begins to flash slowly. If a rolling code transmitter was previously programmed, the indicator will flash rapidly for 2 seconds, and then stay on for about 23 seconds.
2. Once the HomeLink indicator begins to flash slowly, continue to hold the HomeLink button, and follow steps 3 thru 6 under ‘‘Training HomeLink’’ (see page 276 ). Client Assistance If you have problems with training the HomeLink Universal Transceiver, or would like information on home products that can be operated by HomeLink, call (800) 355-3515. On the Internet, go to www.homelink.com.
HomeLink is a registered trademark of Johnson Controls, Inc.
As required by the FCC: This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. This device complies with Industry Canada Standard RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.
279
Features
You should erase all three codes before selling the vehicle.
If a standard transmitter was programmed, the indicator will stay on for about 25 seconds.
07/07/09 09:59:46 31STX610 0285
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Your vehicle is equipped with Bluetooth HandsFreeLink (HFL). HFL uses Bluetooth technology to link your cell phone to your vehicle. With HFL, you can place and receive calls through your vehicle’s audio system, without the distraction of handling your cell phone. To use this feature, you need a Bluetoothcompatible cell phone with the Hands-Free Profile. For more information, and a list of compatible cell phones, visit www.acura.com/ handsfreelink, or call 1-888-528-7876. In Canada, visit www.acura.ca, or call 1-888-9-ACURA-9. The HFL is available in English on U.S. models, and in both English and French on Canadian models. To change the language, see page 305 . Here are the main features of the HFL. Instructions for using the HFL begin on page 290 .
280
Voice Control HFL recognizes simple voice commands, such as phone numbers and names. It uses these commands to automatically dial, receive, and store numbers. For more information on voice control, see Using Voice Control on page 283 . Bluetooth Wireless Technology Bluetooth is a registered trademark of Bluetooth SIG, Inc. Bluetooth is the wireless technology that links your phone to the HFL. The HFL uses a Class 2 Bluetooth, which means the maximum range between your phone and vehicle is 30 feet (10 meters). To use the HFL, your phone must have approved Bluetooth capability along with the Hands Free Profile. This type of phone is available through many phone makers and cellular carriers. You can also find an approved phone by visiting
www.acura.com/handsfreelink, or by calling the HandsFreeLink consumer support at 1-888-528-7876. In Canada, visit www.acura.ca, or call 1-888-9-ACURA-9.
Incoming/Outgoing Calls With a linked phone, the HFL allows you to send and receive calls in your vehicle without holding the phone. Phonebook The HFL can store up to 50 names and phone numbers in its phonebook. With a linked phone, you can then automatically dial any name or number in the phonebook.
07/07/09 09:59:57 31STX610 0286
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink On vehicles with navigation system
On all models
You can also store the desired number to the HFL directly from your cellphone using the receive contact function in the HFL.
Microphone The HFL microphone is on the ceiling, between the front map lights and the console buttons. On models with navigation system, the microphone is shared with the navigation system. Audio System When the HFL is in use, the sound comes through the vehicle’s front audio system speakers. If the audio system is in use while operating either of the HFL buttons or making a call, the HFL over-rides the audio system. To change the volume level, use the audio system volume knob, or the steering wheel volume controls.
HFL Buttons HFL TALK BUTTON
Features
Your vehicle’s HFL system has the cellular phonebook import function. This allows you to import your cellular phonebook to the HFL. Using the navigation system, you can make a call directly and store a desired number in the HFL from the list shown on the navigation display. For more information on how to import the phonebook or to make a call, see page 290 .
HFL BACK BUTTON
To operate the HFL, use the HFL Talk and Back buttons on the left side of the steering wheel. The HFL buttons are used as follows: HFL Talk: This button is used before you give a command, to answer incoming calls, and to confirm system information.
CONTINUED
281
07/07/09 10:00:07 31STX610 0287
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Multi-Information Display HFL TALK BUTTON
SIGNAL STRENGTH
HFL MODE
BATTERY LEVEL STATUS
Signal Strength* − Indicates the network signal strength of the current phone. Five bars equals full strength. ROAM Status* − Indicates your phone is roaming. Battery Level Status* − Indicates the power currently remaining in your phone’s battery. Five bars equals full battery strength.
HFL BACK BUTTON
Press and release the button, then wait for a beep before giving a command. HFL Back: This button is used to end a call, go back to the previous voice control command, and to cancel an operation.
282
ROAM STATUS
PHONE DIALING
When you are operating the HFL, or when you manually select HFL on the multi-information display, you will see this information on the screen:
HFL Mode − Indicates when you are dialing and receiving calls. Phone Dialing − Indicates the number you entered or the number of the incoming call. * : Some phones do not send this information to the HFL.
07/07/09 10:00:17 31STX610 0288
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink How to Use the HFL The HFL is operated by the HFL Talk and Back buttons on the left side of the steering wheel. The next few pages provide instructions for all basic features of the HFL.
To enter a command, press and release the Talk button. Then, after the beep, say your command in a clear, natural tone. Close the windows and the moonroof. When voice commands are used, the fan speed will be automatically adjusted to low. However, for better voice recognition, lowering the fan speed may be necessary. Adjust the airflow from both the dashboard and side vents so they do not blow against the microphone on the ceiling. After pressing the Talk button, wait for the beep, then give a voice command.
Give a voice command in a clear natural speaking voice without pausing between words or numbers. If the system cannot recognize your command because of the background noise, speak louder. If the microphone picks up voices other than yours, the system may not interpret your voice commands correctly. If the HFL does not recognize a command, its response is, ‘‘Pardon.’’ If it doesn’t recognize the command a second time, its response is, ‘‘Please repeat.’’ If it doesn’t recognize the command a third time, it plays the Help prompt.
CONTINUED
283
Features
NOTE: All phones may not operate identically, and some may cause inconsistent operation of the HFL.
Using Voice Control Here are some guidelines for using voice control:
07/07/09 10:00:23 31STX610 0289
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink To hear a list of available options at any time, press the Talk button, wait for the beep, and say, ‘‘Hands free link help.’’ Many commands can be spoken together. For example, you can say, ‘‘Dial 123-456-7891.’’ To enter a string of numbers in a Call or Dial command, you can say them all at once, or you can separate them in blocks of 3, 4, 7, 10, and 11. To skip a voice prompt, press the Talk button while the HFL is speaking. The HFL will then begin listening for your next command.
284
To go back one step in a command process, say, ‘‘Go back,’’ or press the Back button. If nothing is said while the HFL is listening for a command, the HFL will time out and stop its voice recognition. The next time you press the Talk button, the HFL begins listening from the point at which it timed out. To end a command sequence at any time, press and hold the Back button, or press and release the Talk button, wait for the beep, and say, ‘‘Cancel.’’ The next time you press the Talk button, the HFL begins from its main menu.
When you finish a command sequence, the HFL goes back to its main menu. For example, when you store the name, ‘‘Eric,’’ the HFL response is, ‘‘Eric has been stored.’’ The next time you press the Talk button, you will be at the main menu.
07/07/09 10:00:31 31STX610 0290
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Setting Up the System The voice of the HFL can be set to male or female (U.S. models only). Also, the incoming notification can be set to a ring tone, a prompt, or no notification.
2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Setup.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Would you like male or female prompts?’’
4. Press and release the Talk button. If you say ‘‘Yes’’ after the beep, the HFL response is, ‘‘Would you like the notification to be a ring tone or prompt?’’ If you say ‘‘No’’ after the beep, the HFL returns to its main menu. Saying ‘‘No’’ will result in no ring tone or prompt playback during an incoming call. The audio system will still mute, and a message will be displayed.
5. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Ring tone’’ or ‘‘Prompt.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘A ring tone will be used’’ or ‘‘An incoming call prompt will be used.’’ If you choose ‘‘Ring tone,’’ you will hear a ring tone through the audio speakers to announce an incoming call. If you choose ‘‘Prompt,’’ you will hear this message to announce an incoming call: ‘‘You have an incoming call.’’ 6. The HFL response continues ‘‘A security option is available to lock the HFL system. Each time the vehicle is turned on, a passcode would be required to use this system. Would you like this security option turned on?’’ If you say ‘‘Yes,’’ you can set your passcode. Refer to the setting procedure in the next column.
285
Features
To set up the system, do this:
1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘System.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘System options are setup and clear.’’
3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Male’’ or ‘‘Female,’’ depending on the system voice you want. The HFL response is, ‘‘Male (Female) prompts have been selected. Would you like an audible notification of an incoming call?’’
07/07/09 10:00:43 31STX610 0291
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Setting Your Passcode The HFL will accept a numeric, fourdigit passcode that you can use for security purposes. To set your passcode, do this:
1. Follow the system setup procedure as described previously. 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ 3. The HFL response is ‘‘What is the four-digit number you would like to set as your passcode?’’ 4. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the four-digit passcode you want to use. For example, say ‘‘1, 2, 3, 4.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘1, 2, 3, 4. Is this correct?’’
286
5. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Security is on. Each time the vehicle is turned on, the passcode will be required to use the system. The system setup is complete. Returning to the main menu.’’ 6. Press and release the Talk button. If you say ‘‘No.’’ after the beep, the HFL response is ‘‘Security will not be used. The system setup is complete.’’ To enter your passcode, do this;
Once a passcode is set, you can lock the HFL so it only operates after the passcode is entered. 1. The HFL will prompt you for your passcode each time the ignition switch is turned to the ON (II) position and you press the Talk button. You will only be asked for the passcode once per ignition
cycle. If the passcode is set, its response is ‘‘The system is locked. What is the four-digit passcode?’’ 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say your four-digit passcode. For example, say ‘‘1, 2, 3, 4.’’ 3. If the passcode is correct, the HFL response is ‘‘Main menu.’’ If the passcode is not correct, the HFL response is ‘‘1,2,3,4 is incorrect. Please try again.’’ Go back to the step 2. If you forget your passcode and you cannot activate the HFL, consult your dealer to cancel the passcode.
07/07/09 10:00:52 31STX610 0292
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink NOTE: HFL does not allow you to pair your phone if the vehicle is moving. For pairing, your phone must be in its Discovery mode. Up to six phones can be paired to the HFL. The following procedure works for most phones. If you cannot pair your phone to the HFL with this procedure, refer to your phone’s operating manual, visit www.acura.com/handsfreelink, call the Hands Free Link consumer support at (888) 528-7876, or call your phone retailer. In Canada, visit www.acura.ca or call (888) 9ACURA-9. During the pairing process, turn off any previously paired phones before pairing a new phone.
1. With your phone on and the ignition in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position, press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Phone setup.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Phone setup options are status, pair, edit, delete, and list.’’ 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Pair.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘The pairing process requires operation of your mobile phone. For safety, only perform this function while the vehicle is stopped. State a fourdigit code for pairing. Note this code. It will be requested by the phone.’’ 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the four-digit code you want to use. For example, say ‘‘1, 2, 3, 4.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘1, 2, 3, 4. Is this correct?’’ CONTINUED
287
Features
Pairing Your Phone Your Bluetooth compatible phone with HandsFree Profile must be paired to the HFL before you can make and receive hands-free calls. To confirm that your phone is Bluetooth compatible, visit www. acura.com/handsfreelink, or call 1-888528-7876. In Canada, visit www.acura. ca, or call 1-888-9-ACURA-9. Your phone retailer should also be able to confirm that your phone is Bluetooth compatible.
07/07/09 10:01:02 31STX610 0293
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink 4. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Searching for a Bluetooth phone.’’ NOTE: Steps 5 and 6 show a common way to get your phone into its Discovery mode. If these steps do not work on your phone, refer to the phone’s operating manual. 5. Follow the prompts on your phone to get it into its Discovery mode. The phone will search for the HFL. When it comes up, select HandsFreeLink from the list of options displayed on your phone. 6. When asked by the phone, enter the four-digit code from step 3 into your phone. The HFL response is ‘‘A new phone has been found. What would you like to name this phone?’’
288
7. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the name you want to use. For example, say ‘‘Eric’s phone.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Eric’s phone has been successfully paired. Returning to the main menu.’’ 8. If you want to pair another phone, repeat steps 1 through 7. Once the pairing process is completed, AcuraLink may display a connection confirmation screen. This screen is used to create a data connection between your cell phone and the AcuraLink system. You can choose to set up the data connection now, or do it later. If you want to do it now, exit the HFL menu by pressing the HFL Back button one or more times. To rename a paired phone, do this:
1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Phone setup.’’
The HFL response is ‘‘Phone setup options are status, pair, edit, delete, and list.’’ 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Edit.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Which phone would you like to edit?’’ 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the name of the phone you want to rename. For example, say ‘‘Eric’s phone.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘What is the new name for Eric’s phone?’’ 4. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the new name of the phone. For example, say ‘‘Lisa’s phone.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘The name has been changed. Returning to the main menu.’’
07/07/09 10:01:12 31STX610 0294
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink To delete a paired phone, do this:
1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Phone setup.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Phone setup options are status, pair, edit, delete, and list.’’
3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the name of the phone you want to delete. For example say ‘‘Eric’s phone.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Would you like to delete Eric’s phone?’’ 4. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Preparing to delete Eric’s phone.’’ Say ‘‘OK’’ to continue. Otherwise, say ‘‘Go back,’’ or ‘‘Cancel.’’
To list all paired phones, do this:
1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Phone setup.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Phone setup options are status, pair, edit, delete, and list.’’ 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘List.’’ The HFL responds by listing the name of each paired phone. When all phones paired to the system have been read, the HFL response is ‘‘The entire list has been read. Returning to the main menu.’’
To find out the status of the phone being used, do this:
1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Phone setup.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘Phone setup options are status, pair, edit, delete, and list.’’
2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Status.’’ An example of the HFL response is, ‘‘Eric’s phone is linked. Battery strength is three bars. Signal strength is five bars, and the phone is roaming. Returning to the main menu.’’
CONTINUED
289
Features
2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Delete.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘Which phone would you like to delete?’’
5. Press and release the Talk button. If you say ‘‘OK’’ after the beep, the HFL response is ‘‘The phone has been deleted. Returning to the main menu.’’ If you say ‘‘Go back,’’ or ‘‘Cancel,’’ the phone will not be deleted.
07/07/09 10:01:20 31STX610 0295
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink To change from the currently linked phone to another paired phone, do this:
1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Next phone.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Searching for the next phone.’’ The HFL then disconnects the linked phone and searches for another paired phone. If no other phones are found, the first phone remains linked.
Making a Call You can make calls using any phone number, or by using a name in the HFL phonebook. You can also redial the last number called. During a call, the HFL allows you to talk up to 30 minutes after you remove the key from the ignition switch. Continuing a call without running the engine may discharge and weaken the vehicle’s battery.
2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the number you want to call. For example, say ‘‘123 456 7891.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘123 456 7891. Say call, dial, or continue to add numbers.’’
To make a call using a phone number, do this:
3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Call’’ or ‘‘Dial.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Calling’’ or ‘‘Dialing.’’ Once connected, you will hear the person you called through the audio speakers. To change the volume, use the audio system volume knob, or the steering wheel volume controls.
1. With your phone on and the ignition in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position, press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Call’’ or ‘‘Dial.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘What name or number would you like to call/ dial?’’
290
On vehicles with navigation system
You can also make a call directly from the list shown on the navigation display.
4. To end the call, press the Back button.
07/07/09 10:01:29 31STX610 0296
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink To make a call using a name in the HFL phonebook, do this:
2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the name you want to call. For example, say ‘‘Eric.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Would you like to call Eric?’’ 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Calling’’ or ‘‘Dialing.’’ Once connected, you will hear the person you called through the audio speakers. To change the volume, use the audio system volume knob, or the steering wheel volume controls.
To redial the last number called by the phone, press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Redial.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘Redialing.’’ Once connected, you will hear the person you called through the audio speakers. To change the volume, use the audio system volume knob, or the steering wheel volume controls.
Sending Numbers or Names During a Call The HFL allows you to send numbers or names during a call. This is useful when you call a menudriven phone system. You can also program account numbers into the HFL phonebook for easy retrieval during menu-driven calls. To send a number during a call, do this:
1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Send.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘What name or number would you like to send?’’ 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the number you want to send. For example, say ‘‘1, 2, 3.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘1, 2, 3. Say send, or continue to add numbers.’’ NOTE: To send a pound (#), say ‘‘pound.’’ To send a star (*), say ‘‘star.’’
291
Features
1. With your phone on and the ignition in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position, press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Call’’ or ‘‘Dial.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘What name or number would you like to call/ dial?’’
4. To end the call, press the Back button.
07/07/09 10:01:40 31STX610 0297
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Send.’’ The dial tones will be sent, and the call will continue. To send a name during a call, do this:
1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Send.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘What name or number would you like to send?’’ 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the name you want to send. For example, say ‘‘Account number.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Would you like to send account number?’’ 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Send.’’ The dial tones will be sent, and the call will continue.
292
Receiving a Call If you receive a call when you are not on the phone, the HFL interrupts the audio system (if it is on), and plays the incoming call notification, if activated. To answer the call, press the Talk button and begin speaking. If you don’t want to answer the call, press the Back button. If your phone has Call Waiting, and you receive a call when you are on the phone, press and release the Talk button to answer it. When you do this, the original call is placed on hold. To return to the original call, press the Talk button again. If you don’t want to answer the new call, disregard it, and continue with your original call. If you want to hang up the original call and answer the new call, press the Back button.
Transferring a Call During a call, you can transfer it from the HFL to your phone, or from your phone to the HFL. To transfer a call from the HFL to your phone, do this:
Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Transfer.’’ The audio switches from the HFL to the phone.
To transfer a call from your phone to the HFL, do this:
Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Transfer.’’ The audio switches from your phone to the HFL.
07/07/09 10:01:51 31STX610 0298
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Muting a Call During a call, you can mute or unmute your voice to the person you are talking to. To mute your voice, do this:
To unmute your voice, do this:
2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Mute.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘Mute is canceled.’’
To add a name, do this:
1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Phonebook.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Phonebook options are store, edit, delete, receive contact, and list.’’ 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Store.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘What name would you like to store?’’
3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the name you would like to store. For example, say ‘‘Eric’’ or say ‘‘account number.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘What is the number for Eric,’’ or ‘‘What is the number for account number?’’ 4. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the number. For example, say ‘‘123 456 7891.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘123 456 7891.’’ Say ‘‘Enter.’’ or continue to add numbers. 5. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Enter.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Eric (or account number) has been stored. Returning to the main menu.’’
CONTINUED
293
Features
1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Mute.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘Mute is active.’’
Setting up the Phonebook The HFL phonebook can store up to 50 names with their associated numbers. These can be any types of numbers. For example, you can store a phone number and use it to make a call, or you can store an account number and use it during a call to a menu-driven phone system.
07/07/09 10:02:02 31STX610 0299
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink To edit the number of a name, do this:
5. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Enter.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘The number has been changed. Returning to the main menu.’’
4. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘The name has been deleted. Returning to the main menu.’’
2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Edit.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘What name would you like to edit?’’
1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Phonebook.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Phonebook options are store, edit, delete, receive contact, and list.’’
To delete a name, do this:
To list all names in the phonebook, do this:
1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Phonebook.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Phonebook options are store, edit, delete, receive contact, and list.’’
3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the name you would like to edit. For example, say ‘‘Eric.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘What is the new number for Eric?’’ 4. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the new number for Eric. For example, say ‘‘987 654 3219.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘987 654 3219.’’ Say ‘‘Enter.’’ or continue to add numbers.
294
2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Delete.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘What name would you like to delete?’’ 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the name you would like to delete. For example, say ‘‘Eric.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Would you like to delete Eric?’’
1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Phonebook.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘The Phonebook options are store, edit, delete, receive contact, and list.’’ 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘List.’’ The HFL responds by listing the names in the phonebook. When the end of the list is reached, the HFL response is, ‘‘The entire list has been read. Returning to the main menu.’’
07/07/09 10:02:11 31STX610 0300
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink To call a name from the phonebook list, do this:
wheel volume controls. Storing a Phone Number Directly from Your Phone You can store the desired number to the HFL phonebook directly from your cellular phone.
2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘List.’’ The HFL responds by listing the names in the phonebook. When it says the name you want to call, for example, Eric, press the Talk button, and then say ‘‘Call.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘Would you like to call Eric?’’
NOTE: Your phone may not have this capability. Visit www.acura.com/ handsfreelink or call the Hands Free Link consumer support at (888) 528-7876. In Canada, visit www.acura. ca or call (888) 9-ACURA-9. You can see your phone’s owner’s manual for information.
3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Calling.’’ Once connected, you will hear the person you called through the audio speakers. To change the volume, use the audio system volume knob, or the steering
To store a phone number from your phone:
1. With your phone on and the ignition switch in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position, press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Phonebook.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘Phonebook options are store,
2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Receive contact.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘The receive process requires operation of your mobile phone. For safety, only perform this function while the vehicle is stopped. HFL is now waiting to receive a contact from a Bluetooth device.’’ 3. Select a desired number from the list on your phone, and transmit/ send (individual steps will vary for each type of phone, refer to your phone’s owner’s manual) via Bluetooth. The HFL response is ‘‘One phone number has been received for this contact. What name would you like to store for the mobile number? To discard this number, say ‘Discard.’ ’’
CONTINUED
295
Features
1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Phonebook.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Phonebook options are store, edit, delete, receive contact, and list.’’
edit, delete, receive contact and list.’’
07/07/09 10:02:19 31STX610 0301
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink 4. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the name you would like to store. For example, say ‘‘Neil at work.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘Neil at work will be stored. Is this correct?’’ 5. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say either ‘‘Yes’’ or ‘‘No.’’ If you say ‘‘Yes,’’ the HFL response is, ‘‘Neil at work has been stored. Would you like HFL to receive another contact?’’ Go to step 6. If you say ‘‘No,’’ the HFL response is ‘‘Returning to the main menu.’’
296
6. If you want to continue to store any other numbers, press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘HFL is now waiting to receive a contact from a Bluetooth device.’’ 7. Select a desired number from the list on your phone, and transmit/ send (individual steps will vary for each type of phone, refer to your phone’s owner’s manual) via Bluetooth. The HFL response is ‘‘One phone number has been received for this contact. What name would you like to store for the mobile number? To discard this number, say ‘Discard.’ ’’
8. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the name you would like to store. For example, say ‘‘Susan at work.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘Susan at work will be stored. Is this correct?’’ 9. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say either ‘‘Yes’’ or ‘‘No.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Susan at work has been stored. Would you like HFL to receive another contact?’’ 10. If you do not want to continue to store any other numbers, press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘No.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Returning to the main menu.’’
07/07/09 10:02:27 31STX610 0302
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Cellular Phonebook Options
PIN Number. This option allows you to add, change, or remove a PIN number for any phonebook that has been imported.
On vehicles with navigation system
NOTE: Your phone may not have this capability. Visit www.acura.com/ handsfreelink or call the Hands Free Link consumer support at (888) 528-7876. In Canada, visit www.acura. ca or call (888) 9-ACURA-9. You can see your phone’s owner’s manual for information.
Import Cellular Phonebook: This option allows you to store the phonebook of your cellular phone in the HFL. When you link your phone to the HFL and select this option, the system will start importing and loading the phonebook. To use the cellular phonebook with the HFL, say or select ‘‘Cellular Phonebook’’ from the Information screen. The navigation display will change as shown above. If any phonebook is not stored and your phone is not linked to the HFL, Cellular Phonebook is grayed out.
CONTINUED
297
Features
The cellular phonebook option allows you to store up to 1,000 names and 10,000 phone numbers in the phonebook of Bluetooth HandsFreeLink from your cellular phonebook. The maximum names and numbers to be stored varies on the data size. With the HFL, you can then automatically dial any name or number in the phonebook.
07/07/09 10:02:34 31STX610 0303
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Search Imported Phonebook: This option allows you to search the phone numbers stored in the HFL. When you enter keyword for a person’s name, such as the first name or last name, the system will find the number you want and let you make calls. Delete Imported Phonebook: This option allows you to delete the stored phonebook from the HFL. When you link your phone to the HFL and select this option, the system will automatically delete the phonebook of the linked phone from the HFL (see page 297 ).
298
To import the cellular phonebook
You can import the phonebook of your cellular phone in the HFL. Link your phone to the HFL and select ‘‘Import Cellular Phonebook’’ from the ‘‘Select an option’’ screen. When the message ‘‘The import was successful.’’ is displayed, push in on the Interface Dial to select ‘‘OK.’’
NOTE: HFL does not allow you to pair your phone if the vehicle is moving. Up to six phones can be paired to the HFL. For information on linking to the HFL, see page 287 .
07/07/09 10:02:44 31STX610 0304
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink To search the imported phonebook
Select a phonebook from the displayed list. If the phonebook you select has a PIN icon, you will need the 4-digit PIN number to access the phonebook. The following screen will appear. Features
Enter the keyword for a person’s name, such as the first name or last name, using the Interface Dial. If the system does not find an exact match, say or select ‘‘LIST’’ when you finish entering the keyword.
You can search the stored number by entering keywords to make calls by using the HFL. Select ‘‘Search Imported Phonebook’’ from the ‘‘Select an option’’ screen. The display will change as shown above.
Enter the PIN number to access the phonebook. You cannot access a PIN protected phonebook if you do not use the correct PIN number.
The system will display a list of person’s names, with the closest match to the name you entered at the top of the list. CONTINUED
299
07/07/09 10:02:55 31STX610 0305
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Select the number (1−6) of the desired person from the list. Up to three category icons are displayed in the right side of the list. These category icons indicate how many numbers are stored for the person. If a name has more than three category icons, ‘‘ … ’’ is displayed.
Work
The following category icons will appear:
Fax
Preference
300
Pager
Car
Home
Voice
Mobile
Other
After selecting a person, the system will display a list of the person’s phone numbers. Select the desired number from the list to make a call.
07/07/09 10:03:04 31STX610 0306
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink To store in the Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
To delete the imported phonebook
Select a phonebook from the displayed list. If the phonebook you select has a PIN icon, you will need the 4-digit PIN number to access the phonebook. The following screen will appear. Features
Say or select ‘‘STORE IN HandsFreeLink’’ from the ‘‘Select a number to call’’ screen. The screen shown above will appear. Select the desired number from the list to store it in the HFL.
You can delete the stored phonebook from the HFL. Link your phone to the HFL and select ‘‘Delete Imported Phonebook’’ from the ‘‘Select an option’’ screen. The display will change as shown above.
Enter the PIN number to access the phonebook. You cannot access a PIN protected phonebook if you do not use the correct PIN number. CONTINUED
301
07/07/09 10:03:12 31STX610 0307
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink After you enter the correct PIN number, or if the phonebook you select is not PIN protected, the following screen appears.
Say or select ‘‘Yes’’, and the message ‘‘The imported phonebook has been deleted.’’ will appear. Select ‘‘OK’’ to complete the deletion.
302
To add, change, or remove a PIN number from any phonebook
You can add, change or remove a PIN number from any phonebook. Select ‘‘PIN Number’’ from the ‘‘Select an Option’’ screen. The display will change as shown above.
To add a PIN number
1. Select the phonebook you wish to add the PIN number to. The phonebook you select cannot already have a PIN icon. The display will change as shown above.
07/07/09 10:03:19 31STX610 0308
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink To change a PIN number
Features
2. Enter the 4-digit PIN number. You will be asked to re-enter the PIN to verify.
1. Select the phonebook that you wish to change the PIN number for. The display will change as shown above.
2. Enter your current PIN number.
CONTINUED
303
07/07/09 10:03:27 31STX610 0309
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Clearing the System This operation clears the HFL of your passcode, your paired phones, all names in the HFL phonebook, and all imported phonebooks. Clearing is recommended before you sell your vehicle. To clear the system, do this:
1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘System.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘System options are setup and clear.’’ 3. Enter your new 4-digit PIN number. You will be asked to reenter the PIN to verify.
304
2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Clear.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘This process will clear all paired phones, clear all entries in the phonebook, clear the passcode, and restore the defaults in the system setup. Is this what you would like to do?’’
3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Preparing to clear all paired phones, all phonebook entries, the passcode, and restore the defaults in the system setup. Say OK to proceed, otherwise say go back or cancel.’’
07/07/09 10:03:36 31STX610 0310
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink 4. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘OK’’ to proceed, or say ‘‘Go back’’ or ‘‘Cancel.’’
Canadian models only To change from English to French, do this:
1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Change language.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘English or French?’’ 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘French.’’ The HFL response is ‘‘Vous avez selectionne Français. Les noms enregistres en mode Anglais ne seront pas accessible en mode Français. Voulez-vous continuer? You have selected French. Name tags that were stored while in English mode will not be accessible in French mode. Would you like to continue? ’’
3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Oui’’ or ‘‘Yes.’’ If there are no paired phones without French name tags, the HFL response is ‘‘Venillez attendre que le systeme change de langue. Please wait while the language is changed.’’ ‘‘La langue a ete changee. Retour au menu principal.’’ NOTE: If there are paired phones without French name tags, the following prompts will continue. If there are paired phones without French name tags, the HFL response is ‘‘Pour que le système identifie les téléphones qui ont été jumelés dans une autre langue, les noms des téléphones doivent être réenregistrés.’’
CONTINUED
305
Features
5. If you said ‘‘OK,’’ the HFL response is, ‘‘Please wait while the system is cleared.’’ This may take up to 2 minutes to complete, then the HFL response is, ‘‘The system has been cleared. Returning to the main menu.’’
Changing Language
07/07/09 10:03:43 31STX610 0311
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink 4. The HFL response is, for example, ‘‘Quel est le nom Français pour <Paul’s phone>?’’ Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Téléphone de Paul.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘Quel est le nom Français pour <Pat’s phone>?’’ Press and release the Talk button. Say ‘‘Téléphone de Pat.’’ After all paired phones missing a French name tag are rerecorded, the HFL will prompt, ‘‘Retour au menu principal.’’
306
To change from French to English, do this:
1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Changer Langue.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘Anglais ou Français?’’ 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Anglais.’’ The HFL response is, ‘‘You have selected English. Name tags that were stored while in French mode will not be accessible in English mode. Would you like to continue? Vous avez selectionne Anglais. Les noms enregistres en mode Français ne seront pas accessible en mode Anglais. Voulez-vous contnuez?’’
3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Yes’’ or ‘‘Oui.’’ If there are no paired phones without English name tags, the HFL response is ‘‘Please wait while the language is changed. Venillez attendre que le systeme change de langue.’’ ‘‘The language has been changed. Returning to the main menu.’’ NOTE: If there are paired phones without English name tags, the following prompts will continue. If there are paired phones without English name tags, the HFL response is ‘‘The language has been changed. For the system to identify phones that were paired while in another language, the phone names need to be rerecorded.’’
07/07/09 10:03:48 31STX610 0312
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
HFL Limitations In addition, you cannot use the HFL while using AcuraLink.
As required by the FCC: This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
Features
4. The HFL says, for example, ‘‘What is the English name for <Téléphone de Paul>?’’ Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Paul’s phone. ’’ The HFL response is ‘‘What is the English name for <Téléphone de Pat>?’’ Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ‘‘Pat’s phone.’’ After all paired phones missing an English name tag are re-recorded, the HFL will say ‘‘Returning to the main menu.’’
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. This device complies with Industry Canada Standard RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.
307
07/07/09 10:03:56 31STX610 0313
AcuraLink U.S. Technology and Sport Packages
AcuraLink enhances your ownership experience by providing a direct communication link between your vehicle and the Acura Server. Working through the XM radio satellite, AcuraLink works in conjunction with the navigation system, Bluetooth HandsFreeLink (HFL), and audio system in your vehicle. It displays and receives several kinds of messages, including:
Interface Dial Most AcuraLink functions are controlled by the interface dial. The interface dial has two parts, a knob and a selector. KNOB
ENTER
Operating tips and information on your vehicle’s features. Important recall and safety information. Maintenance information to keep your vehicle in top condition. Diagnostic information to provide information about any problems with your vehicle.
308
SELECTOR
The knob turns left and right. Use it to make selections or adjustments to a list or menu on the screen.
The selector can be pushed left, right, up, down, and in. Use the selector to scroll through lists, to select menus, and to highlight menu items. When you make a selection, push the center of the selector (ENTER) to go to that selection.
07/07/09 10:04:06 31STX610 0314
AcuraLink Reading Messages If you have new messages, an envelope icon appears in the top right corner of the navigation screen.
To view previously read messages:
Features
To open a message: Press ENTER on the interface selector, then select New Message from the navigation system map menu.
A list of all messages will be shown. New Messages will be at the top. Select the message you want to read by pressing ENTER.
Press the INFO button. The information screen will be shown.
CONTINUED
309
07/07/09 10:04:15 31STX610 0315
AcuraLink Unread messages have a closed envelope icon next to them. The icon disappears when it has already been read.
Message Options
NOTE: Only Diagnostic Info messages overlay the navigation screen while driving. They indicate if your vehicle has a problem that may need immediate attention (see page 315 ). Select ‘‘Messages’’, then select a message category by pressing ENTER. Select the message you want to read and press ENTER.
310
After purchasing your vehicle, messages may not appear immediately. Your dealer has to register the vehicle identification before you can receive messages. This can take several days to process.
When you open a message, you can read a summary of it, and then choose one of several options. If an option is not available for a message, that button will not be highlighted.
07/07/09 10:04:23 31STX610 0316
AcuraLink Delete − Select this button to delete the current message.
Call − Select this button to call a phone number embedded in the message. When you select Call, the Bluetooth HandsFreeLink (HFL) dials the number for you. To make a call, your Bluetooth compatible phone must be paired to the vehicle’s HandsFreeLink system, powered on, and located within the vehicle (see page 280 ).
Call Your Acura Dealer − Select this button to call the Acura dealer you purchased your vehicle from. AcuraLink also directs you to this dealer so you can schedule a maintenance appointment or receive information about a message. If your assigned servicing dealer changes, AcuraLink will reset to call that dealer.
Diagnostic Info − Select this button to get more information about the current diagnostic message. To use this option, your cellphone must be paired with the HFL. In addition, the paired phone must have a compatible data service and be set up with the AcuraLink system to make a data connection. Access the handsfreelink.com website to find out which data services are currently compatible with AcuraLink. Message Preferences To set your AcuraLink preferences (the types of messages you want to receive, if any), visit the Owner Link website at www.owners.acura.com, and choose what you would like to receive. If you do not have internet access, call Acura Client Services at (800) 382-2238; they can set your message preferences for you.
311
Features
Voice − Select this button to hear a voice read the entire message. This gives you more information than the screen can display at one time. When you select the Voice button, it changes to a Stop Reading button. Select the button again to stop the voice.
Find Nearest Acura Dealer − Select this button to find the nearest Acura dealer using the navigation system.
07/07/09 10:04:33 31STX610 0317
AcuraLink Deleting Messages NOTE: Diagnostic info and recall/ campaign messages can only be deleted by your dealer. To delete a single message: Press the INFO button to bring up the Information screen. Scroll to the Messages option, then select it by pressing ENTER on the interface selector. Select the message category that contains the message you want to delete. Use the interface knob to scroll up or down to the message title you want to delete, and select it by pressing ENTER on the interface selector. Scroll to Delete with the interface knob, and select it by pressing ENTER on the interface selector.
312
To delete all messages: NOTE: The Delete All Messages command does not apply to Diagnostic Info and Recall messages. They can only be deleted by your dealer. Press the SETUP button to view the setup screen. Select MORE by pushing the interface selector to the right.
Use the interface knob to scroll to the AcuraLink/Messages button, and select it by pressing ENTER on the interface selector. Scroll to the Delete Messages option, and select it by pressing ENTER on the interface selector. Scroll to the category with the messages you want to delete, and select the category by pressing ENTER on the interface selector.
07/07/09 10:04:42 31STX610 0318
AcuraLink Quick Tips
Feature Guide
These messages, based on updated vehicle information and comments from other MDX owners, supplement your Owner’s Manual and Quick Start Guide. They provide you with relevant information for a safe and enjoyable ownership experience. For additional information, call Acura Client Services directly through the HFL.
During the first 90 days of ownership, one of up to 32 different messages appears each day. These messages help you to use and understand the features of your vehicle.
Features
Message Categories There are six message categories in AcuraLink: Quick Tips, Feature Guides, Maintenance Minders, Recalls/Campaigns, Diagnostic Info, and Dealer Appointment Reminders. The system can store up to 256 messages. Message categories can be added, revised, or deleted through broadcast messages from Acura.
313
07/07/09 10:04:49 31STX610 0319
AcuraLink Maintenance Minder
These messages provide detailed information about the service needed for your vehicle. When a maintenance message appears on the multi-information display, a list of needed maintenance items is provided through an AcuraLink message. These messages tell you the exact maintenance needed, helping you to avoid unnecessary maintenance costs.
314
You can then use the message options to call your dealer for an appointment or to find the nearest dealer.
Recall/Campaigns
If your vehicle is affected by a recall or other important safety information, a letter will be mailed to you about the issue and how to fix it. If you don’t get your vehicle fixed, you will also receive a reminder message through AcuraLink. You can then use the message options to call your dealer for an appointment or to find the nearest dealer.
07/07/09 10:04:56 31STX610 0320
AcuraLink Diagnostic Info When an indicator comes on or a message is displayed on the MultiInformation Display (MID), AcuraLink can provide information about the cause of the indicator or message and the recommended action to address it. This helps you handle the problem as it occurs, preventing or limiting costly repairs.
For more information on the instrument panel indicators, see page 64 .
Depending on the severity of the problem, the message will let you know if you should see your dealer immediately or if you can wait until a later date. Features
The AcuraLink system cannot determine some mechanical problems (such as squeaks or rattles) that are not triggered by the diagnostic indicator monitors.
information.)
When an indicator comes on or a message is displayed on the MID, AcuraLink immediately notifies you with the message, ‘‘An indicator is on. AcuraLink can help you decide what to do.’’ If you do not want the information right away, select the Check Later option. If you want the information now, select the Check Now option. (If the navigation screen is not active, you must select OK from the navigation disclaimer screen before you can check the
CONTINUED
315
07/07/09 10:05:04 31STX610 0321
AcuraLink When viewing a diagnostic info message through the INFO menu, you can use the Diagnostic Info button to connect to the Acura server and retrieve the latest information regarding the problem.
Dealer Appointment Reminder
NOTE: There may not be any additional information, depending on the time elapsed since the previous time you retrieved the information from the Acura server. You can then use the message options to call your dealer for an appointment or to find the nearest dealer.
When you make an appointment through the Owner’s Link Online Scheduling Service, you can be reminded in advance about that appointment through AcuraLink. If you need to reschedule, you can call your dealer directly with the HFL. The timing of your reminder is based on your reminder preference established on Owner Link.
316
07/07/09 10:05:11 31STX610 0322
AcuraLink AcuraLink/Message Screen
To access the following functions, press the SETUP button, push the interface selector to the right to select MORE, then rotate the interface knob to select AcuraLink/ Messages.
Auto Reading − Select ON to have the system automatically read each message to you. Select OFF to manually select the Voice button when you want a message read to you.
317
Features
Delete Messages − Select this button to delete all stored messages within a category, except for diagnostic info and recall campaign messages. These messages can only be deleted by a certified technician after the recall is done or the problem is corrected, or through a broadcast message from Acura.
New Message Notification − Select ON if you want to be notified of new messages (envelope icon appears on the navigation screen). Select OFF if you do not want to be notified of new messages (envelope icon does not appear on the screen). Messages can still be accessed using the INFO menu. If you would like to stop receiving messages, visit the OwnerLink website at www.owners. acura.com to change your messaging preferences.
07/07/09 10:05:17 31STX610 0323
AcuraLink Phone-Data Connection − Select this button to begin the process required to connect to Acura. This is used to access the most recent diagnostic information when a problem occurs.
To find more information on Bluetooth compatible and enabled cell phones, visit www.acura.com/handsfreelink or call the Hands Free Link consumer support at (888) 528-7876. In Canada, visit www.acura.ca, or call (888) 9ACURA-9.
NOTE: For the Phone Data Connection button to be active, you need a Bluetooth compatible and enabled cellphone paired to the Bluetooth HandsFreeLink (HFL). To complete the data connection setup, the paired phone must have a compatible data service.
318
07/07/09 10:05:21 31STX610 0324
AcuraLink
Features
Connect to the Acura Server − The default setting is prompt. When a diagnostic info message appears, and you select the Check Now button, the system will prompt you before connecting to the Acura server. If you do not wish to connect at that time, select No at the prompt, and you will see the information from the onboard database. The ‘‘Auto’’ setting will remove the prompt when you select the Check Now button and will automatically connect to the Acura server. This setting only applies when you have a Bluetooth enabled phone that is paired with the HFL and you have completed the Phone-Data Connection setup.
319
07/07/09 10:05:26 31STX610 0325
Rearview Camera and Monitor On vehicles with navigation system
Whenever you shift to reverse (R) with the ignition switch in the ON (II) position, the rear view is shown on the navigation system screen. For the best picture, always keep the rearview camera clean, and do not cover the camera lens. To avoid scratching the lens when you clean it, use a moist, soft cloth.
320
Since the rearview camera display area is limited, you should always back up slowly and carefully, and look behind you for obstacles.
07/07/09 10:05:30 31STX610 0326
Before Driving Break-in Period .............................. 322 Fuel Recommendation .................. 322 Service Station Procedures .......... 323 Refueling..................................... 323 Tighten Fuel Cap Message ...... 324 Opening and Closing the Hood ........................................ 325 Oil Check .................................... 326 Engine Coolant Check .............. 326 Fuel Economy ................................ 327 Accessories and Modifications .... 330 Carrying Cargo .............................. 332
321
Before Driving
Before you begin driving your vehicle, you should know what gasoline to use and how to check the levels of important fluids. You also need to know how to properly store luggage or packages. The information in this section will help you. If you plan to add any accessories to your vehicle, please read the information in this section first.
07/07/09 10:05:41 31STX610 0327
Break-in Period, Fuel Recommendation Break-in Period Help assure your vehicle’s future reliability and performance by paying extra attention to how you drive during the first 600 miles (1,000 km). During this period: Avoid full-throttle starts and rapid acceleration. Avoid hard braking for the first 200 miles (300 km). Do not change the oil until the multi-information display indicates it is needed. Do not tow a trailer. You should also follow these recommendations with an overhauled or exchanged engine, or when the brakes are replaced.
322
Fuel Recommendation Your vehicle is designed to operate on premium unleaded gasoline with a pump octane of 91 or higher. If this octane grade is unavailable, regular unleaded gasoline with a pump octane of 87 or higher may be used temporarily. The use of regular unleaded gasoline can cause metallic knocking noises in the engine and will result in decreased engine performance. The long-term use of regular-grade gasoline can lead to engine damage. We recommend quality gasolines containing detergent additives that help prevent fuel system and engine deposits. In addition, in order to maintain good performance, fuel economy, and emissions control, we strongly recommend, in areas where it is available, the use of gasoline that does NOT contain manganese-based fuel additives such as MMT.
Use of gasoline with these additives may adversely affect performance, and cause the malfunction indicator lamp on your instrument panel to come on. If this happens, contact your dealer for service. Some gasoline today is blended with oxygenates such as ethanol or MTBE. Your vehicle is designed to operate on oxygenated gasoline containing up to 10% ethanol by volume and up to 15% MTBE by volume. Do not use gasoline containing methanol. If you notice any undesirable operating symptoms, try another service station or switch to another brand of gasoline. For further important fuel-related information, please refer to your Quick Start Guide.
07/07/09 10:05:50 31STX610 0328
Service Station Procedures Refueling FUEL FILL CAP TETHER
Push
1. Park with the driver’s side closest to the service station pump. 2. Open the fuel fill door by pressing the button in the driver’s door. (To open the fuel fill door manually, see page 446 .)
3. Remove the fuel fill cap slowly. You may hear a hissing sound as pressure inside the tank escapes. Place the cap in the holder on the fuel fill door. 4. Stop filling the tank after the fuel nozzle automatically clicks off. Do not try to ‘‘top off’’ the tank. Leave some room for the fuel to expand with temperature changes.
Before Driving
HOLDER
If the fuel nozzle keeps clicking off even though the tank is not full, there may be a problem with your vehicle’s fuel vapor recovery system. The system helps keep fuel vapor from going into the atmosphere. Try filling at another pump. If this does not fix the problem, consult your dealer.
Gasoline is highly flammable and explosive. You can be burned or seriously injured when handling fuel. Stop the engine, and keep heat, sparks, and flame away. Handle fuel only outdoors. Wipe up spills immediately.
CONTINUED
323
07/07/09 10:05:57 31STX610 0329
Service Station Procedures 5. Screw the fuel fill cap back on until it clicks at least once. If you do not properly tighten the cap, you will see a ‘‘TIGHTEN FUEL CAP’’ message on the multiinformation display (see right column on this page), and the malfunction indicator lamp may also come on (see page 437 ).
Tighten Fuel Cap Message
6. Push the fuel fill door closed until it latches. Your vehicle’s on board diagnostic system will detect a loose or missing fuel fill cap as an evaporative system leak. The first time a leak is detected a ‘‘TIGHTEN FUEL CAP’’ message appears on the multi-information display. Turn the engine off, and confirm the fuel fill cap is installed. If it is, loosen it, then retighten it until it clicks at least once. The message should go off after several days of normal driving once you tighten or
324
replace the fuel fill cap. To scroll to another message, press the INFO button. The ‘‘TIGHTEN FUEL CAP’’ message will appear each time you restart the engine until the system turns the message off. If the system still detects a leak in the vehicle’s evaporative emissions system, the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) comes on. If the fuel fill cap was not already tightened, turn the engine off, and check or retighten the fuel fill cap until it clicks at least once. The MIL should go off after several days of normal driving once the cap is tightened or replaced. If the MIL does not go off, have your vehicle inspected by a dealer. For more information, see page 437 .
07/07/09 10:06:05 31STX610 0330
Service Station Procedures Opening and Closing the Hood
3. Lift the hood up most of the way. The hydraulic supports will lift it up the rest of the way and hold it up.
HOOD RELEASE HANDLE
LATCH
1. Park the vehicle, and set the parking brake. Pull the hood release handle located under the lower left corner of the dashboard. The hood will pop up slightly.
2. Put your fingers under the front edge of the hood near the center. Slide your hand to your left until you feel the hood latch handle. Push this handle up until it releases the hood. Lift up the hood. If the hood latch handle moves stiffly, or if you can open the hood without lifting the handle, the mechanism should be cleaned and lubricated.
325
Before Driving
To close the hood, lower the hood to about a foot (30 cm) above the fender, then press down firmly with your hands. Make sure it is securely latched.
07/07/09 10:06:15 31STX610 0331
Service Station Procedures Oil Check
Engine Coolant Check DIPSTICK
RESERVE TANK
UPPER MARK LOWER MARK
Wait a few minutes after turning the engine off before you check the oil. 1. Remove the dipstick (orange loop).
4. Remove the dipstick again, and check the level. It should be between the upper and lower marks.
2. Wipe off the dipstick with a clean cloth or paper towel.
If it is near or below the lower mark, see Adding Engine Oil on page 393 .
3. Insert the dipstick all the way back into its hole.
326
MIN
MAX
Look at the coolant level in the radiator reserve tank. Make sure it is between the MAX and MIN lines. If it is below the MIN line, see Adding Engine Coolant on page 396 for information on adding the proper coolant. Refer to Owner sMaintenance Checks on page 389 for information about checking other items on your vehicle.
07/07/09 10:06:25 31STX610 0332
Fuel Economy Actual Mileage and EPA Fuel Economy Estimates Comparison. Fuel economy is not a fixed number. It varies based on driving conditions, driving habits and vehicle condition. Therefore, it is not possible for one set of estimates to predict fuel economy precisely for all drivers in all environments.
City MPG − Represents urban driving in a vehicle in light traffic. A range of miles per gallon achieved is also provided. Highway MPG − Represents a mixture of rural and interstate driving, in a warmed-up vehicle, typical of longer trips in free-flowing traffic. A range of miles per gallon
Highway MPG
Combined Fuel Economy
Estimated Annual Fuel Cost (Sample U.S. EPA label shown)
achieved is also provided. Combined Fuel Economy − Represents a combination of city and highway driving. The scale represents the range of combined fuel economy for other vehicles in the class.
Estimated Annual Fuel Cost − Provides an estimated annual fuel cost, based on 15,000 miles (20,000 km) per year multiplied by the cost per gallon (based on EPA fuel cost data) divided by the combined fuel economy. For more information on fuel economy ratings and factors that affect fuel economy, visit www. fueleconomy.gov (Canada: Visit www. vehicles.gc.ca)
327
Before Driving
The EPA fuel economy estimates shown in the example to the right are a useful tool for comparison when buying a vehicle. EPA estimates include:
City MPG
07/07/09 10:06:38 31STX610 0333
Fuel Economy Fuel Economy Factors The following factors can lower your vehicle’s fuel economy: Aggressive driving (hard acceleration and braking) Excessive idling, accelerating and braking in stop-and-go traffic Cold engine operation (engines are more efficient when warmed up) Driving with a heavy load or the air conditioner running Improperly inflated tires Improving Fuel Economy Vehicle Maintenance
A properly maintained vehicle maximizes fuel economy. Poor maintenance can significantly reduce fuel economy. Always maintain your vehicle according to the maintenance messages displayed on the information display (see Owner s Maintenance Checks on page 389 ). For example:
328
Use the recommended viscosity motor oil, displaying the API Certification Seal (see page 393). Maintain proper tire inflation − An under-inflated tire increases ‘‘rolling resistance,’’ which reduces fuel economy. Avoid carrying excess weight in your vehicle − It puts a heavier load on the engine, increasing fuel consumption. Keep your vehicle clean − In particular, a build-up of snow or mud on your vehicle’s underside adds weight and rolling resistance. Frequent cleaning helps your fuel economy. Drive Efficiently
Drive moderately − Rapid acceleration, abrupt cornering, and hard braking increase fuel consumption.
Observe the speed limit − Aerodynamic drag has a big effect on fuel mileage at speeds above 45 mph (75 km/h). Reduce your speed and you reduce the drag. Trailers, car top carriers, roof racks and bike racks are also big contributors to increased drag. Always drive in the highest gear possible − If your vehicle has a manual transmission, you can boost your fuel economy by up shifting as early as possible. Avoid excessive idling − Idling results in 0 miles per gallon.
07/07/09 10:06:46 31STX610 0334
Fuel Economy
Calculating Fuel Economy
Checking Your Fuel Economy
Miles driven
Gallons of fuel
Miles per Gallon
100
Liter
Kilometers
Before Driving
Minimize the use of the air conditioning system − The A/C puts an extra load on the engine which makes it use more fuel. Use the fresh-air ventilation when possible. Plan and combine trips − Combine several short trips into one. A warmed-up engine is more fuel efficient than a cold one.
L per 100 km
Measuring Techniques
Direct calculation is the recommended source of information about your actual fuel economy. Using frequency of fill-ups or taking fuel gauge readings are NOT accurate measures of fuel economy. Fuel economy may improve over the first several thousand miles.
1) Fill the fuel tank until the nozzle automatically clicks off. 2) Reset trip counter to zero. 3) Record the total gallons (liters) needed to refill. 4) Follow one of the simple calculations above.
329
07/07/09 10:06:55 31STX610 0335
Accessories and Modifications Modifying your vehicle, or installing some non-Acura accessories, can make your vehicle unsafe. Before you make any modifications or add any accessories, be sure to read the following information. Accessories Your dealer has Acura accessories that allow you to personalize your vehicle. These accessories have been designed and approved for your vehicle, and are covered by warranty. Although non-Acura accessories may fit on your vehicle, they may not meet factory specifications, and could adversely affect your vehicle’s handling and stability.
330
Before installing any accessory: Improper accessories or modifications can affect your vehicle’s handling, stability, and performance, and cause a crash in which you can be hurt or killed. Follow all instructions in this owner’s manual regarding accessories and modifications. When properly installed, cellular phones, alarms, two-way radios, and low-powered audio systems should not interfere with your vehicle’s computer controlled systems, such as your airbags, anti-lock brakes, and tire pressure monitoring system.
Make sure the accessory does not obscure any lights, or interfere with proper vehicle operation or performance. Be sure electronic accessories do not overload electrical circuits (see page 440 ) or interfere with proper operation of your vehicle. Do not install accessories on the side pillars or across the rear windows. Accessories installed in these areas may interfere with proper operation of the side curtain airbags. Before installing any electronic accessory, have the installer contact your dealer for assistance. If possible, have your dealer inspect the final installation.
07/07/09 10:07:03 31STX610 0336
Accessories and Modifications Modifying Your Vehicle Removing parts from your vehicle, or replacing components with aftermarket components could seriously affect your vehicle’s handling, stability, and reliability.
Modifying your steering wheel or any other part of your vehicle’s safety features can make the systems ineffective. Before Driving
Some examples are: Lowering your vehicle with a non-Acura suspension kit that significantly reduces ground clearance can allow the undercarriage to hit speed bumps or other raised objects, which could cause the airbags to deploy.
Larger or smaller wheels and tires can interfere with the operation of your vehicle’s anti-lock brakes and other systems.
If you plan to modify your vehicle, consult your dealer.
Raising your vehicle with a nonAcura suspension kit can affect the handling and stability. Non-Acura wheels, because they are a universal design, can cause excessive stress on suspension components and will not be compatible with the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS).
331
07/07/09 10:07:12 31STX610 0337
Carrying Cargo Your vehicle has several convenient storage areas:
CONSOLE COMPARTMENT GLOVE BOX
DOOR POCKETS REAR COMPARTMENT
Glove box Door and seat-back pockets Rear cargo area, including the second and third row seats when folded flat Console compartment Storage compartment Rear compartment Roof-rack (if equipped) However, carrying too much cargo, or improperly storing it, can affect your vehicle’s handling, stability, stopping distance, and tires, and make it unsafe. Before carrying any type of cargo, be sure to read the following pages.
STORAGE COMPARTMENT
SEAT-BACK POCKETS CARGO AREA
332
07/07/09 10:07:23 31STX610 0338
Carrying Cargo Load Limits The maximum load for your vehicle is 1,158 lbs (525 kg). See Tire And Loading Information label attached to the driver’s doorjamb. Label Example
Follow all load limits and other loading guidelines in this manual. Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit − (1)Locate the statement ‘‘The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs.’’ on your vehicle’s placard. (2)Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be riding in your vehicle. (3)Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kg or XXX lbs.
(5)Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in Step 4. (6)If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine how this reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.
333
Before Driving
This figure includes the total weight of all occupants, cargo, and accessories, and the tongue load if you are towing a trailer.
Overloading or improper loading can affect handling and stability and cause a crash in which you can be hurt or killed.
(4)The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if the ‘‘XXX’’ amount equals 1,400 lbs. and there will be five 150 lb. passengers in your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs. (1,400 − 750 (5 × 150) = 650 lbs.)
07/07/09 10:07:29 31STX610 0339
Carrying Cargo
Example 1 Max Load (1,158 lbs)
Passenger Weight (150 lbs x 2 = 300 lbs)
Cargo Weight (858 lbs)
Max Load (1,158 lbs)
Passenger Weight (150 lbs x 4 = 600 lbs)
Cargo Weight (558 lbs)
Max Load (1,158 lbs)
Passenger Weight (150 lbs x 5 = 750 lbs)
Cargo Weight (408 lbs)
Example 2
Example 3
334
In addition, the total weight of the vehicle, all occupants, accessories, cargo, and trailer tongue load must not exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) or the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR). Both are on a label on the driver’s doorjamb.
07/07/09 10:07:38 31STX610 0340
Carrying Cargo Carrying Cargo in the Passenger Compartment Store or secure all items that could be thrown around and hurt someone during a crash.
Also, keep all cargo below the bottom of the windows. If it is higher, it could interfere with the proper operation of the side curtain airbags.
If you fold down the second or third row seats, tie down items that could be thrown about the vehicle during a crash or sudden stop.
If you carry large items that prevent you from closing the tailgate, exhaust gas can enter the passenger area. To avoid the possibility of carbon monoxide poisoning, follow the instructions on page 58 . If you carry any items on a roof rack, be sure the total weight of the rack and the items does not exceed 165 lbs (75 kg). If you use an accessory roof rack, the roof rack weight limit may be lower. Refer to the information that came with your roof rack.
Keep the glove box closed while driving. If it is open, a passenger could injure their knees during a crash or sudden stop.
335
Before Driving
Be sure items placed on the floor behind the front seats cannot roll underneath and interfere with the proper operation of the seats, the sensors under the seats, or the driver’s ability to operate the pedals.
Carrying Cargo in the Cargo Area or on a Roof Rack Distribute cargo evenly on the floor of the cargo area, placing the heaviest items on the bottom and as far forward as possible. Tie down items that could be thrown about the vehicle during a crash or sudden stop.
07/07/09 10:07:46 31STX610 0341
Carrying Cargo Optional Separation Net The separation net can be used to hold back soft, lightweight items stored in the cargo area. Heavy items should be tied down, as the net may not prevent them from being thrown about the vehicle in a crash or a sudden stop. Optional Cargo Cover The cargo cover can be used to cover the cargo area behind the third row seats. When the third row seats are folded down, the cargo cover can be extended over the larger area. Do not install the cover over the larger area if the third row seats are not folded down.
336
Cargo Hooks GROCERY HOOKS
CARGO HOOKS
The four hooks on the side panels can be used to install a net for securing items. Each hook is designed to hold up to 50 lbs (23 kg) of weight.
Your vehicle also has a grocery hook on each side panel in the cargo area. They are designed to hold light items. Heavy objects may damage the hook. Make sure any items put on each hook weigh less than 6.5 lbs (3 kg).
07/07/09 10:07:49 31STX610 0342
Driving Driving Guidelines ......................... 338 Preparing to Drive ......................... 338 Starting the Engine........................ 339 Check Starting System Message .................................. 340 Automatic Transmission............... 341 Super Handling-All Wheel Drive (SH-AWD®) System .................... 348 Parking ............................................ 350 Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) ....................................... 351 Braking System.............................. 356 Anti-lock Brakes (ABS) ................ 357 Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System......................................... 359 Active Damper System ................. 361 Towing a Trailer ............................ 363 Trailer Stability Assist ................... 375 Off-Highway Driving Guidelines ................................... 377
337
Driving
This section gives you tips on starting the engine under various conditions, and how to operate the automatic transmission. It also includes important information on parking your vehicle, the braking system, the super handling-all wheel drive (SH-AWD®) system, the vehicle stability assist (VSA) system, active damper system, the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS), and facts you need if you are planning to tow a trailer or drive off-high way.
07/07/09 10:08:01 31STX610 0343
Driving Guidelines, Preparing to Drive Driving Guidelines Your vehicle has higher ground clearance that allows you to travel over bumps, obstacles, and rough terrain. It also provides good visibility so you can anticipate problems earlier. Because your vehicle rides higher off the ground, it has a high center of gravity that can cause it to roll over if you make abrupt turns. Utility vehicles have a significantly higher roll over rate than other types of vehicles. To prevent rollovers or loss of control: Take corners at slower speeds than you would with a passenger vehicle. Avoid sharp turns and abrupt maneuvers whenever possible.
338
Do not modify your vehicle in any way that would raise the center of gravity. Do not carry heavy cargo on the roof. See page 377 for off-highway driving guidelines.
Preparing to Drive You should do the following checks and adjustments before you drive your vehicle. 1. Make sure all windows, mirrors, and outside lights are clean and unobstructed. Remove frost, snow, or ice. 2. Check that the hood is fully closed. 3. Visually check the tires. If a tire looks low, use a gauge to check its pressure. 4. Check that any items you may be carrying are stored properly or fastened down securely. 5. Check the seat adjustment (see page 140 ).
07/07/09 10:08:13 31STX610 0344
Preparing to Drive, Starting the Engine 6. Check the adjustment of the inside and outside mirrors (see page 154 ). 7. Check the steering wheel adjustment (see page 124 ). 8. Make sure the doors and tailgate are securely closed and locked.
10. When you start the engine, check the gauges and indicators in the instrument panel, and the messages on the multi-information display (see pages 63 , 72 and 81 ).
1. Apply the parking brake. 2. In cold weather, turn off all electrical accessories to reduce the drain on the battery. 3. Make sure the shift lever is in Park. Press on the brake pedal. 4. Without touching the accelerator pedal, turn the ignition switch to the START (III) position, then release the ignition switch. You do not need to hold the ignition switch in the START (III) position to start the engine. Depending on the outside temperature, the
starter motor runs for about 6 to 9 seconds until the engine starts. If you hold the ignition switch in the START (III) position for more than 7 seconds, the starter motor, depending on the outside temperature, runs for about 10 to 25 seconds until the engine starts. If the engine does not start, wait at least 10 seconds before trying again.
The immobilizer system protects your vehicle f rom thef t. If an improperlycoded key (or other device) is used, the engine’s f uel system is disabled. For more inf ormation, see page 128 .
CONTINUED
339
Driving
9. Fasten your seat belt. Check that your passengers have fastened their seat belts (see page 15 ).
Starting the Engine Your vehicle’s starting system has an auto control mode. When you turn the ignition switch to the START (III) position, this feature keeps the engine’s starter motor running until the engine starts. Follow these instructions to start the engine:
07/07/09 10:08:21 31STX610 0345
Starting the Engine 5. If the engine does not start within 15 seconds, or starts but stalls right away, repeat step 4 with the accelerator pedal pressed halfway down. If the engine starts, release pressure on the accelerator pedal so the engine does not race. 6. If the engine fails to start, press the accelerator pedal all the way down, and hold it there while starting to clear flooding. If the engine still does not start, return to step 5.
The engine is harder to start in cold weather. Also, the thinner air f ound at altitudes above 8,000 f eet (2,400 meters) adds to this problem.
340
Check Starting System Message
If this message is on, the ignition switch has to be held in the START (III) position manually until the engine starts. The ignition switch can be held in that position up to 15 seconds. Even though you may be able to start the engine manually without the auto control mode of the starting system, have your dealer inspect your vehicle.
If there is a problem with the starting system, you will see a ‘‘CHECK STARTING SYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display when the ignition switch is turned to the ON (II) position. You will also see this message when the auto control mode of the starting system has a problem.
07/07/09 10:08:29 31STX610 0346
Automatic Transmission Shift Lever Position Indicators
If the malfunction indicator lamp comes on along with the ‘‘D’’ indicator, there is a problem with the automatic transmission control system. Avoid rapid acceleration, and have the transmission checked by your dealer as soon as possible. When the ‘‘D’’ indicator warns of a possible problem with the transmission, you will see a ‘‘CHECK TRANSMISSION’’ message on the multi-information display (see page 82 ).
Shifting
To shift from Park to any position, press firmly on the brake pedal, and press the release button on the front of the shift lever, then move the lever. You cannot shift out of Park when the ignition switch is in the LOCK (0) or ACCESSORY (I) position.
CONTINUED
341
Driving
These indicators on the instrument panel show which position the shift lever is in. In the Sequential SportShift Mode, the ‘‘M’’ indicator next to the ‘‘D’’ indicator comes on, and the illuminated number under the charging system indicator shows you the gear you have selected.
The ‘‘D’’ indicator comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. If it flashes while driving (in any shift position), it indicates a possible problem in the transmission.
07/07/09 10:08:37 31STX610 0347
Automatic Transmission
To shift from: P to R R to P N to R D to D3 D3 to D D to N N to D R to N
Do this: Press the brake pedal, and press the shift lever release button. Press the shift lever release button.
Move the shift lever.
Park (P) − This position mechanically locks the transmission. Use Park whenever you are turning off or starting the engine. To shift out of Park, you must press on the brake pedal and press the release button on the shift lever. Make sure your foot is off the accelerator pedal. If you have done all of the above and still cannot move the lever out of Park, see Shift Lock Release on page 346 .
342
To avoid transmission damage, come to a complete stop before shifting into Park. The shift lever must be in Park before you can remove the key from the ignition switch. Reverse (R) − Press the brake pedal and press the release button on the front of the shift lever to shift from Park to reverse. To shift from reverse to neutral, come to a complete stop, and then shift. Press the release button before shifting into reverse from neutral. Neutral (N) − Use neutral if you need to restart a stalled engine, or if it is necessary to stop briefly with the engine idling. Shift to the Park position if you need to leave your vehicle for any reason. Press on the brake pedal when you are moving the shift lever from neutral to another gear.
Drive (D) − Use this position for your normal driving. The transmission automatically selects a suitable gear (1 through 5) for your speed and acceleration. You may notice the transmission shifting up at higher engine speeds when the engine is cold. This helps the engine warm up faster.
07/07/09 10:08:46 31STX610 0348
Automatic Transmission
(+) UP SHIFT
SELECTED GEAR
With the shift lever in ‘‘D’’ position, you can select the Sequential SportShift mode to shift gears much like a manual transmission, but without a clutch pedal. When you move the shift lever from ‘‘D’’ to ‘‘M’’ position, the display shows the selected gear.
(−) DOWN SHIFT
To enter the Sequential SportShift mode, move the shift lever further to the driver’s side. To return to ‘‘D,’’ move the shift lever to the passenger’s side. In Sequential SportShift mode, each time you push forward on the shift lever, the transmission shifts to a higher gear. Pull back on the lever to downshift. The number of the gear selected is displayed on the instrument panel.
CONTINUED
343
Driving
When you accelerate away from a stop, the transmission starts in first gear. You have to manually upshift between first and fifth gears. Make sure you upshift before the engine speed reaches the tachometer’s red zone. The transmission remains in the selected gear (5, 4, 3, 2, or 1). There is no automatic downshift when you push the accelerator pedal to the floor.
Sequential SportShift Mode
07/07/09 10:08:55 31STX610 0349
Automatic Transmission The transmission may automatically downshift from the higher gear to the lower gear under these conditions: Driving on level roads and downhill To shift from
Speed range
4→3
under 19 mph (31 km/h)
5→4
under 38 mph (60 km/h)
Driving uphill To shift from
344
Speed range
4→3
under 34 mph (55 km/h)
5→4
under 47 mph (75 km/h)
Downshifting gives you more power when climbing, and provides engine braking when going down a steep hill. The transmission also shifts automatically as the vehicle comes to a complete stop. It downshifts to first gear when the vehicle speed is under 10 mph (16 km/h).
If you try to manually downshift at a speed that would cause the engine to exceed the redline in a lower gear, the transmission does not downshift. The gear indicator will flash the number of the lower gear several times, then return to the higher gear. If the vehicle speed slows to below the redline of the selected lower gear position while the indicator is flashing, the transmission downshifts, and the display shows the selected lower gear.
07/07/09 10:09:03 31STX610 0350
Automatic Transmission The table shows the speed ranges for upshifting and downshifting. To shift from
Speed range
To shift from
Speed range
3→2
under 60 mph (96 km/h)
over 0 mph (0 km/h)
4→3
under 93 mph (150 km/h)
2→3
over 10 mph (16 km/h)
5→4
under 118 mph (190 km/h)
3→4
over 19 mph (31 km/h)
4→5
over 37 mph (60 km/h)
If you start out in second gear, the transmission will be fixed in that gear. The transmission will not automatically downshift to first gear even when the vehicle speed is under 10 mph (16 km/h). You need to shift down to first gear manually.
CONTINUED
345
Driving
1→2
Starting in Second Gear
When you are in Sequential SportShift mode, and the vehicle is stopped, push forward on the shift lever to shift to second gear. You will see ‘‘2’’ in the display. Starting out in second gear will help to reduce wheelspin in deep snow or on a slippery surface.
07/07/09 10:09:10 31STX610 0351
Automatic Transmission Drive (D3) − This position is similar to D, except only the first three gears are selected. Use D3 when towing a trailer in hilly terrain, or to provide engine braking when going down a steep hill. D3 can also keep the transmission from cycling between third, fourth, and fifth gears in stop-and-go driving. For faster acceleration when in D3 or D, you can get the transmission to automatically downshift by pushing the accelerator pedal to the floor. The transmission will shift down one, two, or three gears, depending on your speed.
346
Engine Speed Limiter If you exceed the maximum speed for the gear you are in, the engine speed will enter into the tachometer’s red zone. If this occurs, you may feel the engine cut in and out. This is caused by a limiter in the engine’s computer controls. The engine will run normally when you reduce the rpm below the red zone. Before downshifting, make sure the engine will not go into the tachometer’s red zone.
Shift Lock Release This allows you to move the shift lever out of Park if the normal method of pushing on the brake pedal and pressing the release button does not work. 1. Set the parking brake. 2. Remove the key from the ignition switch.
07/07/09 10:09:18 31STX610 0352
Automatic Transmission
RELEASE BUTTON
6. Remove the key from the shift lock release slot, then reinstall the cover. Make sure the notch on the cover is on the driver’s side. Press the brake pedal, and restart the engine. If you need to use the shift lock release, it means your vehicle is developing a problem. Have the vehicle checked by a dealer.
3. Put a cloth on the edge of the shift lock release slot cover. Use a small flat-tipped screwdriver or metal fingernail file to carefully pry up the edge of the cover and remove it from the slot.
Driving
COVER
SHIFT LOCK RELEASE SLOT
4. Insert a key into the shift lock release slot. 5. Push down on the key while you press the release button on the front of the shift lever and move the shift lever out of Park to neutral.
347
07/07/09 10:09:25 31STX610 0353
Super Handling-All Wheel Drive (SH-AWD ®) System The super handling-all wheel drive (SH-AWD®) system is a full time allwheel-drive system that automatically controls and transfers varying amounts of engine torque to all wheels independently, according to the driving conditions. While the SH-AWD® system helps to enhance the vehicle’s driving stability in all situations, it is still your responsibility to drive and corner at reasonable speeds and to leave a sufficient margin of safety.
SH-AWD® Torque Distribution Monitor TORQUE INDICATOR
TORQUE INDICATOR
The SH-AWD® torque distribution monitor on the multi-information display shows you the amount of torque being sent to the wheels. Each wheel: right front (RF), left front (LF), right rear (RR), and left rear (LR), has its own torque indicator.
348
Each torque indicator is displayed as a bar graph divided into 5 segments. The number of segments represents the amount of torque distributed to each wheel. When there is only a slight change in torque distribution while driving, such as cruising on level roads at the same speed, the torque distribution monitor may stop displaying the amount of torque. This is not a system problem. The monitor will show the amount if the system senses any change in torque distribution.
07/07/09 10:09:31 31STX610 0354
Super Handling-All Wheel Drive (SH-AWD®) System Your vehicle still has normal frontwheel drive with vehicle stability assist (VSA), but does not have the advantages of SH-AWD®. Have your vehicle checked by a dealer as soon as possible.
Driving
If the SH-AWD® indicator blinks while driving, it indicates the differential temperature is too high. You will also see an ‘‘SH-AWD® DIFF TEMP. HIGH’’ message on the multiinformation display. If this happens, pull to the side of the road when it is safe, shift to Park, and let the engine idle until the indicator goes out. If the indicator does not go out, take your vehicle to a dealer to have it
checked. If the SH-AWD® indicator on the instrument panel stays on, and the ‘‘CHECK SH-AWD® SYSTEM’’ message also appears on the multiinformation display, there is problem with the SH-AWD® system.
349
07/07/09 10:09:39 31STX610 0355
Parking Always use the parking brake when you park your vehicle. Make sure the parking brake is set firmly, or your vehicle may roll if it is parked on an incline. Set the parking brake before you put the transmission in Park. This keeps the vehicle from moving and putting pressure on the parking mechanism in the transmission.
Parking Tips Make sure the moonroof and the windows are closed. Turn off the lights.
Never park over dry leaves, tall grass, or other flammable materials. The hot three way catalytic converter could cause these materials to catch on fire.
Place any packages, valuables, etc. in the cargo area or take them with you.
If the vehicle is facing uphill, turn the front wheels away from the curb.
Lock the doors and the tailgate.
If the vehicle is facing downhill, turn the front wheels toward the curb. Check the indicator on the instrument panel to verify that the security system is set. Make sure the parking brake is fully released before driving away. Driving with the parking brake partially set can overheat or damage the rear brakes.
350
07/07/09 10:09:48 31STX610 0356
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Your vehicle is equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that turns on every time you start the engine and monitors the pressure in your tires while driving.
If you think you can safely drive a short distance to a service station, proceed slowly to the station, then inflate the tire to the recommended pressure.
It is possible that the pressures shown on the multi-information display and the pressures you manually measure are slightly different. If the difference is significant or you cannot make the low tire pressure/ TPMS indicator and message on the multi-information display go out after inflating the tires to the specified values, have your dealer check the system as soon as possible.
Driving on a significantly underinflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s handling and stopping ability.
If the tire is flat, or if the tire pressure is too low to continue driving, replace the tire with the compact spare tire (see page 425 ).
Because tire pressure varies by temperature and other conditions, the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator may come on unexpectedly. CONTINUED
351
Driving
Each tire has its own pressure sensor. If the air pressure of a tire becomes significantly low, the sensor in that tire immediately sends a signal that causes the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator in the instrument panel to come on. If this happens, you will see which tire is losing pressure on the multiinformation display along with a ‘‘CHECK TIRE PRESSURE’’ message.
Low Tire Pressure/ TPMS Indicator When the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator is on, one or more of your tires is significantly underinflated. You should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure as indicated on the vehicle’s tire information placard.
07/07/09 10:09:56 31STX610 0357
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) For example, if you check and fill your tires in a warm area, then drive in extremely cold weather, the tire pressure will be lower than measured and could be underinflated and cause the low tire pressure/ TPMS indicator to come on. Or, if you check and adjust your tire pressure in cooler conditions, and drive into extremely hot conditions, the tire may become overinflated. However, the low tire pressure/ TPMS indicator will not come on if the tires are overinflated. Refer to page 415 for tire inflation guidelines. If there is a problem with the TPMS, this indicator begins to flash. It stops flashing after approximately 1 minute, then stays on. You will also see a ‘‘CHECK TPMS SYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page 82 ).
352
Although your tire pressure is monitored, you must manually check the tire pressures monthly.
Tire Pressure Monitor
Each tire, including the spare, should be checked monthly when the vehicle is cold, and set to the recommended inflation pressure as specified on the vehicle placard and in the owner’s manual (see page 416 ).
To select the tire pressure monitor, press the INFO button several times with the ignition switch in the ON (II) position. You will see the above display on the multi-information display when all tire pressures are normal.
07/07/09 10:10:03 31STX610 0358
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
To see the inflation pressures of all four tires, press the SEL/RESET button. The display changes as shown above.
Canadian model
Each tire pressure is shown in PSI (U.S. models) or in kPa (Canadian models).
This shows that front left tire is losing pressure.
Each tire has its own pressure sensor. If the air pressure of a tire becomes significantly low, the sensor in that tire immediately sends a signal that causes the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator in the instrument panel to come on. If this happens, you will see which tire is losing pressure on the multiinformation display along with a ‘‘CHECK TIRE PRESSURE’’ CONTINUED message.
353
Driving
U.S. model
07/07/09 10:10:11 31STX610 0359
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) TPMS System Failure
If any of the tires has low pressure, the tire pressure monitor also shows above message to warn you about the low tire pressure when you select the display by pressing the INFO button several times. Following this display, press the SEL/RESET button to see each tire pressure. When you continue driving after installing the spare tire, you will also see this message on the multiinformation display.
354
If there is a problem with the TPMS, the tire pressure monitor shows a ‘‘SYSTEM FUNCTION ERROR’’ message and the tire pressure readings are not displayed. If this happens, you will first see a system warning message ‘‘CHECK TPMS SYSTEM’’ on the multi-information display.
If there is a problem with the TPMS, you will see the above message on the multi-information display. If you see this message, the system is off and is not monitoring the tire pressures. Have the system checked by your dealer as soon as possible. Also, the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator begins to flash, then stays on (see page 352 ).
07/07/09 10:10:19 31STX610 0360
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) If the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator comes on, or the multiinformation display shows a ‘‘CHECK TPMS SYSTEM’’ message, the VSA system automatically turns on even when the VSA system is turned off by pressing the VSA OFF switch (see page 360 ). If this happens, you cannot turn the VSA system off by pressing the VSA OFF switch again.
Changing a Tire with TPMS If you have a flat tire, the low tire pressure/TPMS and tire monitor indicators will come on. Replace the indicated flat tire with the compact spare tire (see page 425 ).
This indicator and the warning message on the multi-information display will go off, after several miles (kilometers) driving, when the spare tire is replaced with the specified regular tire equipped with the tire pressure monitor sensor. Each wheel is equipped with a tire pressure sensor mounted inside the tire behind the valve stem. You must use TPMS specific wheels. It is recommended that you always have
your tires serviced by your dealer or a qualified technician. Never use a puncture-repairing agent in a flat tire. If used, you will have to replace the tire pressure sensor. Have the flat tire repaired by your dealer as soon as possible.
Driving
When you restart the vehicle with the compact spare tire, the TPMS system message will also be displayed on the multi-information display after several miles (kilometers) driving.
After the flat tire is replaced with the spare tire, the low tire pressure/ TPMS indicator stays on while driving. After several miles (kilometers) driving, this indicator begins to flash, then stays on again. You will also see a ‘‘CHECK TPMS SYSTEM’’ message on the multiinformation display. This is normal; the system cannot monitor the spare tire pressure. Manually check the spare tire pressure to be sure it is correct.
CONTINUED
355
07/07/09 10:10:26 31STX610 0361
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS), Braking System As required by the FCC: This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. This device complies with Industry Canada Standard RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.
356
Braking System Your vehicle is equipped with disc brakes at all four wheels. A power assist helps reduce the effort needed on the brake pedal. The emergency brake assist system increases the stopping force when you depress the brake pedal hard in an emergency situation. The anti-lock brake system (ABS) helps you retain steering control when braking very hard. Resting your foot on the pedal keeps the brakes applied lightly, builds up heat, and reduces their effectiveness and reduces brake pad life. In addition, fuel economy can be reduced. It also keeps your brake lights on all the time, confusing drivers behind you.
Constant application of the brakes when going down a long hill builds up heat and reduces their effectiveness. Use the engine to assist the brakes by taking your foot off the accelerator and downshifting to a lower gear. Check the brakes after driving through deep water. Apply the brakes moderately to see if they feel normal. If not, apply them gently and frequently until they do. Be extra cautious in your driving.
07/07/09 10:10:34 31STX610 0362
Braking System, Anti-lock Brakes (ABS) Braking System Design The hydraulic system that operates the brakes has two separate circuits. Each circuit works diagonally across the vehicle (the left-front brake is connected with the right-rear brake, etc.). If one circuit should develop a problem, you will still have braking at two wheels.
If the brake pads need replacing, you will hear a distinctive, metallic screeching sound when you apply the brake pedal. If you do not have the brake pads replaced, they will screech all the time. It is normal for the brakes to occasionally squeal or squeak when you apply them.
The electronic brake distribution (EBD) system, which is part of the ABS, also balances the front-to-rear braking distribution according to vehicle loading.
You will feel a pulsation in the brake pedal when the ABS activates, and may hear some noise. This is normal: it is the ABS rapidly pumping the brakes. On dry pavement, you will need to press on the brake pedal very hard before the ABS activates. However, you may feel the ABS activate immediately if you are trying to stop on snow or ice. Driving
Brake Wear Indicators All four brakes have audible brake wear indicators.
Anti-lock Brakes (ABS) The anti-lock brake system (ABS) helps prevent the wheels from locking up, and helps you retain steering control by pumping the brakes rapidly, much faster than a person can do it.
You should never pump the brake pedal.
Let the ABS work for you by always keeping firm, steady pressure on the brake pedal. This is sometimes referred to as ‘‘stomp and steer.’’
357
07/07/09 10:10:43 31STX610 0363
Anti-lock Brakes (ABS) ABS Indicator If this indicator comes on, the antilock function of the braking system has shut down. The brakes still work like a conventional system, but without anti-lock. You should have your dealer inspect your vehicle as soon as possible. You will also see a ‘‘CHECK ABS SYSTEM’’ message on the multiinformation display (see page 81 ). If the indicator comes on while driving, test the brakes as instructed on page 438 .
If the ABS indicator and the brake system indicator come on together, and the parking brake is fully released, the EBD system may also be shut down.
Important Safety Reminders ABS does not reduce the time or distance it takes to stop the vehicle. It only helps with steering control during braking.
Test your brakes as instructed on page 438 . If the brakes feel normal, drive slowly and have your vehicle repaired by your dealer as soon as possible. Avoid sudden hard braking which could cause the rear wheels to lock up and possibly lead to a loss of control.
ABS will not prevent a skid that results from changing direction abruptly, such as trying to take a corner too fast or making a sudden lane change. Always drive at a safe speed for the road and weather conditions.
The VSA indicator will come on along with the ABS indicator.
ABS cannot prevent a loss of stability. Always steer moderately when you are braking hard. Severe or sharp steering wheel movement can still cause your vehicle to veer into oncoming traffic or off the road. A vehicle with ABS may require a longer distance to stop on loose or uneven surfaces, such as gravel or snow, than a vehicle without antilock.
358
07/07/09 10:10:53 31STX610 0364
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System The vehicle stability assist (VSA) system helps to stabilize the vehicle during cornering if the vehicle turns more or less than desired. It also assists you in maintaining traction while accelerating on loose or slippery road surfaces. It does this by regulating the engine’s output and by selectively applying the brakes.
The VSA system cannot enhance the vehicle’s driving stability in all situations and does not control your vehicle’s entire braking system. It is still your responsibility to drive and corner at reasonable speeds and to leave a sufficient margin of safety.
When VSA activates, you will see the VSA activation indicator blink. Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System Indicator If this indicator comes on while driving, pull to the side of the road when it is safe, and turn off the engine. Reset the system by restarting the engine. If the VSA system indicator stays on or comes back on while driving, have the VSA system inspected by your dealer. If the indicator does not come on when the ignition switch is turned to the ON (II) position, there may be a problem with the VSA system. Have your dealer inspect your vehicle as soon as possible.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK VSA SYSTEM’’ message on the multiinformation display if there is a problem with the VSA system. If the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator comes on, or the multiinformation display shows a ‘‘CHECK TPMS SYSTEM’’ message, the VSA system automatically turns on even when the VSA system is turned off by pressing the VSA OFF switch (see page 360 ). If this happens, you cannot turn the VSA system off by pressing the VSA OFF switch again. Without VSA, your vehicle will have normal braking and cornering ability, but it will not have VSA traction and stability enhancement.
359
Driving
When VSA activates, you may notice that the engine does not respond to the accelerator in the same way it does at other times. There may also be some noise from the VSA hydraulic system. You will also see the VSA activation indicator blink.
VSA Activation Indicator
07/07/09 10:11:02 31STX610 0365
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System VSA Off Switch
This switch is under the driver’s side vent. To turn the VSA system on and off, press and hold it until you hear a beep. When VSA is off, the VSA activation indicator comes on as a reminder. With the VSA off, the trailer stability assist function is also turned off (see page 375 ).
360
VSA is turned on every time you start the engine, even if you turned it off the last time you drove the vehicle. In certain unusual conditions when your vehicle gets stuck in shallow mud or fresh snow, it may be easier to free it with the VSA temporarily switched off. When the VSA system is off, the traction control system is also off. You should only attempt to free your vehicle with the VSA off if you are not able to free it when the VSA is on. Immediately after freeing your vehicle, be sure to switch the VSA on again. We do not recommend driving your vehicle with the VSA and traction control systems switched off.
VSA and Tire Sizes Driving with varying tire or wheel sizes may cause the VSA to malfunction. When replacing tires, make sure they are of the same size and type as your original tires (see page 419 ). If you install winter tires, make sure they are the same size as those that were originally supplied with your vehicle. Exercise the same caution during winter driving as you would if your vehicle was not equipped with VSA.
07/07/09 10:11:10 31STX610 0366
Active Damper System U.S. Sport Packages and Canadian Elite models
The active damper system is always on, constantly adjusting your vehicle’s dampers to the best settings for current road conditions along with vehicle speed and handling inputs.
Sport mode: The system prioritizes handling response, vehicle body control and tire-to-road adhesion to allow for higher performance handling. Comfort mode: The system prioritizes road isolation to allow for a more comfortable ride. Either mode can be used in any type of operating conditions.
To switch between comfort and sport mode, press and release the active damper system button located on the center console to choose the desired mode.
CONTINUED
361
Driving
The system uses electrically controlled dampers to enhance handling precision, vehicle composure, tire to road adhesion and rough road ride comfort isolation. The system reacts to inputs from various electronic sensors to give exactly the right amount of suspension damping to provide optimal ride comfort and handling.
The system provides two selectable modes.
07/07/09 10:11:17 31STX610 0367
Active Damper System Active Damper System Indicator If there is a problem with the active damper system, the active damper system shuts down and the active damper system indicator on the instrument panel comes on.
When comfort mode is selected, the green indicator in the button comes ON, and the message ‘‘COMFORT’’ will appear on the multi-information display for five seconds.
When sport mode is selected, the green indicator in the button goes off, and the message ‘‘SPORT’’ will appear on the multi-information display for five seconds. You will also see the ‘‘CHECK ADS SYSTEM’’ message appears on the multi-information display.
362
07/07/09 10:11:25 31STX610 0368
Active Damper System, Towing a Trailer If you see this warning indicator and message, have your vehicle checked at your dealer as soon as possible. In this case, your vehicle still has the normal damper function, but it will not have the active damper function.
Towing a Trailer Your vehicle has been designed primarily to carry passengers and their cargo. You can also use it to tow a trailer if you carefully observe the load limits, use the proper equipment, and follow the guidelines in this section. Break-In Period
Check the loading of your vehicle and trailer carefully before starting to drive. Driving
Avoid towing a trailer during your vehicle’s first 600 miles (1,000 km) (see page 322 ).
Exceeding any load limit or improperly loading your vehicle and trailer can cause a crash in which you can be seriously hurt or killed.
Be sure to read the Off-Highway Driving Guidelines section on page 377 if you plan to tow off paved surfaces. Your vehicle is equipped with a trailer stability assist to help stabilize the vehicle/trailer combination by reducing the vehicle speed. For more information, see page 375 .
363
07/07/09 10:11:35 31STX610 0369
Towing a Trailer Load Limit
and cause it to sway. Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) − The maximum allowable weight of the vehicle, all occupants, all accessories, all cargo and the tongue load is 5,952 lbs (2,700 kg).
Total Trailer Weight
The maximum allowable weight of the trailer and everything in or on it depends on the number of occupants in your vehicle and the type of trailer being towed (see page 366 ). Towing a trailer that is too heavy can seriously affect your vehicle’s handling and performance. It can also damage the engine and drivetrain.
364
Tongue Load
The weight that the tongue of a fully loaded trailer puts on the hitch should be 5 to 10 percent of the total trailer weight for boat trailers, and 8 to 15 percent of total trailer weight for all other trailers. (See page 366 for limits for your towing situation). Too much tongue load reduces front-tire traction and steering control. Too little tongue load can make the trailer unstable
Gross Axle Weight Ratings (GAWR) − The maximum allowable weight of the vehicle, all occupants, all accessories, all cargo, and the tongue load must not exceed 2,888 lbs (1,310 kg) on the front axle, and 3,175 lbs (1,440 kg) on the rear axle. Gross Combined Weight Rating (GCWR) − The maximum allowable weight of the fully loaded vehicle and trailer is 10,053 lbs (4,560 kg) with the proper hitch. The GCWR must be reduced 2 percent for every 1,000 feet (305 meters) of elevation.
07/07/09 10:11:47 31STX610 0370
Towing a Trailer Estimating Loads The best way to confirm that all loads are within limits is to check them at a public scale. For public scales in your area, check your local phone book, or contact your trailer dealer or rental agency for assistance.
To Estimate the Total Trailer Weight
Add the weight of your trailer (as quoted by the manufacturer) with everything in or on the trailer. Then check the tables on page 366 to make sure you do not exceed the limit for your conditions.
2. Measure and record the distance from the ground to the bottom of the trailer hitch. 3. Connect the fully loaded trailer to the hitch. 4. Measure again from the ground to the same spot on the bottom of the hitch. 5. Subtract the second measurement from the first measurement, then refer to the following table.
MDX and Technology Packages models
If the difference is:
Estimated tongue load is:
13/32’’ 11/16’’ 31/32’’ 1 1/4’’
150 lbs (68 kg) 250 lbs (114 kg) 350 lbs (159 kg) 450 lbs (205 kg)
U.S. Sport Packages and Canadian Elite models
If the difference is:
Estimated tongue load is:
1/2’’ 27/32’’ 1 5/32’’ 1 1/2’’
150 lbs (68 kg) 250 lbs (114 kg) 350 lbs (159 kg) 450 lbs (205 kg)
If the difference is more than 1 ½ inch, you have too much load on the tongue. Redistribute the load or remove cargo as needed.
365
Driving
To help ensure a safe drive to a scale, or if you cannot get to a public scale, we recommend that you estimate your total trailer weight and tongue load as described next.
To Estimate the Tongue Load
1. Park the vehicle on level ground.
07/07/09 10:11:53 31STX610 0371
Towing a Trailer Total Trailer Weight and Tongue Load Limits: Number of Occupants* 2 3 4 5 6 7 *
**
366
Maximum Total Trailer Weight
Maximum Tongue Load
5,000 lbs (2,268 kg) 4,750 lbs (2,155 kg) 4,500 lbs (2,041 kg) 4,250 lbs (1,928 kg) 4,000 lbs (1,814 kg)
500 lbs (227 kg) 470 lbs (213 kg) 370 lbs (168 kg) 275 lbs (125 kg) 150 lbs (68 kg) Towing is Not Recommended
The corresponding weight limits assume occupants fill seats from the front of the vehicle to the back, each occupant weighs 150 lbs (70 kg), and each has 15 lbs (7 kg) of cargo in the cargo area. Any additional weight, including cargo or accessories, reduces the maximum trailer weight and maximum tongue load. Never exceed the gross axle weight ratings (see page 364 ). Recommended tongue load should be 5−15% of the total trailer weight for boat trailers, and 8−15% of the total trailer weight for all other trailers.
07/07/09 10:12:03 31STX610 0372
Towing a Trailer Checking Loads To accurately check your loads at the public scale, the vehicle and trailer should be fully loaded, and all occupants should stay in the vehicle while the attendant watches the scale. 2. Check the gross vehicle weight. Limit: 5,952 lbs (2,700 kg)
1. Check the front gross axle weight. Limit: 2,888 lbs (1,310 kg)
4. If you cannot weigh the rear axle directly, you can calculate the rear gross axle weight by subtracting the weight in step 1 from the weight in step 2. Limit: 3,064 lbs (1,390 kg)
CONTINUED
367
Driving
3. Check the rear gross axle weight. Limit: 3,175 lbs (1,440 kg)
5. Check the gross combined weight. Limit: 10,053 lbs (4,560 kg) Remember, maximum gross combined weight should be decreased 2 % for every 1,000 feet (305 meters) of elevation.
07/07/09 10:12:11 31STX610 0373
Towing a Trailer Towing Equipment and Accessories Towing generally requires a variety of supplemental equipment. To ensure the best quality, we recommend that you purchase Acura equipment whenever possible. 6. Check the weight of the hitched trailer. Write this number down.
7. Check the weight of the unhitched trailer. Limit: See page 366 . 8. Calculate the tongue load. Subtract the weight in step 6 from the weight in step 7. Limit: See page 366 . Recommended: see page 364 . Range: 5-10% for boat trailers 8-15% for other trailers
368
Your dealer offers a trailer package that includes a hitch, a ball mount, and a wiring harness. Discuss any additional needs with your trailer sales or rental agency, and make sure all equipment is properly installed, maintained, and also meets state, federal, province, and local regulations.
07/07/09 10:12:21 31STX610 0374
Towing a Trailer Hitch
We strongly recommend that you have your dealer install a class 3 hitch. Using non-Acura equipment may result in serious damage to your vehicle. Read the trailer manufacturer’s instructions, and select the appropriate draw bar for the height of the trailer you will be towing. Weight Distributing Hitch
There are two common types of trailer brakes: surge and electric. Surge brakes are common for boat trailers, since the brakes will get wet. If you choose electric brakes, be sure they are electronically actuated. Do not attempt to tap into your vehicle’s hydraulic system. No matter how successful it may seem, any attempt to attach trailer brakes to your vehicle’s hydraulic system will lower braking effectiveness and create a potential hazard. See your trailer manufacturer for more information on installing electric brakes.
A 4-pin gray connector is available as an option at your dealer. This connector has all of the circuits required to install most electric trailer brake controllers. A jumper harness to adapt your electric trailer brake controller to the vehicle is included with the optional Acura Genuine trailer hitch kit. To obtain a connector and a trailer hitch kit, see your dealer. Have a qualified mechanic install your trailer brake controller following the trailer brake controller manufacturer’s instructions. Failure to properly install the trailer brake controller may increase the distance it takes for you to stop your vehicle when towing a trailer.
CONTINUED
369
Driving
A weight distributing hitch is not recommended for use with your vehicle, as an improperly adjusted weight distributing hitch may reduce handling, stability, and braking performance.
Trailer Brakes
Acura requires that any trailer with a total trailer weight of 1,000 lbs (455 kg) or more have its own brakes.
07/07/09 10:12:31 31STX610 0375
Towing a Trailer Use this illustration to identify each terminal in the trailer brake controller connector. ELECTRIC BRAKE (YELLOW)
BRAKE (20A) (BLUE)
Safety Chains
Always use safety chains when you tow a trailer. Make sure the chains are secured to the trailer and hitch, and that they cross under the tongue and can catch the trailer if it becomes unhitched. Leave enough slack to allow the trailer to turn corners easily, but do not let the chains drag on the ground. Sway Control
GROUND (BLACK)
STOP (LIGHT GREEN)
This device is recommended if your trailer tends to sway. Your trailer maker can tell you what kind of sway control you need and how to install it. Trailer Mirrors
Many states and provinces require special exterior mirrors when towing a trailer. Even if they don’t, you should install special mirrors if you cannot clearly see behind you, or if the trailer creates a blind spot.
370
Spare Tires
When towing a trailer, we recommend that you carry a full-size spare wheel and tire for your vehicle and trailer. See page 419 for proper tire size, page 429 for how to store a full size wheel and tire, and page 425 for information on changing a flat tire. Remember to unhitch the trailer before changing a flat. Ask your trailer sales or rental agency where and how to store the trailer’s spare tire.
07/07/09 10:12:39 31STX610 0376
Towing a Trailer Trailer Lights ACCESSORY OPTION
TRAILER BACK-UP LIGHT BACK-UP LIGHT (−)
ILLUMINATION LIGHTS
BRAKE DIAGNOSTIC
RIGHT TURN SIGNAL
TRAILER HAZARD LIGHT +B CHARGE
Trailer lights and equipment must comply with federal, state, province, and local regulations. Check trailer light requirements for the areas where you plan to tow, and use only equipment designed for your vehicle. Your vehicle is equipped with a connector to install an optional trailer lighting connector that mates with your vehicle. You can get this optional connector from your dealer.
Since lighting and wiring vary with trailer type and brand, you should also have a qualified mechanic install a suitable connector between the vehicle and the trailer. Driving
LEFT TURN SIGNAL
ELECTRIC BRAKE
If you use a non-Acura trailer lighting harness and converter, you can get the mating connector and pins that mate with the connector in your vehicle from your dealer.
TAILLIGHTS
Refer to the above illustration for wiring information. We recommend that you have your dealer install an Acura wiring harness and converter. This harness has been designed for your vehicle.
371
07/07/09 10:12:49 31STX610 0377
Towing a Trailer Pre-Tow Checklist When preparing to tow, and before driving away, be sure to check the following: The vehicle has been properly serviced, and the suspension and the cooling system are in good operating condition. The trailer has been properly serviced and is in good condition. All weights and loads are within limits. The hitch, safety chains, and any other attachments are secure. All items on and in the trailer are properly secured and cannot shift while you drive.
372
The lights and brakes on your vehicle and the trailer are working properly. Your vehicle tires and spare are in good condition and properly inflated. The trailer tires and spare are in good condition and inflated as recommended by the trailer maker.
Driving Safely With a Trailer The added weight, length, and height of a trailer will affect your vehicle’s handling and performance, so driving with a trailer requires some special driving skills and techniques. For your safety and the safety of others, take time to practice driving maneuvers before heading for the open road, and follow the guidelines in this section.
07/07/09 10:12:58 31STX610 0378
Towing a Trailer Towing Speeds and Gears
Drive slower than normal in all driving situations, and obey posted speed limits for vehicles with trailers. Use D position when towing a trailer on level roads. D3 is the proper shift lever position to use when towing a trailer in hilly terrain. (See ‘‘ Driving on Hills’’ on the next page for additional gear information.)
Gear position
Speed range
1
0 − 19 mph (0 − 30 km/h)
2
19 − 31 mph (30 − 50 km/h)
3
31 − 41 mph (50 − 65 km/h)
4
over 41 mph (over 65 km/h)
If the automatic transmission fluid temperature increases and exceeds the specified limit, the A/T temperature indicator comes on (see page 68 ). You will also see a ‘‘A/T TEMP HIGH’’ message on the multiinformation display. Making Turns and Braking
Make turns more slowly and wider than normal. The trailer tracks a smaller arc than your vehicle, and it can hit or run over something the vehicle misses. Allow more time and distance for braking. Do not brake or turn suddenly as this could cause the trailer to jackknife or turn over.
CONTINUED
373
Driving
When towing a fixed-sided trailer (e. g., camper), do not exceed 55 mph (88 km/h). At higher speeds, the trailer may sway or affect vehicle handling.
When driving uphill and downhill, use the Sequential SportShift mode to provide the proper engine power and engine braking on each gear. Select fourth, third, second, or first gear; depending on the vehicle speeds and road condition. Do not use fifth gear. The recommended speed range for each gear position is shown in the table.
07/07/09 10:13:08 31STX610 0379
Towing a Trailer Driving on Hills
When climbing hills, closely watch your temperature gauge. If it nears the red (Hot) mark, turn the air conditioning off, reduce speed and, if necessary, pull to the side of the road to let the engine cool. If the transmission shifts frequently while going up a hill, shift to D3. If you must stop when facing uphill, use the foot brake or parking brake. Do not try to hold the vehicle in place by pressing on the accelerator, as this can cause the automatic transmission to overheat. When driving down hills, reduce your speed and shift down to D3. Do not ‘‘ride’’ the brakes. Remember, it takes longer to slow down and stop when towing a trailer.
374
Handling Crosswinds and Buffeting
Crosswinds and air turbulence caused by passing trucks can disrupt your steering and cause the trailer to sway. When being passed by a large vehicle, keep a constant speed, and steer straight ahead. Do not try to make quick steering or braking corrections. Backing Up
Always drive slowly and have someone guide you when backing up. Grip the bottom of the steering wheel, then turn the wheel to the left to get the trailer to move to the left. Turn the wheel to the right to move the trailer to the right. Parking
Follow all normal precautions when parking, including putting the transmission in Park and firmly setting the parking brake. Also, place wheel chocks at each of the trailer’s tires.
Retrieving a Boat
If the vehicles tires slip when retrieving a boat from the water, keep D position and do not use the sequential sport shift mode. This prevents the transmission damage. Towing Your Vehicle Your vehicle is not designed to be towed behind a motor home. If your vehicle needs to be towed in an emergency, see page 446 .
07/07/09 10:13:17 31STX610 0380
Trailer Stability Assist Your vehicle is equipped with trailer stability assist function. This function works on the same sensors as the vehicle stability assist (VSA) system. This function helps to stabilize the vehicle/trailer combination when the trailer severely sways or oscillates. For more information of the VSA system, see page 359 .
The vehicle/trailer combination is more affected by crosswinds, buffeting, and improper tongue load. These conditions can make the trailer unstable, and cause it to sway.
When the brakes are applied, the trailer’s brake lights come on along with the vehicle brake lights. When the trailer stability assist activates, you will see the VSA activation indicator blink. There may also be some noise from the VSA hydraulic system.
Trailer stability assist cannot prevent a loss of control. Always reduce the vehicle speed and steer firmly. Do not brake suddenly or make quick steering motion. It could cause the trailer to jackknife or turn over and the system becomes ineffective. Trailer stability assist cannot prevent swaying that can occur in crosswinds and in normal and emergency driving maneuvers. It helps only to stabilize the vehicle/trailer combination in these conditions, after the oscillation becomes severe. Trailer stability assist will also be ineffective while driving at high speed or towing a trailer with a high center of gravity. Always obey the recommended speed limits for towing a trailer, see page 373 .
375
Driving
If the function detects the vehicle/ trailer instability, it checks if the swaying is caused by the trailer, and if the trailer swaying or oscillation is increasing.
Under these conditions, trailer stability assist begins to stabilize the vehicle/trailer combination by reducing the vehicle speed. The control unit sends signals to selectively apply the brakes and regulate the engine output. The brake lights of your vehicle will be turned on automatically by the system even if you do not keep the pressure on the brake pedal.
07/07/09 10:13:26 31STX610 0381
Trailer Stability Assist Trailer Stability Assist Failure
In this case, your vehicle still has the VSA traction and stability enhancement, but it will not have the trailer stability assist function. If there is a problem with the VSA system, the system and Trailer Stability Assist shuts off. The VSA system and VSA activation indicators also come on (see page 359 ).
The control unit monitors the VSA circuitry and the braking system. If there is a problem with the brake lighting system, the trailer stability assist function shuts down and the ‘‘CHECK TRAILER STABILITY ASSIST’’ message appears on the multi-information display. If you see this message, have your vehicle checked at your dealer as soon as possible.
376
The ABS indicator and the brake system indicator may also come on along with the VSA system indicator. If you see these warning indicators, have your vehicle checked at your dealer as soon as possible.
If you turn off the VSA, the trailer stability assist function also shuts off. Press and hold the VSA off switch until you hear a beep (see page 360 ). The VSA activation indicator comes on as a reminder. Press and hold the switch again to turn the system on. The function turns on every time you start the engine along with the VSA, even if you turned it off the last time you drove the vehicle.
07/07/09 10:13:35 31STX610 0382
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
If you decide to drive on unpaved roads, you will find that it requires somewhat different driving skills. Your vehicle will also handle somewhat differently than it does on pavement. Be sure to pay extra attention to the precautions and tips in this section, and get acquainted with your vehicle before leaving the pavement.
Improperly operating this vehicle on or off-pavement can cause an accident or rollover in which you and your passengers could be seriously injured or killed. Follow all instructions and guidelines in this owner’s manual. Keep your speed low, and don’t drive faster than conditions permit.
Important Safety Precautions To avoid loss of control or rollover, be sure to follow all precautions and recommendations. Be sure to store cargo properly and do not exceed your cargo load limits (see page 333 and 364 ). Whenever you drive, make sure you and your passengers always wear seat belts. Keep your speed low, and never go faster than the conditions allow. It’s up to you to continually assess the situation and drive within the limits.
377
Driving
General Information Your vehicle has been designed primarily for use on pavement. But its higher ground clearance and super handling-all wheel drive (SH-AWD®) system allow you to occasionally travel on unpaved roads, to campgrounds, picnic sites, and similar locations. It is not designed for trailblazing, mountain climbing, or other challenging off-road activities.
07/07/09 10:13:47 31STX610 0383
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines Check Out Your Vehicle Before you leave the pavement, be sure to do all scheduled maintenance and service, and inspect your vehicle for any problems. Pay special attention to the condition of the tires, and check the tire pressures. After you return to the pavement, carefully inspect your vehicle to make sure there is no damage that could make driving it unsafe. Recheck the condition of the tires and the tire pressures. Remember The route presents limits (too steep or bumpy roads). You have limits (driving skill and comfort). And your vehicle has limits (traction, stability, and power). Driving off-highway can be hazardous if you fail to recognize limits and take the proper precautions.
378
Accelerating and Braking For better traction on all surfaces, accelerate slowly and gradually build up speed. If you try to start too fast on wet soil, mud, snow, or ice, you might not have enough traction to get underway, and you may dig yourself a hole. Starting with the shift lever in D position will help you have a smoother start on snow or ice. Keep in mind that you will usually need more time and distance to brake to a stop on unpaved surfaces. Avoid hard braking. Do not ‘‘pump’’ the brakes; let the anti-lock braking system pump them for you. Avoiding Obstacles Debris in the road can damage your suspension or other components. Because your vehicle has a high center of gravity, driving over a large obstacle, or allowing a wheel to drop into a deep hole can cause your vehicle to tip or roll over.
Driving on Slopes If you can’t clearly see all conditions or obstacles on a slope, walk the slope before you drive on it. If you have any doubt whether or not you can safely drive on the slope, don’t do it. Find another route. If you are driving up a hill and find that you cannot continue, do not try to turn around. Your vehicle could roll over. Slowly back down the hill, following the same route you took up the hill. Crossing a Stream Before driving through water, stop, get out if necessary, and make sure that: The water is not deep enough to cover your wheel hubs, axles, or exhaust pipe. You could stall and not be able to restart your engine. The water can also damage important vehicle components.
07/07/09 10:13:59 31STX610 0384
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
If you decide it is safe to drive through water, choose a suitable speed, and proceed without shifting, changing speeds, stopping, or shutting off the engine. After driving through water, test your brakes. If they got wet, gently ‘‘pump’’ them while driving slowly until they operate normally.
If the water is deeper than the wheel hubs, some additional service may be required. This service is not covered by your warranties. If You Get Stuck If you get stuck, carefully try to go in the direction (forward or reverse) that you think will get you unstuck. Do not spin the tires at high speeds. It will not help you get out and may cause damage to the transmission or SH-AWD® system. If you are still unable to free yourself, your vehicle is equipped with front and rear tow hooks designed for this purpose. Use a nylon strap to attach the MDX to the recovery vehicle and carefully take out the slack in the strap. Once the strap is tight, the recovery vehicle should apply force. Remember that the recovery vehicle needs good traction to avoid
becoming stuck, too. You should never use a jack to try to get unstuck. Your vehicle could easily slip off the jack and hurt you or someone else. Towing a Trailer Off-Road You may be able to safely tow a lightweight trailer (such as a motorcycle or small tent trailer) offroad if you follow these guidelines. Do not exceed 1,000 lbs (450 kg) or a tongue weight of 100 lbs (45 kg). Stay on smooth, level dirt roads, and avoid driving in hilly terrain. Allow extra room for starting, stopping, and turning. Slow down if you encounter bumps or other obstacles.
379
Driving
The banks are sloped so you can drive out. The water is not flowing too fast. Deep rushing water can sweep you downstream. Even very shallow rushing water can wash the ground from under your tires and cause you to lose traction and possibly roll over. The banks and surface under the water provide good traction. The water may hide hazards such as rocks, holes, or mud.
07/07/09 10:14:02 31STX610 0385
380
07/07/09 10:14:06 31STX610 0386
Maintenance This section explains why it is important to keep your vehicle well maintained and how to follow basic maintenance safety precautions. This section also includes instructions on how to read the maintenance minder messages on the multi-information display, and instructions for simple maintenance tasks you may want to take care of yourself.
381
Maintenance
If you have the skills and tools to perform more complex maintenance tasks on your vehicle, you may want to purchase the service manual. See page 469 for information on how to obtain a copy, or see your dealer.
Maintenance Safety ....................... 382 Maintenance Minder ..................... 383 Fluid Locations............................... 391 Engine Compartment Cover ........ 392 Adding Engine Oil ......................... 393 Changing the Engine Oil and Filter ............................................ 394 Engine Coolant ............................... 396 Windshield Washers ..................... 398 Automatic Transmission Fluid..... 399 Brake Fluid ..................................... 401 Power Steering Fluid ..................... 402 Timing Belt ..................................... 402 Lights .............................................. 403 Dust and Pollen Filter ................... 409 Cleaning the Seat Belts ................. 409 Floor Mats ...................................... 410 Wiper Blades .................................. 411 Tires ................................................ 415 Checking the Battery .................... 421 Vehicle Storage .............................. 422
07/07/09 10:14:16 31STX610 0387
Maintenance Safety All service items not detailed in this section should be performed by a certified technician or other qualified mechanic. Important Safety Precautions To eliminate potential hazards, read the instructions before you begin, and make sure you have the tools and skills required. Make sure your vehicle is parked on level ground, the parking brake is set, and the engine is off. To clean parts, use a commercially available degreaser or parts cleaner, not gasoline. To reduce the possibility of fire or explosion, keep cigarettes, sparks, and flames away from the battery and all fuel-related parts.
Wear eye protection and protective clothing when working with the battery or compressed air.
Improperly maintaining this vehicle, or failing to correct a problem before driving can cause a crash in which you can be seriously hurt or killed. Always follow the inspection and maintenance recommendations and schedules in this owner’s manual. Potential Vehicle Hazards Carbon Monoxide poison from engine exhaust. Be sure there is adequate ventilation whenever you operate the engine. Burns from hot parts. Let the
382
engine and exhaust system cool down before touching any parts. Injury from moving parts. Do not run the engine unless instructed to do so.
Failure to properly follow maintenance instructions and precautions can cause you to be seriously hurt or killed. Always follow the procedures and precautions in this owner’s manual. Some of the most important safety precautions are given here. However, we cannot warn you of every conceivable hazard that can arise in performing maintenance. Only you can decide whether or not you should perform a given task.
07/07/09 10:14:24 31STX610 0388
Maintenance Minder One of the most convenient and important features of the multiinformation display on your vehicle is the maintenance minder.
Engine Oil Life
REMAINING ENGINE OIL LIFE
Based on engine operating conditions and accumulated engine revolutions, the onboard computer in your vehicle calculates the remaining engine oil life.
To see the remaining engine oil life displayed on the multi-information display as a percentage, turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. Make sure the display shows blank, SH-AWD® and tire pressure, and then press the SEL/ RESET button on the steering wheel repeatedly until the engine oil life appears (see page 73 ).
Calculated Engine Displayed Oil Life (%) Engine Oil Life (%) 100% − 91% 100% 90% − 81% 90% 80% − 71% 80% 70% − 61% 70% 60% − 51% 60% 50% − 41% 50% 40% − 31% 40% 30% − 21% 30% 20% − 16% 20% 15% − 11% 15% 10% − 6% 10% 5% − 1% 5% 0% 0%
CONTINUED
383
Maintenance
The system also displays the code for other scheduled maintenance items needing service.
The remaining engine oil life is displayed according to the table shown below.
07/07/09 10:14:30 31STX610 0389
Maintenance Minder
MAINTENANCE MAIN ITEM
MAINTENANCE SUB ITEMS
When the remaining engine oil life is 15 to 6 percent, the multi-information display shows a ‘‘SERVICE DUE SOON’’ message along with the maintenance schedule code indicating the main and sub items required at the time of the oil change. Refer to page 390 for a complete list of the maintenance main items and sub items.
384
When the remaining oil life is 1 to 5 percent, the multi-information display shows a ‘‘SERVICE DUE NOW’’ message with the same maintenance items ‘‘SERVICE DUE SOON’’ was displayed with. When you see this message have the indicated maintenance performed as soon as possible.
Press the SEL/RESET button on the steering wheel repeatedly to select the engine oil life. The message ‘‘SERVICE’’, along with ‘‘5%’’, and the maintenance item code are displayed on the lower part of the multiinformation display when the calculated engine oil life is 1−5 percent (see page 383 ).
07/07/09 10:14:37 31STX610 0390
Maintenance Minder These messages will come on every time you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. Immediately have the service performed, and make sure to reset the oil life minder as previously described. The message will be canceled if the ▼ or ▲ button on the steering wheel is pressed. Press the ▼ or ▲ button to see the message again. Press the SEL/RESET button on the steering wheel repeatedly to select the engine oil life. The message ‘‘SERVICE’’, along with ‘‘0 %’’, and the maintenance item code are displayed on the lower part of the multi-information display when the calculated engine oil life is 0−1 %.
CONTINUED
385
Maintenance
If the indicated maintenance service is not done and the remaining engine oil life reaches 0%, the multiinformation display will show the message ‘‘SERVICE PAST DUE’’ and the maintenance item code(s). This message is displayed when the total mileage is less than 10 miles (for U.S. models) or 10 km (for Canadian models) after the engine oil life became 0%.
07/07/09 10:14:45 31STX610 0391
Maintenance Minder
TOTAL PAST DUE MILEAGE U.S.
CANADA
MAINTENANCE CODE
If the indicated required service is not done and the remaining engine oil life becomes 0%, the multiinformation display will show a ‘‘SERVICE PAST DUE’’ message, the total mileage after the remaining oil life became 0%, and the maintenance item code(s).
386
This message is displayed when you drive over 10 miles (for U.S. models) or 10 km (for Canadian models) after seeing the 0% message. Immediately have the service performed, and make sure to reset the display as previously described. The message will be canceled if the ▼ or ▲ button on the steering wheel is pressed. Press the ▼ or ▲ button to see the message again.
U.S.
CANADA TOTAL PAST DUE MILEAGE
When you press the SEL/RESET button to select the engine oil life, the message ‘‘SERVICE’’, along with the maintenance item code and the total negative mileage after the oil life became 0 %, will be displayed on the lower part of the multiinformation display.
07/07/09 10:14:56 31STX610 0392
Maintenance Minder Maintenance Main Items and Sub Items
MAINTENANCE MAIN ITEM
MAINTENANCE SUB ITEMS
All the maintenance items displayed in the multi-information display are in code. For an explanation of the maintenance codes, see page 390 .
more than 10 seconds. The remaining engine oil life reset mode will be shown on the multiinformation display.
If maintenance service is done by someone other than your dealer, reset the maintenance minder as follows: 1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. 2. If the engine oil life is not displayed, press the SEL/RESET button on the steering wheel repeatedly the multi-information display shows blank, SH-AWD® and tire pressure. 3. Press and hold the SEL/RESET button on the steering wheel for
4. Select ‘‘RESET’’ by pressing the INFO (▲/▼) button, then press the SEL/RESET button to reset the engine oil life display. The maintenance item code(s) will disappear, and the engine oil life will reset to ‘‘100.’’ If you want to cancel the oil life reset mode, select ‘‘CANCEL.’’
387
Maintenance
MAINTENANCE MAIN ITEM
MAINTENANCE SUB ITEMS
Resetting the Engine Oil Life Display Your dealer will reset the display after completing the required maintenance service. You will see ‘‘OIL LIFE 100%’’ on the display the next time you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position.
07/07/09 10:15:00 31STX610 0393
Maintenance Minder Important Maintenance Precautions If you have the required service done but do not reset the display, or reset the display without doing the service, the system will not show the proper maintenance intervals. This can lead to serious mechanical problems because you will no longer have an accurate record of when maintenance is needed.
388
Your authorized dealer knows your vehicle best and can provide competent, efficient service. However, service at a dealer is not mandatory to keep your warranties in effect. Maintenance may be done by any qualified service facility or person who is skilled in this type of automotive service. Keep all receipts as proof of completion, and have the person who does the work fill out your Maintenance Journal or Canadian Maintenance Log. Check your warranty booklet for more information.
We recommend using Acura parts and fluids whenever you have maintenance done. These are manufactured to the same highquality standards as the original components, so you can be confident of their performance and durability.
07/07/09 10:15:09 31STX610 0394
Maintenance Minder U.S. Vehicles: Maintenance, replacement, or repair of emissions control devices and systems may be done by any automotive repair establishment or individual using parts that are certified to EPA standards.
Lights − Check the operation of the headlights, parking lights, taillights, high-mount brake light, and license plate lights monthly. See page 403 .
Engine oil level − Check every time you fill the fuel tank. See page 326 . Engine coolant level − Check the radiator reserve tank every time you fill the fuel tank. See page 326 .
Maintenance
According to state and federal regulations, failure to perform maintenance on the items marked with # will not void your emissions warranties. However, Acura recommends that all maintenance services be performed in accordance with the intervals indicated by the Multi-Information Display.
Owner s Maintenance Checks You should check the following items at the specified intervals. If you are unsure of how to perform any check, turn to the appropriate page listed.
Automatic transmission − Check the fluid level monthly. See page 399 . Brakes − Check the fluid level monthly. See page 401 . Tires − Check the tire pressure monthly. Examine the tread for wear and foreign objects. See page 416 .
389
07/07/09 10:15:17 31STX610 0395
Maintenance Minder
Maintenance Schedule for Normal Conditions
Symbol A B
Maintenance Main Items Replace engine oil1 Replace engine oil1and oil filter Inspect front and rear brakes Check parking brake adjustment Inspect these items: Tie rod ends, steering gear box, and boots Suspension components Driveshaft boots Brake hoses and lines (including ABS) All fluid levels and condition of fluids Exhaust system# Fuel lines and connections#
Symbol 1 2
3 4
1 : If the message ‘‘SERVICE DUE NOW’’ does not appear more than 12 months after the display is reset, change the engine oil every year.
#: See information on maintenance and emissions warranty in the first column on page 389 .
NOTE :
390
Independent of the maintenance messages in the multi-information display, replace the brake fluid every 3 years. Inspect idle speed every 160,000 miles (256,000 km). Adjust the valves during services A, B, 1, 2, or 3 if they are noisy.
5 6
Maintenance Sub Items Rotate tires Replace air cleaner element If you drive in dusty conditions, replace every 15,000 miles (24,000 km). Replace dust and pollen filter If you drive primarily in urban areas that have high concentrations of soot in the air from industry and from diesel-powered vehicles, replace every 15,000 miles (24,000 km). Inspect drive belt Replace transmission and transfer fluid Replace spark plugs Replace timing belt and inspect water pump If you drive regularly in very high temperatures (over 110°F, 43°C), in very low temperatures (under−20°F, −29°C), or towing a trailer, replace every 60,000 miles (U.S.)/100,000 km (Canada). Inspect valve clearance Replace engine coolant Replace rear differential fluid Driving in mountainous areas at very low vehicle speeds or trailer towing results in higher level of mechanical (shear) stress to fluid. This requires differential fluid changes more frequently than recommended by the Maintenance Minder. If you regularly drive your vehicle under these conditions, have the differential fluid changed at 7,500 miles (12,000 km), then every 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
07/07/09 10:15:22 31STX610 0396
Fluid Locations
BRAKE FLUID (Black cap)
POWER STEERING FLUID (Red cap)
ENGINE COOLANT RESERVOIR ENGINE OIL FILL CAP
Maintenance
WASHER FLUID (Blue cap)
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID DIPSTICK (Yellow loop)
ENGINE OIL DIPSTICK (Orange loop)
RADIATOR CAP
391
07/07/09 10:15:27 31STX610 0397
Engine Compartment Cover The component parts in the engine compartment are protected by the cover. You may need to remove the cover when you perform some simple maintenance work. Cover is secured by holding clips. To remove the front bulkhead cover, remove the holding clips with a flattip screwdriver.
392
FRONT BULKHEAD COVER HOLDING CLIP
07/07/09 10:15:35 31STX610 0398
Adding Engine Oil ENGINE OIL FILL CAP
The oil viscosity or weight is provided on the container’s label. 5W-20 oil is formulated for yearround protection of your vehicle to improve cold weather starting and fuel economy.
Maintenance
Unscrew and remove the engine oil fill cap on top of the valve cover. Pour in the oil slowly and carefully so you do not spill. Clean up any spills immediately. Spilled oil could damage components in the engine compartment. Reinstall the engine oil fill cap, and tighten it securely. Wait a few minutes, and recheck the oil level on the engine oil dipstick. Do not fill above the upper mark; you could damage the engine.
Recommended Engine Oil Oil is a major contributor to your engine’s performance and longevity. Always use a premium-grade 5W-20 detergent oil displaying the API Certification Seal. This seal indicates the oil is energy conserving, and that it meets the American Petroleum Institute’s latest requirements. It is highly recommended that you use Honda motor oil in your vehicle. Make sure the API Certification Seal says ‘‘For Gasoline Engines.’’
Ambient Temperature
API CERTIFICATION SEAL
393
07/07/09 10:15:43 31STX610 0399
Adding Engine Oil, Changing the Engine Oil and Filter Synthetic Oil You may use a synthetic motor oil if it meets the same requirements given for a conventional motor oil: it displays the API Certification Seal and it is the proper weight. You must follow the oil and filter change intervals shown on the multiinformation display.
Changing the Engine Oil and Filter Always change the oil and filter according to the maintenance messages shown on the multiinformation display. The oil and filter collect contaminants that can damage your engine if they are not removed regularly.
Engine Oil Additives Your vehicle does not require any oil additives. Additives may adversely affect the engine or transmission performance and durability.
Changing the oil and filter requires special tools and access from underneath the vehicle. The vehicle should be raised on a service stationtype hydraulic lift for this service. Unless you have the knowledge and proper equipment, you should have this maintenance done by a skilled mechanic. 1. Run the engine until it reaches normal operating temperature, then shut it off.
394
WASHER
DRAIN BOLT
2. Open the hood, and remove the engine oil fill cap. Remove the oil drain bolt and washer from the bottom of the engine. Drain the oil into an appropriate container.
07/07/09 10:15:53 31STX610 0400
Changing the Engine Oil and Filter OIL FILTER
4. Install a new oil filter according to the instructions that come with it. Make sure to clean off any dirt and dust on the connecting surface of a new oil filter. 5. Put a new washer on the drain bolt, then reinstall the drain bolt. Tighten the drain bolt to: 29 lbf·ft (39 N·m , 4.0 kgf·m)
Make sure the oil filter gasket is not stuck to the engine block. If it is, remove it before installing a new oil filter.
6. Refill the engine with the recommended oil. Engine oil change capacity (including filter): 4.5 US qt (4.3 )
8. Let the engine run for several minutes, then check the drain bolt and oil filter for leaks. 9. Turn off the engine and let it sit for several minutes, then check the oil level on the dipstick. If necessary, add more oil.
Improper disposal of engine oil can be harmf ul to the environment. If you change your own oil, please dispose of the used oil properly. Put it in a sealed container, and take it to a recycling center. Do not discard it in a trash bin or dump it on the ground.
395
Maintenance
3. Remove the oil filter, and let the remaining oil drain. A special wrench (available from your dealer) is required.
7. Reinstall the engine oil fill cap. Start the engine. The oil pressure indicator should go out within 5 seconds. If it does not, turn off the engine, and check your work.
07/07/09 10:16:00 31STX610 0401
Engine Coolant Adding Engine Coolant
Always use Honda Long-life Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2. This coolant is pre-mixed with 50 percent antifreeze and 50 percent water. Never add straight antifreeze or plain water.
MAX MIN
If the coolant level in the reserve tank is at or below the MIN line, add coolant to bring it up to the MAX line. Inspect the cooling system for leaks.
396
If Honda antifreeze/coolant is not available, you may use another major-brand non-silicate coolant as a temporary replacement. Make sure it is a high-quality coolant recommended for aluminum engines. Continued use of any non-Honda coolant can result in corrosion, causing the cooling system to malfunction or fail. Have the cooling system flushed and refilled with Honda antifreeze/coolant as soon as possible.
If the reserve tank is completely empty, you should also check the coolant level in the radiator.
Removing the radiator cap while the engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray out, seriously scalding you. Always let the engine and radiator cool down before removing the radiator cap.
07/07/09 10:16:08 31STX610 0402
Engine Coolant
RADIATOR CAP COVER
RADIATOR CAP
4. The coolant level should be up to the base of the filler neck. Add coolant if it is low. Pour the coolant slowly and carefully so you do not spill any. Clean up any spill immediately; it could damage components in the engine compartment. 5. Put the radiator cap back on, and tighten it fully.
2. Remove the radiator cap cover.
Maintenance
1. Make sure the engine and radiator are cool.
3. Remove the radiator cap by pushing down and turning counterclockwise.
Relieve any pressure in the cooling system by turning the radiator cap counterclockwise, without pressing down. CONTINUED
397
07/07/09 10:16:16 31STX610 0403
Engine Coolant, Windshield Washers
MAX
Windshield Washers Check the fluid level in the windshield washer reservoir at least monthly during normal use. If the washer fluid is low, a ‘‘WASHER FLUID LOW’’ message appears on the multi-information display.
RESERVE TANK
MIN
6. Pour coolant into the reserve tank. Fill it to halfway between the MAX and MIN marks. Put the cap back on the reserve tank. Do not add any rust inhibitors or other additives to your vehicle’s cooling system. They may not be compatible with the coolant or engine components.
398
Fill the reservoir with a good-quality windshield washer fluid. This increases the cleaning capability and prevents freezing in cold weather. When you refill the reservoir, clean the edges of the windshield wiper blades with windshield washer fluid on a clean cloth. This will help to condition the blade edges.
Do not use engine antif reeze or a vinegar/water solution in the windshield washer reservoir. Antif reeze can damage your vehicle’s paint, while a vinegar/water solution can damage the windshield washer pump. Use only commercially-available windshield washer f luid.
07/07/09 10:16:24 31STX610 0404
Automatic Transmission Fluid The transmission should be drained and refilled with new fluid when this service is shown on a maintenance message in the multi-information display.
DIPSTICK
Check the fluid level with the engine at normal operating temperature.
DIPSTICK
2. Remove the dipstick (yellow loop) from the transmission, and wipe it with a clean cloth.
3. Insert the dipstick all the way into the transmission securely as shown in the illustration. 4. Remove the dipstick and check the fluid level. It should be between the upper and lower marks.
CONTINUED
399
Maintenance
1. Park the vehicle on level ground. Start the engine, let it run until the radiator fan comes on, then shut off the engine. For accurate results, wait about 60 seconds (but no longer than 90 seconds) before doing step 2.
UPPER MARK LOWER MARK
07/07/09 10:16:32 31STX610 0405
Automatic Transmission Fluid 5. If the level is below the lower mark, add fluid into the dipstick hole to bring it to the level between the upper and lower marks. Pour the fluid slowly and carefully so you do not spill any. Clean up any spill immediately; it could damage components in the engine compartment. Always use Honda ATF-Z1 (automatic transmission fluid). 6. Insert the dipstick all the way back into the transmission securely as shown in the illustration. Make sure the rubber cap on the dipstick fits in the dipstick guide and that you push the dipstick in all the way.
400
The transmission should be drained and refilled with new fluid when this service is shown on a maintenance message in the multi-information display. If you are not sure how to add fluid, contact your dealer.
Use only Honda Genuine ATF-Z1 (Automatic Transmission Fluid). Do not mix with other transmission f luids. Using transmission f luid other than Honda Genuine ATF-Z1 may cause deterioration in transmission operation and durability, and could result in damage to the transmission. Damage resulting f rom the use of transmission f luid other than Honda Genuine ATF-Z1 is not covered by the Acura new vehicle warranty.
07/07/09 10:16:39 31STX610 0406
Brake Fluid Replace the brake fluid when this service is indicated on a maintenance message in the multi-information display. Check the fluid level in the brake fluid reservoir monthly.
Always use Honda Heavy Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3. If it is not available, you should use only DOT 3 or DOT 4 fluid, from a sealed container, as a temporary replacement. Using any non-Honda brake fluid can cause corrosion and decrease the life of the system. Have the brake system flushed and refilled with Honda Heavy Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3 as soon as possible.
MAX
The fluid level should be between the MIN and MAX marks on the side of the reservoir. If the level is at or below the MIN mark, your brake system needs attention. Have the brake system inspected for leaks or worn brake pads.
401
Maintenance
Brake fluid marked DOT 5 is not compatible with your vehicle’s braking system and can cause extensive damage.
MIN
07/07/09 10:16:49 31STX610 0407
Power Steering Fluid, Timing Belt Power Steering Fluid UPPER LEVEL
Always use Honda Power Steering Fluid. You may use another power steering fluid as an emergency replacement, but have the power steering system flushed and refilled with Honda PSF as soon as possible. A low power steering fluid level can indicate a leak in the system. Check the fluid level frequently, and have the system inspected as soon as possible.
LOWER LEVEL
Check the level on the side of the reservoir when the engine is cold. The fluid should be between the UPPER LEVEL and LOWER LEVEL. If not add power steering fluid to the UPPER LEVEL mark. Pour the fluid slowly and carefully so you do not spill any. Clean up any spills immediately; it could damage components in the engine compartment.
402
If you are not sure how to add fluid, contact your dealer.
Turning the steering wheel to f ull lef t or right lock and holding it there can damage the power steering pump.
Timing Belt The timing belt should be replaced at the intervals shown in the maintenance minder schedule. Replace the timing belt every 60,000 miles (U.S.) or every 100,000 km (Canada) if you regularly drive your vehicle in any of the following conditions: In very high temperatures (over 110°F, 43°C). In very low temperatures (under −20°F, −29°C). Frequently tow a trailer.
07/07/09 10:17:00 31STX610 0408
Lights Headlight Aiming
MDX and Technology Packages models
The headlights were properly aimed when your vehicle was new. If you regularly carry heavy items in the trunk or pull a trailer, readjustment may be required. Adjustments should be done by your dealer or other qualified technician.
Halogen headlight bulbs get very hot when lit. Oil, perspiration, or a scratch on the glass can cause the bulb to overheat and shatter. 1. Open the hood. 2. Remove the front bulkhead cover (see page 392 ).
BULB
CONNECTOR
3. Remove the electrical connector from the bulb by pushing on the tab and pulling the connector down. 4. Remove the bulb by turning it about one-quarter turn counterclockwise.
CONTINUED
403
Maintenance
Low Beam Headlight Bulb Replacement The low beam headlight bulbs are a type of high voltage discharge tube. High voltage can remain in the circuit even with the light switch off and the key removed. Because of this, you should not attempt to examine or change a low beam headlight bulb yourself. If a low beam headlight bulb fails, take the vehicle to your dealer to have it replaced.
Replacing a High Beam Headlight Bulb Your vehicle has halogen headlight bulbs. When replacing a bulb, handle it by its base, and protect the glass from contact with your skin or hard objects. If you touch the glass, clean it with denatured alcohol and a clean cloth.
07/07/09 10:17:11 31STX610 0409
Lights 5. Insert the new bulb into the hole, and turn it one-quarter turn clockwise to lock it in place. 6. Push the electrical connector onto the new bulb.
Replacing Front Turn Signal/ Parking and Side Marker Light Bulbs FRONT TURN SIGNAL LIGHT
BULB
PARKING LIGHT
BULB
7. Turn on the headlights to test the new bulb.
SOCKET
1. Open the hood. 2. Remove the front bulkhead cover (see page 392 ). 3. Remove the socket by turning it one-quarter turn counterclockwise. 4. Pull the bulb straight out of its socket.
404
SOCKET
5. Push the new bulb straight into the socket until it bottoms. 6. Insert the socket back into the headlight assembly. Turn it clockwise to lock it in place. 7. Turn on the lights to make sure the new bulb is working.
07/07/09 10:17:19 31STX610 0410
Lights
SIDE MARKER LIGHT
Halogen bulbs get very hot when lit. Oil, perspiration, or a scratch on the glass can cause the bulb to overheat and shatter.
BOLT
HOLDING CLIPS
1. Remove the bolt and use the flattip screwdriver to remove the holding clips located under the front bumper. 2. Push down the inner fender.
CONTINUED
405
Maintenance
SOCKET
BULB
Replacing Front Fog/Daytime Running Light Bulbs Your vehicle uses halogen light bulbs. When replacing a bulb, handle it by its plastic case, and protect the glass from contact with your skin or hard objects. If you touch the glass, clean it with denatured alcohol and a clean cloth.
07/07/09 10:17:27 31STX610 0411
Lights CONNECTOR
Replacing Rear Bulbs (in Rear Pillar) COVER
BOLT
INNER FENDER
3. Remove the electrical connector from the bulb by pushing on the tab and pulling the connector down. 4. Remove the bulb from the fog light assembly by turning it onequarter turn counterclockwise.
406
BOLT
1. Open the tailgate. Use a flat-tip screwdriver protected with a cloth to pry open the two covers.
2. Remove the two bolts, and remove the rear light assembly from the rear pillar. 3. Determine which of the two bulbs is burned out: turn signal/hazard lights or side marker light.
07/07/09 10:17:37 31STX610 0412
Lights 6. Push the new bulb straight into the socket until it bottoms.
Replacing a Back-up Light Bulb
7. Turn on the lights to make sure the new bulb is working. 8. Put the socket back into the light assembly, and turn it clockwise to lock it in place.
SOCKET
4. Remove the socket by turning it one-quarter turn counterclockwise. 5. Pull the bulb straight out of its socket.
COVER
1. Open the tailgate. Place a cloth on the edge of the light assembly cover. Remove the cover by carefully prying in the notch on its middle edge with a flat-tip screwdriver.
CONTINUED
407
Maintenance
BULB
9. Install the rear light assembly in the rear pillar. Tighten the two bolts. Snap the bolt covers into position.
07/07/09 10:17:46 31STX610 0413
Lights
BULB
6. Put the socket back into the light assembly, and turn it clockwise to lock it in place. 7. Place the cover back into the light assembly. Push it up until it locks in place.
SOCKET
2. Remove the socket by turning it one-quarter turn counterclockwise. 3. Pull the bulb straight out of its socket. 4. Push the new bulb straight into the socket until it bottoms. 5. Turn on the lights to make sure the new bulb is working.
408
Side Turn Signal Light Each outside mirror has side turn signal lights. The lights should be replaced by your dealer. Rear License Plate Bulb The license plate has two lights above it. The bulbs should be replaced by your dealer.
07/07/09 10:17:52 31STX610 0414
Dust and Pollen Filter, Cleaning the Seat Belts Dust and Pollen Filter This filter removes the dust and pollen that is brought in from the outside through the climate control system.
OPENING
Dirt build-up around the openings of the seat belt anchors can cause the belts to retract slowly. Wipe the openings with a clean cloth dampened in mild soap and warm water or isopropyl alcohol.
Maintenance
Have your dealer replace the filter when this service is indicated by a maintenance message on the multiinformation display. It should be replaced every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) if you drive primarily in urban areas that have high concentrations of soot in the air, or if the flow from the climate control system becomes less than usual.
Cleaning the Seat Belts
If your seat belts get dirty, use a soft brush with a mixture of mild soap and warm water to clean them. Do not use bleach, dye, or cleaning solvents. Let the belts air-dry before you use the vehicle.
409
07/07/09 10:17:57 31STX610 0415
Floor Mats Front
The floor mats that came with your vehicle hook over the floor mat anchors. This keeps the floor mats from sliding forward, possibly interfering with the pedals, or backwards, making the front passenger’s weight sensors ineffective. If you remove a floor mat, make sure to re-anchor it when you put it back in your vehicle.
410
Rear
If you use a non-Acura floor mat, make sure it fits properly and that it can be used with the floor mat anchors. Do not put additional floor mats on top of the anchored mats.
07/07/09 10:18:06 31STX610 0416
Wiper Blades Check the condition of the wiper blades at least every 6 months. Replace them if you find signs of cracking in the rubber, and areas that are getting hard or if they leave streaks and unwiped areas when used.
WIPER ARMS
LOCK TAB
1. Raise each wiper arm off the windshield, lifting the driver’s side first, then the passenger’s side.
Do not open the hood when the wiper arms are raised, or you will damage the hood and the wiper arms.
2. Disconnect the blade assembly from the wiper arm: Press and hold the lock tab. Slide the blade assembly toward the lock tab until it releases from the wiper arm. When replacing a wiper blade, make sure not to drop the wiper blade or wiper arm down on the windshield. CONTINUED
411
Maintenance
To replace the front wiper blades:
07/07/09 10:18:13 31STX610 0417
Wiper Blades BLADE
BLADE
5. Slide the new wiper blade into the holder until the tabs lock. 6. Slide the wiper blade assembly onto the wiper arm. Make sure it locks in place.
REINFORCEMENT
3. Remove the blade from its holder by grabbing the tabbed end of the blade. Pull firmly until the tabs come out of the holder.
412
4. Examine the new wiper blades. If they have no plastic or metal reinforcement along the back edge, remove the metal reinforcement strips from the old wiper blade, and install them in the slots along the edge of the new blade.
7. Lower the wiper arm against the window. Windshield: Lower the passenger’s side first, then the driver’s side.
07/07/09 10:18:20 31STX610 0418
Wiper Blades WIPER ARM
BLADE
REINFORCEMENT
1. Raise the wiper arm off the rear window.
2. Slide the blade out of the wiper arm.
3. Examine the new wiper blades. If they have no plastic or metal reinforcement along the back edge, remove the metal reinforcement strips from the old wiper blade, and install them in the slots along the edge of the new blade.
CONTINUED
413
Maintenance
To replace the rear wiper blade:
07/07/09 10:18:24 31STX610 0419
Wiper Blades
4. Slide the new blade into the wiper arm. Make sure it is engaged in the slot along its full length. 5. Lower the wiper arm.
414
07/07/09 10:18:33 31STX610 0420
Tires To safely operate your vehicle, your tires must be the proper type and size, in good condition with adequate tread, and correctly inflated. The following pages give more detailed information on how to take care of your tires and what to do when they need to be replaced.
Follow all instructions in this owner’s manual regarding tire inflation and maintenance.
Underinflated tires wear unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and are more likely to fail from being overheated.
immediately with a tire gauge. Use a gauge to measure the air pressure in each tire at least once a month. Even tires that are in good condition may lose 1 to 2 psi (10 to 20 kPa, 0.1 to 0.2 kgf/cm ) per month. Remember to check the spare tire at the same time.
Overinflated tires can make your vehicle ride more harshly, are more prone to damage from road hazards, and wear unevenly.
Maintenance
Using tires that are excessively worn or improperly inflated can cause a crash in which you can be seriously hurt or killed.
Inflation Guidelines Keeping the tires properly inflated provides the best combination of handling, tread life, and riding comfort.
The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) warns you when a tire pressure is low. See page 351 for more information. Even though your vehicle is equipped with TPMS, we recommend that you visually check your tires every day. If you think a tire might be low, check it
CONTINUED
415
07/07/09 10:18:42 31STX610 0421
Tires Check the air pressures when the tires are cold. This means the vehicle has been parked for at least 3 hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km). Add or release air, if needed, to match the recommended cold tire pressures. If you check air pressures when the tires are hot [driven for several miles (kilometers)], you will see readings 4 to 6 psi (30 to 40 kPa, 0.3 to 0.4 kgf/cm ) higher than the cold readings. This is normal. Do not let air out to match the recommended cold air pressure. The tire will be underinflated.
While tubeless tires have some ability to self-seal if they are punctured, you should look closely for punctures if a tire starts losing pressure. You should get your own tire pressure gauge and use it whenever you check your tire pressures. This will make it easier for you to tell if a pressure loss is due to a tire problem and not due to a variation between gauges.
Recommended Tire Pressures The following chart shows the recommended cold tire pressures for most normal and high-speed driving conditions. Tire Size P255/55R18 104H
Cold Tire Pressure for Normal Driving Front/Rear: 32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm )
The compact spare tire pressure is: 60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm ) For convenience, the recommended tire sizes and cold tire pressures are on a label on the driver’s doorjamb. For additional information about your tires, see page 454 .
416
07/07/09 10:18:52 31STX610 0422
Tires Tire Inspection Every time you check inflation, you should also examine the tires for damage, foreign objects, and wear.
INDICATOR LOCATION MARKS
You should look for: Bumps or bulges in the tread or side of the tire. Replace the tire if you find either of these conditions. Cuts, splits, or cracks in the side of the tire. Replace the tire if you can see fabric or cord.
Your tires have wear indicators molded into the tread. When the tread wears down, you will see a 1/2 inch (12.7 mm) wide band across the tread. This shows there is less than 1/16 inch (1.6 mm) of tread left on the tire. A tire this worn gives very little traction on wet roads. You should replace the tire if you can see three or more tread wear indicators.
417
Maintenance
Excessive tread wear.
TREAD WEAR INDICATORS
Tire Service Life The service life of your tires is dependent on many factors, including, but not limited to, driving habits, road conditions, vehicle loading, inflation pressure, maintenance history, speed, and environmental conditions (even when the tires are not in use). In addition to your regular inspections and inflation pressure maintenance, it is recommended that you have annual inspections performed once the tires reach five years old. It is also recommended that all tires, including the spare, be removed from service after 10 years from the date of manufacture, regardless of their condition or state of wear. The last four digits of the TIN (tire identification number) are found on the sidewall of the tire and indicate the date of manufacture (See Tire Labeling on page 456 ).
07/07/09 10:19:02 31STX610 0423
Tires Tire Maintenance In addition to proper inflation, correct wheel alignment helps to decrease tire wear. If you find a tire is worn unevenly, have your dealer check the wheel alignment. Have your dealer check the tires if you feel a consistent vibration while driving. A tire should always be rebalanced if it is removed from the wheel. When you have new tires installed, make sure they are balanced. This increases riding comfort and tire life. For best results, have the installer perform a dynamic balance.
Improper wheel weights can damage your vehicle’s aluminum wheels. Use only Acura wheel weights f or balancing.
418
Tire Rotation Front
Front
(For Non-directional (For Directional Tires and Wheels) Tires and Wheels)
To help increase tire life and distribute wear more evenly, rotate the tires according to the maintenance messages displayed on the multi-information display. Move the tires to the positions shown in the illustration each time they are rotated. If you purchase directional tires, rotate only front-to-back.
Replacing Tires and Wheels Replace your tires with radial tires of the same size, load range, speed rating, and maximum cold tire pressure rating (as shown on the tire’s sidewall). Mixing radial and bias-ply tires on your vehicle can reduce braking ability, traction, and steering accuracy. Using tires of a different size or construction can cause the ABS and vehicle stability assist system (VSA) to work inconsistently. The ABS works by comparing the speed of the wheels. When replacing tires, use the same size originally supplied with the vehicle. Tire size and construction can affect wheel speed and may cause the system to activate. When the tires are rotated, make sure the air pressures are checked.
07/07/09 10:19:13 31STX610 0424
Tires It is best to replace all four tires at the same time. If that is not possible or necessary, replace the two front tires or two rear tires as a pair. Replacing just one tire can seriously affect your vehicle’s handling. If you ever replace a wheel, make sure that the wheel’s specifications match those of the original wheels.
Replacement wheels are available at your dealer.
Always use the size and type of tires recommended in this owner’s manual. Wheel and Tire Specifications Wheel: 18 x 8 J Tires: P255/55R18 104H See page 454 for information about DOT Tire Quality Grading, and page 456 for tire size and labeling information.
For the best performance in snowy or icy conditions, you should install snow tires or tire chains. They may be required by local laws under certain conditions. Snow Tires If you mount snow tires on your vehicle, make sure they are radial tires of the same size and load range as the original tires. Mount snow tires on all four wheels. The traction provided by snow tires on dry roads may be lower than your original tires. Check with the tire dealer for maximum speed recommendations.
419
Maintenance
Also be sure you use only TPMS specific wheels. If you do not, the tire pressure monitoring system will not work.
Installing improper tires on your vehicle can affect handling and stability. This can cause a crash in which you can be seriously hurt or killed.
Winter Driving Tires marked ‘‘M + S’’ or ‘‘All Season’’ on the sidewall have an allweather tread design suitable for most winter driving conditions.
07/07/09 10:19:20 31STX610 0425
Tires Tire Chains Mount tire chains on your tires when required by driving conditions or local laws. Install them only on the front tires. Because your vehicle has limited tire clearance, Acura strongly recommends using the chains listed below. SCC Super Z-6#SZ 435 When installing chains, follow the manufacturer’s instructions and mount them as tightly as you can. Drive slowly with chains installed. If you hear them contacting the body or chassis, stop and investigate. Make sure the chains are installed tightly, and that they are not contacting the brake lines or suspension. Remove the chains as soon as you start driving on cleared roads.
420
Using the wrong chains, or not properly installing chains, can damage the brake lines and cause a crash in which you can be seriously injured or killed. Follow all instructions in this owner’s manual regarding the selection and use of tire chains.
Traction devices that are the wrong size or improperly installed can damage your vehicle’s brake lines, suspension, body, and wheels. Stop driving if they are hitting any part of the vehicle.
Wheels Clean the wheels as you would the rest of the exterior. Wash them with the same solution, and rinse them thoroughly. Aluminum alloy wheels have a protective clear-coat that keeps the aluminum from corroding and tarnishing. Cleaning the wheels with harsh chemicals (including some commercial wheel cleaners) or a stiff brush can damage the clear-coat. To clean the wheels, use a mild detergent and a soft brush or sponge.
07/07/09 10:19:28 31STX610 0426
Checking the Battery TEST INDICATOR WINDOW
If additional battery maintenance is needed, see your dealer or a qualified technician. WARNING: Battery posts, terminals, and related accessories contain lead and lead compounds. Wash your hands after handling. If you need to connect the battery to a charger, disconnect both cables to prevent damaging your vehicle’s electrical system. Always disconnect the negative (−) cable first, and reconnect it last.
The battery gives off explosive hydrogen gas during normal operation. A spark or flame can cause the battery to explode with enough force to kill or seriously hurt you. Wear protective clothing and a face shield, or have a skilled technician do the battery maintenance. If the radio fuse is removed, the audio system will disable itself. The next time you turn on the radio you will see ‘‘ENTER CODE’’ in the frequency display. Use the preset buttons to enter the digit code (see page 235 ).
421
Maintenance
Check the condition of the battery monthly by looking at the test indicator window: Green − Good condition White − Liquid level low, replace battery Black − Charging necessary
Check the terminals for corrosion (a white or yellowish powder). To remove it, cover the terminals with a solution of baking soda and water. It will bubble up and turn brown. When this stops, wash it off with plain water. Dry off the battery with a cloth or paper towel. Coat the terminals with grease to help prevent further corrosion.
07/07/09 10:19:37 31STX610 0427
Vehicle Storage If you need to park your vehicle for an extended period (more than 1 month), there are several things you should do to prepare it for storage. Proper preparation helps prevent deterioration and makes it easier to get your vehicle back on the road. If possible, store your vehicle indoors. Fill the fuel tank. Wash and dry the exterior completely. Clean the interior. Make sure the carpeting, floor mats, etc., are completely dry. Leave the parking brake off. Put the transmission in Park.
422
Block the rear wheels. If the vehicle is to be stored for a longer period, it should be supported on jackstands so the tires are off the ground. Leave one window open slightly (if the vehicle is being stored indoors). Disconnect the battery. Support the front and rear wiper blade arms with a folded towel or rag so they do not touch the windshield. To minimize sticking, apply a silicone spray lubricant to all door and tailgate seals. Also, apply a vehicle body wax to the painted surfaces that mate with the door and tailgate seals.
Cover the vehicle with a ‘‘breathable’’ cover, one made from a porous material such as cotton. Non-porous materials, such as plastic sheeting, trap moisture, which can damage the paint. If possible, periodically run the engine until it reaches full operating temperature (the cooling fans cycle on and off twice). Preferably, do this once a month.
07/07/09 10:19:40 31STX610 0428
Taking Care of the Unexpected This section covers the more common problems that motorists experience with their vehicles. It gives you information about how to safely evaluate the problem and what to do to correct it. If the problem has stranded you on the side of the road, you may be able to get going again. If not, you will also find instructions on getting your vehicle towed.
Compact Spare Tire....................... 424 Changing a Flat Tire ..................... 425 If the Engine Won’t Start .............. 431 Jump Starting ................................. 432 If the Engine Overheats ............... 434 Low Oil Pressure Indicator .......... 436 Charging System Indicator........... 436 Malfunction Indicator Lamp ........ 437 Brake System Indicator ................ 438 Fuses ............................................... 439 Fuse Locations ............................... 443 Opening the Fuel Fill Door Manually ..................................... 446 Emergency Towing ....................... 446 If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck ........... 447 Taking Care of the Unexpected
423
07/07/09 10:19:49 31STX610 0429
Compact Spare Tire Use the compact spare tire as a temporary replacement only. Get your regular tire repaired or replaced, and put it back on your vehicle as soon as you can. Check the inflation pressure of the compact spare tire every time you check the other tires. It should be inflated to: 60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm ) Follow these precautions: Never exceed 50 mph (80 km/h). This tire gives a harsher ride and less traction on some road surfaces. Use greater caution while driving.
424
Do not mount snow chains on a compact spare.
INDICATOR LOCATION MARK
Do not use your compact spare tire on another vehicle unless it is the same make and model. After the flat tire is replaced with the spare tire, the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator stays on. After several miles (kilometers) driving with the spare, this indicator begins to flash, then stays on again. You will also see a ‘‘CHECK TPMS SYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page 354 ).
TREAD WEAR INDICATOR BAR
Replace the tire when you can see the tread wear indicator bars. The replacement should be the same size and design tire, mounted on the same wheel. The spare tire is not designed to be mounted on a regular wheel, and the spare wheel is not designed for mounting a regular tire.
07/07/09 10:19:57 31STX610 0430
Changing a Flat Tire If you have a flat tire while driving, stop in a safe place to change it. Drive slowly along the shoulder until you get to an exit or an area to stop that is far away from the traffic lanes.
The vehicle can easily roll off the jack, seriously injuring anyone underneath.
1. Park the vehicle on firm, level, and non-slippery ground. Put the transmission in Park. Apply the parking brake.
JACK
TOOLS
SPARE TIRE
2. Turn on the hazard warning lights, and turn the ignition switch to the LOCK (0) position. Have all passengers get out of the vehicle while you change the tire.
4. Push the rear edge of the handle to raise the handle loop and pull up the loop to raise the cargo area floor.
3. Open the tailgate. CONTINUED
425
Taking Care of the Unexpected
Follow the directions for changing a tire exactly, and never get under the vehicle when it is supported only by the jack.
CARGO AREA FLOOR
07/07/09 10:20:03 31STX610 0431
Changing a Flat Tire PLASTIC COVER
KNOB
COVER
5. The tools and jack are under the cargo area behind a cover on the driver’s side. Remove the cover by turning the knobs counterclockwise, then pulling out the cover.
426
6. Turn the jack’s end bracket counterclockwise to loosen it, then remove the jack.
7. The spare tire is stored underneath the rear cargo area. Remove the plastic cover on the cargo area lining to access the shaft for the spare tire hoist.
07/07/09 10:20:12 31STX610 0432
Changing a Flat Tire WHEEL NUT WRENCH
WHEEL NUT WRENCH
BRACKET
9. Keep turning the wheel nut wrench to create slack in the cable. 10.Remove the bracket from the spare tire.
8. Put the wheel nut wrench on the hoist shaft. Turn the wrench counterclockwise to lower the spare tire to the ground. CONTINUED
427
Taking Care of the Unexpected
The wheel nut wrench supplied with your vehicle is specially adapted to f it the hoist shaf t. Do not use any other tool.
11.Loosen each wheel nut 1/2 turn with the wheel nut wrench.
07/07/09 10:20:19 31STX610 0433
Changing a Flat Tire EXTENSION
JACKING POINT
12. Place the jack under the jacking point nearest the tire you need to change. Turn the end bracket clockwise until the top of the jack contacts the jacking point. Make sure the jacking point tab is resting in the jack notch.
428
WHEEL NUT WRENCH
13. Use the extension and the wheel nut wrench as shown to raise the vehicle until the flat tire is off the ground. 14.Remove the wheel nuts, then remove the flat tire.
BRAKE HUB
15.Before mounting the spare tire, wipe any dirt off the mounting surface of the wheel and hub with a clean cloth. Wipe the hub carefully; it may be hot from driving.
07/07/09 10:20:27 31STX610 0434
Changing a Flat Tire 20.Place the flat tire face up under the hoist.
16.Put on the spare tire. Put the wheel nuts back on finger-tight, then tighten them in a crisscross pattern with the wheel nut wrench until the wheel is firmly against the hub. Do not try to tighten the wheel nuts fully.
21.Insert the hoist bracket into the center hole of the flat tire.
17.Lower the vehicle to the ground, and remove the jack.
19.Remove the center cap from the flat tire. CONTINUED
429
Taking Care of the Unexpected
18.Tighten the wheel nuts securely in the same crisscross pattern. Have the wheel nut torque checked at the nearest automotive service facility. Tighten the wheel nuts to: 94 lbf·ft (127 N·m , 13 kgf·m)
07/07/09 10:20:33 31STX610 0435
Changing a Flat Tire WHEEL NUT WRENCH
Always raise the spare tire hoist, even if you are not stowing a tire. If the hoist is lef t down, it will be damaged during driving and need to be replaced. 24.Store the jack in its holder. Turn the jack’s end bracket to lock it in place. Store the tools, and install the cover. 22.Slowly turn the wheel nut wrench clockwise to take up the slack of the hoist cable. Make sure the bracket is seated in the center hole of the flat tire. 23.Turn the wheel nut wrench clockwise until the flat tire rests against the underbody of the vehicle and you hear the hoist click.
430
25.Refer to Changing a Tire with TPMS (see page 355 ).
Loose items can fly around the interior in a crash and could seriously injure the occupants. Store the wheel, jack, and tools securely before driving.
07/07/09 10:20:44 31STX610 0436
If the Engine Won t Start Diagnosing why the engine won’t start falls into two areas, depending on what you hear when you turn the ignition switch to the START (III) position: You hear nothing, or almost nothing. The engine’s starter motor does not operate at all, or operates very slowly. You can hear the starter motor operating normally, or the starter motor sounds like it is spinning faster than normal, but the engine does not start up and run.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. Turn on the headlights, and check their brightness. If the headlights are very dim or do not come on at all, the battery is discharged. See Jump Starting on page 432 . Turn the ignition switch to the START (III) position. If the headlights do not dim, check the condition of the fuses. If the fuses are OK, there is probably something wrong with the electrical circuit for the ignition switch or starter motor. You will need a qualified technician to determine the problem. See Emergency Towing on page 446 .
If the headlights dim noticeably or go out when you try to start the engine, either the battery is discharged or the connections are corroded. Check the condition of the battery and terminal connections (see page 421 ). You can then try jump starting the vehicle from a booster battery (see page 432 ). The Starter Operates Normally In this case, the starter motor’s speed sounds normal, or even faster than normal, when you turn the ignition switch to the START (III) position, but the engine does not run. Are you using a properly coded key? An improperly coded key will cause the immobilizer system indicator in the instrument panel to blink rapidly (see page 70 ). CONTINUED
431
Taking Care of the Unexpected
Nothing Happens or the Starter Motor Operates Very Slowly When you turn the ignition switch to the START (III) position, you do not hear the normal noise of the engine trying to start. You may hear a clicking sound, a series of clicks, or nothing at all.
Check these things: Check the transmission interlock. The transmission must be in Park or neutral or the starter will not operate.
07/07/09 10:20:54 31STX610 0437
If the Engine Won t Start, Jump Starting Are you using the proper starting procedure? Refer to Starting the Engine on page 339 . Do you have fuel? Check the fuel gauge; the warning indicator may not be working. There may be an electrical problem, such as no power to the fuel pump. Check all the fuses (see page 440 ). If you find nothing wrong, you will need a qualified technician to find the problem. See Emergency Towing on page 446 .
432
Jump Starting Although this seems like a simple procedure, you should take several precautions.
A battery can explode if you do not follow the correct procedure, seriously injuring anyone nearby. Keep all sparks, open flames, and smoking materials away from the battery. You cannot start your vehicle by pushing or pulling it.
To Jump Start Your Vehicle:
1. Open the hood, and check the physical condition of the battery. In very cold weather, check the condition of the electrolyte. If it seems slushy or frozen, do not try jump starting until it thaws.
If a battery sits in extreme cold, the electrolyte inside can f reeze. Attempting to jump start with a f rozen battery can cause it to rupture. 2. Turn off all the electrical accessories: heater, A/C, climate control, audio system, lights, etc. Put the transmission in neutral or Park, and set the parking brake.
07/07/09 10:21:02 31STX610 0438
Jump Starting 5. If the booster battery is in another vehicle, have an assistant start that vehicle and run it at a fast idle. 6. Start your vehicle. If the starter motor still operates slowly, check that the jumper cables have good metal-to-metal contact.
BOOSTER BATTERY
3. Connect one jumper cable to the positive (+) terminal on your vehicle’s battery. Connect the other end to the positive (+) terminal on the booster battery.
4. Connect the second jumper cable to the negative (−) terminal on the booster battery. Connect the other end to the grounding strap as shown. Do not connect this jumper cable to any other part of the engine.
Keep the ends of the jumper cables away from each other and any metal on the vehicle until everything is disconnected. Otherwise, you may cause an electrical short.
433
Taking Care of the Unexpected
The numbers in the illustration show you the order to connect the jumper cables.
7. Once the vehicle is running, disconnect the negative cable from your vehicle, then from the booster battery. Disconnect the positive cable from your vehicle, and then from the booster battery.
07/07/09 10:21:09 31STX610 0439
If the Engine Overheats The pointer of your vehicle’s temperature gauge should stay in the midrange under most conditions. If it climbs to the red mark, you should determine the reason (hot day, driving up a steep hill, etc.). If the vehicle overheats, you should take immediate action. The only indication may be the temperature gauge climbing to or above the red mark. Or you may see steam or spray coming from under the hood.
Driving with the temperature gauge pointer at the red mark can cause serious damage to the engine.
434
Steam and spray from an overheated engine can seriously scald you. Do not open the hood if steam is coming out.
1. Safely pull to the side of the road. Put the transmission in Park, and set the parking brake. Turn off the all accessories, and turn on the hazard warning indicators. 2. If you see steam and/or spray coming from under the hood, turn off the engine. Wait until you see no more signs of steam or spray, then open the hood. 3. If you do not see steam or spray, leave the engine running and watch the temperature gauge. If the high heat is due to overloading, the engine should start to cool down almost immediately. If it does, wait until the temperature gauge comes down to the midpoint, then continue driving.
07/07/09 10:21:18 31STX610 0440
If the Engine Overheats 4. If the temperature gauge stays at the red mark, turn off the engine. 5. Look for any obvious coolant leaks, such as a split radiator hose. Everything is still extremely hot, so use caution. If you find a leak, it must be repaired before you continue driving (see Emergency Towing on page 446 ). 6. If you do not find an obvious leak, check the coolant level in the radiator reserve tank. Add coolant if the level is below the MIN mark.
Always let the engine and radiator cool down before removing the radiator cap. 8. Using gloves or a large heavy cloth, turn the radiator cap counterclockwise, without pushing down, to the first stop. After the pressure releases, push down on the cap, and turn it until it comes off.
10.Put the radiator cap back on tightly. Run the engine, and check the temperature gauge. If it goes back to the red mark, the engine needs repair (see Emergency Towing on page 446 ). 11.If the temperature stays normal, check the coolant level in the radiator reserve tank. If it has gone down, add coolant to the MAX mark. Put the cap back on tightly.
435
Taking Care of the Unexpected
7. If there was no coolant in the reserve tank, you may need to add coolant to the radiator. Let the engine cool down until the pointer reaches the middle of the temperature gauge, or lower, before checking the radiator.
Removing the radiator cap while the engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray out, seriously scalding you.
9. Start the engine and set the climate control to AUTO at ‘‘Hi.’’ Add coolant to the radiator up to the base of the filler neck. If you do not have the proper coolant mixture available, you can add plain water. Remember to have the cooling system drained and refilled with the proper mixture as soon as you can.
07/07/09 10:21:28 31STX610 0441
Low Oil Pressure Indicator, Charging System Indicator Low Oil Pressure Indicator This indicator should never come on when the engine is running. If it starts flashing or stays on, the oil pressure has dropped very low or lost pressure. Serious engine damage is possible, and you should take immediate action. You will also see a ‘‘CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL’’ message on the multi-information display when this indicator comes on.
Running the engine with low oil pressure can cause serious mechanical damage almost immediately. Turn of f the engine as soon as you can saf ely get the vehicle stopped.
436
1. Safely pull off the road, and shut off the engine. Turn on the hazard warning indicators. 2. Let the vehicle sit for a minute. Open the hood, and check the oil level (see page 326 ). An engine very low on oil can lose pressure during cornering and other driving maneuvers. 3. If necessary, add oil to bring the level back to the full mark on the dipstick (see page 393 ). 4. Start the engine, and watch the oil pressure indicator. If it does not go out within 10 seconds, turn off the engine. There is a mechanical problem that needs to be repaired before you can continue driving (see Emergency Towing on page 446 ).
Charging System Indicator If the charging system indicator comes on brightly when the engine is running, the battery is not being charged. You will also see a ‘‘CHECK CHARGING SYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page 81 ). Immediately turn off all electrical accessories. Try not to use other electrically operated controls such as the power windows. Keep the engine running; starting the engine will discharge the battery rapidly. Go to a service station or garage where you can get technical assistance.
07/07/09 10:21:36 31STX610 0442
Malfunction Indicator Lamp If this indicator comes on while driving, it means one of the engine’s emissions control systems may have a problem. Even though you may feel no difference in your vehicle’s performance, it can reduce your fuel economy and cause increased emissions. Continued operation may cause serious damage.
If you keep driving with the malf unction indicator lamp on, you can damage your vehicle’s emissions controls and engine. Those repairs may not be covered by your vehicle’s warranties. You will also see a ‘‘CHECK EMISSION SYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page 81 ). Readiness Code Your vehicle has certain ‘‘readiness codes’’ that are part of the on-board diagnostics for the emissions systems. In some states, part of the emissions testing is to make sure
these codes are set. If they are not set, the test cannot be completed. If the battery in your vehicle has been disconnected or gone dead, these codes may be erased. It takes several days of driving under various conditions to set the codes again. To check if they are set, turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, without starting the engine. The malfunction indicator lamp will come on for 20 seconds. If it then goes off, the readiness codes are set. If it blinks five times, the readiness codes are not set. If possible, do not take your vehicle for an emissions test until the readiness codes are set. Refer to Emissions Testing for more information (see page 463 ).
437
Taking Care of the Unexpected
If you have recently refueled your vehicle, the indicator coming on could be due to a loose or missing fuel fill cap. Tighten the cap until it clicks at least once. Tightening the cap will not turn the indicator off immediately; it can take several days of normal driving.
If the indicator comes on repeatedly, even though it may turn off as you continue driving, have your vehicle checked by the dealer as soon as possible.
07/07/09 10:21:44 31STX610 0443
Brake System Indicator U.S.
Canada
The brake system indicator normally comes on when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, and as a reminder to check the parking brake. It will stay on if you do not fully release the parking brake. If the brake system indicator comes on while driving, the brake fluid level is probably low. Press lightly on the brake pedal to see if it feels normal. If it does, check the brake fluid level the next time you stop at a service station (see page 401 ). You will also see a ‘‘LOW BRAKE FLUID’’ message on the multiinformation display (see page 81 ).
438
If the fluid level is low, take your vehicle to a dealer, and have the brake system inspected for leaks or worn brake pads. However, if the brake pedal does not feel normal, you should take immediate action. A problem in one part of the system’s dual circuit design will still give you braking at two wheels. You will feel the brake pedal go down much farther before the vehicle begins to slow down, and you will have to press harder on the pedal. You will also see a ‘‘CHECK BRAKE SYSTEM’’ message on the multiinformation display (see page 81 ).
Slow down by shifting to a lower gear, and pull to the side of the road when it is safe. Because of the long distance needed to stop, it is hazardous to drive the vehicle. You should have it towed, and repaired as soon as possible (see Emergency Towing on page 446 ). If you must drive the vehicle a short distance in this condition, drive slowly and carefully. If the ABS indicator and the VSA system indicator come on with the brake system indicator, have your vehicle inspected by your dealer immediately.
07/07/09 10:21:53 31STX610 0444
Fuses INTERIOR
LID
REAR
LID
UNDER-HOOD (PRIMARY)
TAB
The rear fuse box is located at the left side of cargo area.
The interior fuse box is underneath the dashboard on the driver’s side.
The primary under-hood fuse box is located next to the battery. The secondary fuse box is on the passenger’s side.
To remove the fuse box lid, put your finger in the notch on the lid, pull it toward you, and take it out of its hinges.
UNDER-HOOD (SECONDARY)
Taking Care of the Unexpected
The vehicle’s fuses are located in four fuse boxes.
To open it, push the tabs as shown.
TAB
439
07/07/09 10:22:00 31STX610 0445
Fuses Checking and Replacing Fuses If something electrical in your vehicle stops working, the first thing you should check for is a blown fuse. Determine from the chart on pages 443 , 444 , and 445 , or the diagram on the fuse box lid, which fuse or fuses control that device. Check those fuses first, but check all the fuses before deciding that a blown fuse is the cause. Replace any blown fuses, and check if the device works. 1. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK (0) position. Make sure the headlights and all other accessories are off. 2. Remove the cover from the fuse box.
440
FUSE
BLOWN
3. Check each of the large fuses in the under-hood fuse boxes by looking through the top at the wire inside. Removing these fuses requires a Phillips-head screwdriver.
BLOWN
07/07/09 10:22:07 31STX610 0446
Fuses BLOWN
FUSE PULLER
5. Look for a burned wire inside the fuse. If it is burned out, replace it with one of the spare fuses of the same rating or lower.
If you replace the blown fuse with a spare fuse that has a lower rating, it might blow out again. This does not indicate anything wrong. Replace the fuse with one of the correct rating as soon as you can.
CONTINUED
441
Taking Care of the Unexpected
4. Check the smaller fuses in the under-hood fuse boxes and rear fuse box, and all the fuses in the interior and rear fuse boxes by pulling out each one with the fuse puller provided in the primary under-hood fuse box.
If you cannot drive the vehicle without fixing the problem, and you do not have a spare fuse, take a fuse of the same rating or a lower rating from one of the other circuits. Make sure you can do without that circuit temporarily (such as the accessory power socket or radio).
07/07/09 10:22:11 31STX610 0447
Fuses
Replacing a f use with one that has a higher rating greatly increases the chances of damaging the electrical system. If you do not have a replacement f use with the proper rating f or the circuit, install one with a lower rating. 6. If the replacement fuse of the same rating blows in a short time, there is probably a serious electrical problem with your vehicle. Leave the blown fuse in that circuit, and have your vehicle checked by a qualified technician.
442
If the radio fuse is removed, the audio system will disable itself. The next time you turn on the radio you will see ‘‘ENTER CODE’’ in the frequency display. Use the preset buttons to enter the digit code (see page 235 ).
07/07/09 10:22:18 31STX610 0448
Fuse Locations PRIMARY UNDER-HOOD FUSE BOX
No. Amps.
2−7
40 A
2−8 3−1
− 60 A
3−2
40 A
3−3
60 A
3−4
50 A
Main fuse Not Used Not Used Not Used Rear Blower Motor ABS VSA Trailer Main Power Seats, Driver’s Position Memory System, Subwoofer Front Heated Seat, TPMS, Moonroof, Driver’s Lumber Support Not Used Fog Lights, Front Blower Motor Headlights, Daytime Running Lights Cooling Fan, Condenser Fan, MG Clutch, Headlight Washer* Ignition Switch Main
No. Amps. 3−5 3−6
50 A 60 A
3−7 3−8 4
30 A − 40 A
5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
− − 30 A 30 A 7.5 A 15 A 15 A 20 A 20 A 20 A 20 A
Circuits Protected Power Window SH-AWD®, Power Tailgate Open/Closer, Rear ACC Socket, Cargo Area Light, Rear Defroster ECU (PCM) Not Used Audio, Door Lock, Interior Lights Not Used Not Used Active Damper Control Unit Audio Amplifier Rear Entertainment System Hazard Horn, Stop ABS VSA Trailer (Brake) Rear Heated Seat A/C Inverter
*: Canadian model
443
Taking Care of the Unexpected
2−1 2−2 2−3 2−4 2−5 2−6
120 A − − − 30 A 40 A 40 A 40 A
1
Circuits Protected
07/07/09 10:22:27 31STX610 0449
Fuse Locations SECONDARY UNDER-HOOD FUSE BOX
No. Amps. 1 2
10 A 10 A
3 4
10 A 10 A
444
Circuits Protected Left Daytime Running Light Right Daytime Running Light Left Headlight High Right Headlight High
No. Amps. 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 22
7.5 A 30 A 7.5 A 15 A 15 A 15 A 15 A 40 A 20 A 30 A 30 A 30 A 7.5 A 15 A 15 A 7.5 A
Circuits Protected Small Lights (Exterior) Headlight Low Main Cooling Fan Timer IGP IG Coil DBW AFHT Front Blower Motor Fog lights Headlight Washer* Condenser Fan Cooling Fan MG Clutch Left Headlight Low Right Headlight Low Small Lights (Interior)
*: Canadian model
REAR FUSE BOX
No. Amps. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
− − − − 10 A 20 A − 10 A 30 A 30 A 40 A
Circuits Protected Not Used Not Used Not Used Not Used Rear ACC Socket Power Tailgate Not Used Cargo Area Light SH-AWD® Rear Defroster Power Tailgate
07/07/09 10:22:38 31STX610 0450
Fuse Locations INTERIOR FUSE BOX
No. Amps.
Auxiliary
No. Amps. 7.5 A 10 A
3 4 5
10 A 20 A 10 A
TPMS Driver’s Lumber Support Motor Moonroof Front Heated Seats Audio
7.5 A 10 A 20 A 15 A 15 A 30 A 10 A 20 A 20 A 20 A 20 A 20 A 10 A 20 A 7.5 A
21
7.5 A
Interior Light Interior Light, Moonroof Door Lock ACC Socket IG Coil Windshield Wiper Subwoofer Passenger’s Power Recline Driver’s Power Slide Telescope Steering Wheel Driver’s Power Recline Passenger’s Power Slide Alternator Fuel Pump SH-AWD® , Active Damper Control Unit Gauges
No. Amps. 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30
10 A − 20 A 20 A 30 A 30 A 20 A 10 A 10 A
31
15 A
32 33
10 A −
Circuits Protected SRS Not Used Left Rear Power Window Right Rear Power Window Passenger’s Power Window Driver’s Power Window Tilt Steering Wheel ABS VSA A/C Headlight Auto Leveling, Rear Wiper, Windshield/ Rear Washer ACC Not Used
Taking Care of the Unexpected
1 2
Circuits Protected
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
Circuits Protected
Auxiliary No. Amps. 1 2
7.5 A 7.5 A
Circuits Protected Starter DIAG STS
445
07/07/09 10:22:46 31STX610 0451
Opening the Fuel Fill Door Manually, Emergency Towing Opening the Fuel Fill Door Manually
Emergency Towing If your vehicle needs to be towed, call a professional towing service or organization. Never tow your vehicle with just a rope or chain. It is very dangerous.
LID
RELEASE LEVER
If the fuel fill door release button does not work, use the release lever inside the rear fuse box lid in the cargo area.
446
To open the fuel fill door, pull the release lever rearward.
The only way you can safely tow your vehicle is with flat-bed equipment. The operator will load your vehicle on the back of a truck. Any other method of towing will damage the drive system. When you contact the towing agency, inform them a flat-bed is required.
Towing with only two tires on the ground will damage parts of the all-wheel-drive system. Your vehicle should be transported on a f lat-bed truck or trailer.
07/07/09 10:22:52 31STX610 0452
If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck If your vehicle gets stuck in sand, mud, or snow, call a towing service to pull it out (see the previous page).
Front
COVER
Rear
COVER
For very short distances, such as freeing the vehicle, you can use the detachable towing hook that mounts on the anchors in the front and rear bumpers.
The cover is attached to the bumper with a tether. Taking Care of the Unexpected
1. Remove the cover, put cloth on the edge of the cover and carefully pry with a small flat-tip screwdriver or a metal fingernail file.
447
07/07/09 10:22:58 31STX610 0453
If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck WHEEL NUT WRENCH
WHEEL NUT WRENCH
To avoid damage to your vehicle, use the towing hook f or straight, f lat ground towing only. Do not tow at an angle. The tow hook should not be used to tow the vehicle onto a f lat bed. Do not use it as a tie down.
Front
TOWING HOOK
2. Remove the towing hook and wheel nut wrench placed behind a cover under the cargo area. 3. Screw the towing hook into the hole, and tighten it with the wheel nut wrench.
448
Rear
TOWING HOOK
07/07/09 10:23:02 31STX610 0454
Technical Information The diagrams in this section give you the dimensions and capacities of your vehicle and the locations of the identification numbers. It also includes information you should know about your vehicle’s tires and emissions control systems.
Identification Numbers ................. 450 Specifications ................................. 452 DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles) ........................... 454 Tire Labeling .................................. 456 Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) − Required Federal Explanation............................. 458 Emissions Controls........................ 460 Three Way Catalytic Converter ... 462 Emissions Testing ......................... 463
Technical Information
449
07/07/09 10:23:06 31STX610 0455
Identification Numbers Your vehicle has several identifying numbers located in various places.
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
The vehicle identification number (VIN) is the 17-digit number your dealer uses to register your vehicle for warranty purposes. It is also necessary for licensing and insuring your vehicle. The easiest place to find the VIN is on a plate fastened to the top of the dashboard. You can see it by looking through the windshield on the driver’s side. It is also on the certification label attached to the driver’s doorjamb, and is stamped on the engine compartment bulkhead. The VIN is also provided in bar code on the certification label.
CERTIFICATION LABEL
450
07/07/09 10:23:10 31STX610 0456
Identification Numbers The engine number is stamped into the engine block. It is on the front.
ENGINE NUMBER
The transmission number is on a label on top of the transmission.
Technical Information
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION NUMBER
451
07/07/09 10:23:28 31STX610 0457
Specifications Dimensions Length Width Height Wheelbase Track
Front Rear
Weights Gross vehicle weight rating Gross combined weight*1 rating (GCWR)
190.7 in (4,844 mm) 77.0 in (1,955 mm) 68.2 in (1,733 mm) 108.3 in (2,750 mm) 67.7 in (1,720 mm) 67.5 in (1,715 mm)
See the tire information label attached to the driver’s doorjamb. 10,053 lbs (4,560 kg)
*1 : The GCWR must be reduced 2 percent for every 1,000 feet (305 meters) of elevation. Air Conditioning Refrigerant type Charge quantity Lubricant type Seating Capacities Total Front Second Third
452
HFC-134a (R-134a) 21.2−22.9 oz (600−650 g) ND-OIL8
7 2 3 2
Capacities Fuel tank Engine coolant Engine oil
*1
Change Total Change*2 Including filter Without filter Total Automatic Change transmission Total fluid Rear Change differential Total fluid Transfer Change assembly Total fluid Windshield U.S. vehicles washer Canadian reservoir vehicles
Approx. 21.00 US gal (79.5 ) 1.93 US gal (7.3 ) 2.43 US gal (9.2 ) 4.5 US qt (4.3 ) 4.2 US qt (4.0 ) 5.3 US qt (5.0 ) 3.0 US qt (2.8 ) 8.3 US qt (7.9 ) 2.6 US qt (2.5 ) 2.9 US qt (2.7 ) 0.4 US qt (0.4 ) 0.4 US qt (0.4 ) 4.2 US qt (4.0 ) 6.1 US qt (5.8 )
*1 : Including the coolant in the reserve tank and that remaining in the engine Reserve tank capacity: 0.18 US gal (0.7 ) *2 : Excluding the oil remaining in the engine
07/07/09 10:23:56 31STX610 0458
Specifications Lights Headlights
High Low*
Daytime running light Front side marker lights Front turn signal lights Parking lights Fog light Front foot lights Rear turn signal lights Rear side marker light Backup lights License plate lights Front Individual map lights Rear Cargo area light Tailgate light Vanity mirror light Door light
12 V 12 V 12 V 12 V 12 V 12 V 12 V 12 V 12 V 12 V 12 V 12 V 12 V 12 V 12 V 12 V 12 V 12 V
− − − − − − − − − − − − − − − − − −
60 W (HB3) 35 W (D2S) 60 W (HB3) 3 CP 21 W 3 CP 55 W (H11) 3.4 W 21 W 3 CP 18 W 3 CP 5W 5W 8W 5W 2W 3.4 W
Battery Capacity
Rear
Under-hood
Engine Type Bore x Stroke Displacement Compression ratio Spark plugs
Alignment Toe-in Camber Caster
12 V − 65 AH/5 HR 12 V − 76 AH/20 HR
See page 445 or the fuse label attached to the inside of the fuse box lid. See page 444 or the fuse label attached to the inside of the fuse box lid. See page 443 and 444 or the fuse box cover.
Tires Size Pressure
Front Rear Front Rear Front
Front/Rear Spare Front/Rear Spare
Water cooled 4-stroke SOHC VTEC V6 gasoline engine 3.54 x 3.78 in (90.0 x 96.0 mm) 223.5 cu-in (3,664 cm ) 11.0 : 1 DENSO: SKJ20DR-M11 NGK: IZFR6K11
0.00 in (0.0 mm) 0.08 in (2.0 mm) −0°30’ −0°30’ 4°12’
P255/55R18 104H T165/80D17 104M 32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm ) 60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )
453
Technical Information
* : The low beam headlights are high voltage discharged type. Replacement of a low beam headlight bulb should be performed by your dealer.
Fuses Interior
07/07/09 10:24:05 31STX610 0459
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles) The tires on your vehicle meet all U.S. Federal Safety Requirements. All tires are also graded for treadwear, traction, and temperature performance according to Department of Transportation (DOT) standards. The following explains these gradings. Uniform Tire Quality Grading Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and maximum section width. For example: Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A All passenger car tires must conform to Federal Safety Requirements in addition to these grades.
454
Treadwear The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and onehalf (1 1/2) times as well on the government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices and differences in road characteristics and climate.
Traction The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C. Those grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction performance. Warning: The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or peak traction characteristics.
07/07/09 10:24:09 31STX610 0460
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles) Warning: The temperature grade for this tire is established for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive speed, underinflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause heat buildup and possible tire failure.
Technical Information
Temperature The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C, representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law.
455
07/07/09 10:24:22 31STX610 0461
Tire Labeling The tires that came on your vehicle have a number of markings. Those you should be aware of are described below. TIRE LABELING EXAMPLE (1)
Tire Size
Whenever tires are replaced, they should be replaced with tires of the same size. The following is an example of tire size with an explanation of what each component means. P255/55R18 104H P
− Vehicle type (P indicates passenger vehicle).
255 − Tire width in millimeters. 55 − Aspect ratio (the tire’s section height as a percentage of its width). (1) (4) (1) (2) (3) (4)
456
(3)
(2)
Tire Size Tire Identification Number (TIN) Maximum Tire Pressure Maximum Tire Load
R
− Tire construction code (R indicates radial).
18 − Rim diameter in inches.
104 − Load index (a numerical code associated with the maximum load the tire can carry). H − Speed symbol (an alphabetical code indicating the maximum speed rating). Tire Identification Number (TIN)
The tire identification number (TIN) is a group of numbers and letters that look like the following example. TIN is located on the sidewall of the tire. DOT B97R FW6X 2202 DOT − This indicates that the tire meets all requirements of the U.S. Department of Transportation. B97R − Manufacturer’s identification mark.
07/07/09 10:24:30 31STX610 0462
Tire Labeling FW6X − Tire type code. 2202
− Date of manufacture. Year Week
Maximum Tire Pressure
Max Press − The maximum air pressure the tire can hold. Maximum Tire Load
Max Load − The maximum load the tire can carry at maximum air pressure. Technical Information
457
07/07/09 10:24:36 31STX610 0463
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) − Required Federal Explanation Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label.
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale
Driving on a significantly underinflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s handling and stopping ability.
(If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.)
when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated.
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale.
458
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure.
07/07/09 10:24:41 31STX610 0464
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) − Required Federal Explanation Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for approximately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists.
Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly.
Technical Information
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly.
459
07/07/09 10:24:48 31STX610 0465
Emissions Controls The burning of gasoline in your vehicle’s engine produces several byproducts. Some of these are carbon monoxide (CO), oxides of nitrogen (NOx), and hydrocarbons (HC). Gasoline evaporating from the tank also produces hydrocarbons. Controlling the production of NOx, CO, and HC is important to the environment. Under certain conditions of sunlight and climate, NOx and HC react to form photochemical ‘‘smog.’’ Carbon monoxide does not contribute to smog creation, but it is a poisonous gas.
The Clean Air Act The United States Clean Air Act* sets standards for automobile emissions. It also requires that automobile manufacturers explain to owners how their emissions controls work and what to do to maintain them. This section summarizes how the emissions controls work. Scheduled maintenance is on page 390 . In Canada, Acura vehicles comply with the Canadian emission requirements, as specified in an agreement with Environment Canada, at the time they are manufactured. *
Crankcase Emissions Control System Your vehicle has a positive crankcase ventilation system. This keeps gasses that build up in the engine’s crankcase from going into the atmosphere. The positive
460
crankcase ventilation valve routes them from the crankcase back to the intake manifold. They are then drawn into the engine and burned. Evaporative Emissions Control System As gasoline evaporates in the fuel tank, an evaporative emissions control canister filled with charcoal adsorbs the vapor. It is stored in this canister while the engine is off. After the engine is started and warmed up, the vapor is drawn into the engine and burned during driving. Onboard Refueling Vapor Recovery The onboard refueling vapor recovery (ORVR) system captures the fuel vapors during refueling. The vapors are adsorbed in a canister filled with activated carbon. While driving, the fuel vapors are drawn into the engine and burned off.
07/07/09 10:24:57 31STX610 0466
Emissions Controls Exhaust Emissions Controls The exhaust emissions controls include four systems: PGM-FI, ignition timing control, exhaust gas recirculation, and three way catalytic converter. These four systems work together to control the engine’s combustion and minimize the amount of HC, CO, and NOx that come out the tailpipe. The exhaust emissions control systems are separate from the crankcase and evaporative emissions control systems. PGM-FI System
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) System
The exhaust gas recirculation (EGR) system takes some of the exhaust gas and routes it back into the intake manifold. Adding exhaust gas to the air/fuel mixture reduces the amount of NOx produced when the fuel is burned. Three Way Catalytic Converter
The three way catalytic converter is in the exhaust system. Through chemical reactions, it converts HC, CO, and NOx in the engine’s exhaust to carbon dioxide (CO2), nitrogen (N2), and water vapor.
Replacement Parts The emissions control systems are designed and certified to work together in reducing emissions to levels that comply with the Clean Air Act. To make sure the emissions remain low, you should use only new Acura replacement parts or their equivalent for repairs. Using lower quality parts may increase the emissions from your vehicle. The emissions control systems are covered by warranties separate from the rest of your vehicle. Read your warranty manual for more information. Technical Information
The PGM-FI system uses sequential multiport fuel injection. It has three subsystems: air intake, engine control, and fuel control. The powertrain control module (PCM) uses various sensors to determine how much air is going into the engine. It then controls how much fuel to inject under all operating conditions.
Ignition Timing Control System
This system constantly adjusts the ignition timing, reducing the amount of HC, CO, and NOx produced.
461
07/07/09 10:25:04 31STX610 0467
Three Way Catalytic Converter The three way catalytic converter contains precious metals that serve as catalysts, promoting chemical reactions to convert the exhaust gasses without affecting the metals. The catalytic converter is referred to as a three-way catalyst, since it acts on HC, CO, and NOx. A replacement unit must be an original Acura part or its equivalent. The three way catalytic converter must operate at a high temperature for the chemical reactions to take place. It can set on fire any combustible materials that come near it. Park your vehicle away from high grass, dry leaves, or other flammables.
THREE WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER
A defective three way catalytic converter contributes to air pollution, and can impair your engine’s performance. Follow these guidelines to protect your vehicle’s three way catalytic converter. Always use unleaded gasoline. Even a small amount of leaded gasoline can contaminate the catalyst metals, making the three way catalytic converter ineffective.
462
WARM UP THREE WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTERS
Keep the engine well maintained. Have your vehicle diagnosed and repaired if it is misfiring, backfiring, stalling, or otherwise not running properly.
07/07/09 10:25:12 31STX610 0468
Emissions Testing Testing of Readiness Codes If you take your vehicle for an emissions test shortly after the battery has been disconnected or gone dead, it may not pass the test. This is because of certain ‘‘readiness codes’’ that must be set in the onboard diagnostics for the emissions systems. These codes are erased when the battery is disconnected, and set again only after several days of driving under a variety of conditions.
If the testing facility determines that the readiness codes are not set, you will be requested to return at a later date to complete the test. If you must get the vehicle retested within the next two or three days, you can condition the vehicle for retesting by doing the following. 1. Make sure the gas tank is nearly, but not completely, full (around 3/4). 2. Make sure the vehicle has been parked with the engine off for 6 hours or more.
4. Without touching the accelerator pedal, start the engine, and let it idle for 20 seconds. 5. Keep the vehicle in Park. Increase the engine speed to 2,000 rpm, and hold it there until the temperature gauge rises to at least 1/4 of the scale (about 3 minutes). 6. Without touching the accelerator pedal, let the engine idle for 20 seconds.
CONTINUED
463
Technical Information
3. Make sure the ambient temperature is between 40° and 95°F.
07/07/09 10:25:17 31STX610 0469
Emissions Testing 7. Select a nearby lightly traveled major highway where you can maintain a speed of 50 to 60 mph (80 to 97 km/h) for at least 20 minutes. Drive on the highway in D. Do not use cruise control. When traffic allows, drive for 90 seconds without moving the accelerator pedal. (Vehicle speed may vary slightly; this is okay.) If you cannot do this for a continuous 90 seconds because of traffic conditions, drive for at least 30 seconds, then repeat it two more times (for a total of 90 seconds).
464
8. Then drive in city/suburban traffic for at least 10 minutes. When traffic conditions allow, let the vehicle coast for several seconds without using the accelerator pedal or the brake pedal.
9. Make sure the vehicle has been parked with the engine off for 30 minutes. If the testing facility determines the readiness codes are still not set, see your dealer.
07/07/09 10:25:20 31STX610 0470
Warranty and Client Relations Client Service Information ........... 466 Warranty Coverages ..................... 467 Reporting Safety Defects (U.S. Vehicles) ........................... 468 Authorized Manuals ...................... 469 Warranty and Client Relations
465
07/07/09 10:25:28 31STX610 0471
Client Service Information Acura dealership personnel are trained professionals. They should be able to answer all your questions. If you encounter a problem that your dealership does not solve to your satisfaction, please discuss it with the dealership’s management. The service manager or general manager can help. Almost all problems are solved in this way.
Canadian Owners:
If you are dissatisfied with the decision made by the dealership’s management, contact the Acura Client Services Office.
In Puerto Rico and the U.S. Virgin Islands:
U.S. Owners: American Honda Motor Co., Inc. Acura Client Services Mail Stop 500-2N-7E 1919 Torrance Blvd. Torrance, CA 90501-2746 Tel: (800) 382-2238
466
Acura Client Services Honda Canada Inc. 715 Milner Avenue Toronto, ON M1B 2K8 Tel: 1-888-9-ACURA-9 Fax: Toll-free 1-877-939-0909 Toronto (416) 287-4776
Vortex Motor Corp. Bella International P.O. Box 190816 San Juan, PR 00919-0816 Tel: (787) 620-7546
When you call or write, please give us this information: Vehicle Identification Number (see page 450 ) Name and address of the dealer who services your vehicle Date of purchase Mileage on your vehicle Your name, address, and telephone number A detailed description of the problem Name of the dealer who sold the vehicle to you
07/07/09 10:25:38 31STX610 0472
Warranty Coverages U.S. Owners Your new vehicle is covered by these warranties:
Emissions Control Systems Defects Warranty and Emissions Performance Warranty − these two
warranties cover your vehicle’s emissions control systems. Time, mileage, and coverage are conditional. Please read your warranty booklet for exact information.
Original Equipment Battery Limited Warranty − this warranty gives up
to 100 % credit toward a replacement battery.
Rust Perforation Limited Warranty
− all exterior body panels are covered for rust-through from the inside for the specified time period with no mileage limit. Accessory Limited Warranty −
Acura accessories are covered under this warranty. Time and mileage limits depend on the type of accessory and other factors. Please read your warranty manual for details. Replacement Parts Limited Warranty − covers all Acura
replacement parts against defects in materials and workmanship.
Replacement Battery Limited Warranty − provides prorated
coverage for a replacement battery purchased from your dealer. Replacement Muffler Lifetime Limited Warranty − provides
coverage for as long as the purchaser of the muffler owns the vehicle. Restrictions and exclusions apply to all these warranties. Please read the 2008 Acura warranty information booklet that came with your vehicle for precise information on warranty coverages. Your vehicle’s original tires are covered by their manufacturer. Tire warranty information is in a separate booklet. Canadian Owners Please refer to the 2008 warranty manual that came with your vehicle.
467
Warranty and Client Relations
New Vehicle Limited Warranty − covers your new vehicle, except for the battery, emissions control systems, and accessories, against defects in materials and workmanship.
Seat Belt Limited Warranty − a seat belt that fails to function properly is covered by a limited warranty. Please read your warranty booklet for details.
07/08/21 11:03:13 31STX610 0473
Reporting Safety Defects (U.S. Vehicles) If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA), in addition to notifying American Honda Motor Co., Inc.
468
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or Acura Automobile Division, American Honda Motor Co., Inc.
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to http://www.saf ercar.gov; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 New Jersey Avenue, SE., Washington, DC 20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.saf ercar.gov.
07/07/09 10:25:50 31STX610 0474
Authorized Manuals Purchasing Factory Authorized Manuals (U.S.only)
The publications shown below can be purchased from Helm Incorporated. You can order by phone or online: Call Helm Inc. at 1-800-782-4356 (credit card orders only) Go online at www. helminc. com If you are interested in other years or models, contact Helm Inc. at 1-800-782-4356. Publication Form Number 61STX01 61STX01EL
31STXM10 31STXQ10 ACU-R
2007-2008 Acura MDX Service Manual 2008 Acura MDX Electrical Troubleshooting Manual 2008 Acura MDX Body Repair Manual 2008 Acura MDX Owner’s Manual 2008 Acura MDX Navigation System Owner’s Manual 2008 Acura MDX Maintenance Journal 2008 Acura MDX Quick Start Guide Order Form for Previous Years Indicate Year and Model Desired
Electrical Troubleshooting Manual: Complements the Service Manual by providing in-depth troubleshooting information for each electrical circuit in your vehicle. Body Repair Manual: Describes the procedures involved in the replacement of damaged body parts.
469
Authorized Manuals
61STX30 31STX610 31STX810
Form Description
Service Manual: Covers maintenance and recommended procedures for repair to engine and chassis components. It is written for the journeyman mechanic, but it is simple enough for most mechanically inclined owners to understand.
07/07/09 10:25:53 31STX610 0475
470
07/07/09 10:25:58 31STX610 0476
Index A
B Battery Charging System Indicator............................ 65, 436 Jump Starting ............................. 432 Maintenance ............................... 421 Specifications ............................. 453 Before Driving ............................... 321 Belts, Seat ..................................... 8, 20 Beverage Holders .......................... 163 Booster Seats ................................... 55 Brakes Anti-lock System (ABS) ............ 357
Break-in, New Linings .............. 322 Fluid ............................................ 401 Parking ........................................ 153 System Indicator .................. 65, 438 Wear Indicators ......................... 357 Braking System.............................. 356 Break-in, New Vehicle .................. 322 Brightness Control, Instruments ................................ 123 Brights, Headlights ....................... 118 Bulb Replacement Back-up Lights ........................... 407 Front Parking Lights ................. 404 Front Side Marker Lights......... 404 Headlights .................................. 403 Rear Bulbs .................................. 406 Specifications ............................. 453 Turn Signal Lights ..................... 404 Bulbs, Halogen ............................... 403
C Cancel Button................................. 272 Capacities Chart............................. 452 CONTINUED
I
INDEX
Accessories and Modifications .... 330 ACCESSORY (Ignition Key Position) ...................................... 129 Accessory Power Sockets............. 166 AC Power Outlet ............................ 167 Active Damper System ................. 361 Acura Link ...................................... 308 Additives, Engine Oil..................... 394 Airbag (SRS) ................................ 9, 24 Air Conditioning System ............... 170 Rear A/C Control ...................... 175 Air Outlets (Vents) ........................ 177 Air Pressure, Tires ........................ 415 Antifreeze ....................................... 396 Anti-lock Brakes (ABS) Indicator Light ..................... 66, 357 Operation .................................... 357 Anti-theft, Audio System............... 235 Anti-theft Steering Column Lock ............................................. 129 Audio System ................. 180, 181, 200 Auto Control Mode, Starting Engine ......................................... 339 Automatic Climate Control........... 170
Automatic Lighting........................ 119 Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners .... 22 Automatic Speed Control.............. 270 Automatic Transmission............... 341 Capacity, Fluid ........................... 452 Checking Fluid Level ................ 399 Shifting ........................................ 341 Shift Lever Position Indicators ................................ 341 Shift Lever Positions ................. 342 Shift Lock Release ..................... 346
07/07/09 10:26:03 31STX610 0477
Index Carbon Monoxide Hazard .............. 58 Cargo Area Light ........................... 161 Cargo Hook .................................... 336 Cargo, How to Carry ..................... 332 CAUTION, Explanation of .............. iii Certification Label ......................... 450 Chains, Tires .................................. 420 Changing a Flat Tire ..................... 425 Changing Oil How to ......................................... 394 When to....................................... 383 Charging System Indicator .... 65, 436 Checklist, Before Driving ............. 338 Childproof Door Locks ................. 131 Child Safety ...................................... 37 Booster Seats ............................... 55 Child Seats .............................. 42, 45 Important Safety Reminders ...... 41 Infants ........................................... 42 Larger Children ........................... 54 LATCH.......................................... 47 Risks with Airbags....................... 38 Small Children.............................. 43 Tether ........................................... 51 Where Should a Child Sit? .......... 38
II
Child Seats ........................................ 45 LATCH Anchorage Points ......... 47 Tether Anchorage Points ..... 52, 53 Cleaning Seat Belts........................ 409 Client Service Office ..................... 466 Climate Control System ................ 170 Clock ............................................... 236 Code, Audio System ...................... 235 CO in the Exhaust ......................... 460 Compact Spare Tire....................... 424 Console Compartment .................. 164 Consumer Information*................ 466 Controls, Instruments and .............. 61 Coolant Adding ......................................... 396 Checking ..................................... 326 Proper Solution .......................... 396 Temperature Gauge .................... 72 Crankcase Emissions Control System......................................... 460 Cruise Control Indicator ................. 70 Cruise Control Operation ............. 270 Cup Holders.................................... 163 Customize Settings .......................... 83 Door/Window Setup ................. 105 Lighting Setup............................ 100
Meter Setup .................................. 89 Position Setup............................... 97 Setting to Default ......................... 86 Wiper Setup ................................ 113
D DANGER, Explanation of ................ iii Dashboard .................................... 3, 62 Daytime Running Lights............... 120 Dead Battery .................................. 432 Defects, Reporting Safety............. 468 Defogger, Rear Window ............... 122 Defrosting the Windows ............... 174 Differential Fluid ........................... 452 Dimensions ..................................... 452 Dimming the Headlights .............. 118 Dipstick Automatic Transmission........... 399 Engine Oil ................................... 326 Directional Signals ........................... 67 Disc Brake Wear Indicators ......... 357 Disc Care ........................................ 229 Disc Changer ......................... 190, 218 Disc Changer Error Messages ............................ 199, 228
07/07/09 10:26:08 31STX610 0478
Index Disc Player ............................. 190, 218 Disposal of Used Oil ...................... 395 Doors Locking and Unlocking ............. 130 Lockout Prevention ................... 131 Monitor ......................................... 11 Power Door Locks ..................... 130 DOT Tire Quality Grading ........... 454 Driver and Passenger Safety ............ 5 Driving ............................................ 337 Economy ..................................... 327 Driving Position Memory System......................................... 157 DVD Player Error Messages ....... 265 DVD Player .................................... 240
E
Evaporative Emissions Controls .. 460 Exhaust Fumes ................................ 58 Exhaust Gas Recirculation System......................................... 461 Expectant Mothers, Use of Seat Belts by ......................................... 18
F Fan, Interior.................................... 173 Features, Comfort and Convenience ............................... 169 Filling the Fuel Tank ..................... 323 Filters Oil ................................................ 394 Flashers, Hazard Warning............ 122 Flat Tire, Changing a .................... 425 Floor Mats ...................................... 410 Fluids Automatic Transmission........... 399 Brake ........................................... 401 Power Steering........................... 402 Windshield Washer ................... 398 CONTINUED
III
INDEX
Economy, Fuel ............................... 327 Emergencies................................... 423 Battery, Jump Starting .............. 432 Brake System Indicator ............ 438 Changing a Flat Tire ................. 425 Charging System Indicator ...... 436 Checking the Fuses................... 440 Driving with a Flat Tire ............ 424
Hazard Warning Flashers ........ 122 Jump Starting ............................. 432 Low Oil Pressure Indicator ...... 436 Malfunction Indicator Lamp .... 437 Overheated Engine ................... 434 Opening the Fuel Fill Door Manually ................................. 446 Towing ........................................ 446 Emergency Brake .......................... 153 Emergency Flashers ..................... 122 Emergency Towing ....................... 446 Emissions Controls........................ 460 Emissions Testing ......................... 463 Engine Check Starting System ............. 340 Coolant Temperature Gauge ..... 72 If it Won’t Start .......................... 431 Malfunction Indicator Lamp ................................. 65, 437 Oil Life ........................................ 383 Oil Pressure Indicator ......... 65, 436 Oil, What Kind to Use ............... 393 Overheating................................ 434 Specifications ............................. 453 Speed Limiter ............................. 346 Starting........................................ 339
07/07/09 10:26:13 31STX610 0479
Index FM Stereo Radio Reception .................................... 205 Fog Lights ...................................... 120 Folding the Second Seat ............... 144 Folding the Third Seat .................. 145 Four-way Flashers ......................... 122 Front Airbags ............................... 9, 27 Front Seat ....................................... 140 Adjusting..................................... 140 Airbags ...................................... 9, 27 Heaters........................................ 148 Fuel .................................................. 322 Fill Door and Cap....................... 323 Gauge ............................................ 72 Octane Requirement ................. 322 Opening the Fuel Fill Door Manually ................................. 446 Oxygenated ................................ 322 Reserve Indicator......................... 71 Tank, Filling the......................... 323 Tighten Fuel Cap ....................... 324 Fuses, Checking the ...................... 440
G Gas Mileage, Improving................ 327
IV
Gasoline .......................................... 322 Gauge ............................................ 72 Low Fuel Indicator ...................... 71 Octane Requirement ................. 322 Tank, Refueling ......................... 323 Gas Station Procedures................. 323 Gauges Engine Coolant Temperature .... 72 Fuel ................................................ 72 Speedometer ................................ 72 Tachometer .................................. 72 GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) ........................................ 364 GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating) ........................................ 364 Gearshift Lever Positions ............. 342 Glove Box ....................................... 164 GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) ........................................ 364
H Halogen Headlight Bulbs.............. 403 HandsFreeLinkTM ........................... 280 HFL Buttons............................... 281 Hazard Warning Flashers............. 122
Headlights ...................................... 118 Aiming ......................................... 403 Automatic Lighting ................... 119 Daytime Running Lights .......... 120 High Beam Indicator ................... 70 High Beams, Turning on .......... 118 Lights On Indicator ..................... 70 Low Beams, Turning on ........... 118 Reminder Chime........................ 118 Replacing Halogen Bulbs ......... 403 Turning on .................................. 118 Washers ...................................... 117 Headphones.................................... 266 Head Restraints ............................. 141 Heated Mirror ................................ 156 Heaters, Seats ................................ 148 Heating and Cooling ...................... 170 High-Low Beam Switch ................ 118 HomeLink Universal Transceiver................................. 276 Hood, Opening the ........................ 325 Horn................................................. 115
I Identification Number, Vehicle.... 450
07/07/09 10:26:20 31STX610 0480
Index SH-AWD® ............................. 69, 348 SRS ................................................ 66 System Message .................... 69, 80 Tire Pressure Monitor ................ 68 Turn Signal and Hazard Warning .................................... 67 VSA Activation ............................. 67 VSA System .................................. 67 Individual Map Lights ................... 160 Infant Restraint ................................ 42 Infant Seats ....................................... 42 Inflation, Proper Tire .................... 415 Inside Mirror .................................. 154 Inspection, Tire .............................. 417 Instrument Panel ......................... 4, 63 Instrument Panel Brightness ....... 123 Interface Dial ......................... 200, 308 Interior Lights ................................ 159 Introduction ......................................... i
K Keys ................................................. 126 Keyless Memory Settings ............ 139
L Label, Certification ........................ 450 Lane Change, Signaling ................ 118 Lap/Shoulder Belts ................... 15, 21 Light Control Switch ..................... 159 Lights Bulb Replacement ..................... 403 Indicator ........................................ 63 Interior ........................................ 159 Parking ........................................ 118 Load Limit .............................. 333, 364 LOCK (Ignition Key Position) ..... 129
J Jacking up the Vehicle .................. 428 Jack, Tire ........................................ 425 Jump Starting ................................. 432
INDEX
Ignition Keys............................................. 126 Switch .......................................... 129 Timing Control System ............. 461 Immobilizer System....................... 128 Important Safety Precautions .......... 6 Indicators, Instrument Panel .......... 63 Active Damper System ....... 71, 361 ABS (Anti-lock Brake) ................ 66 A/T Temp..................................... 68 Brake (Parking and Brake System) ............................. 65, 438 Charging System ................. 65, 436 Cruise Control .............................. 70 Cruise Main .................................. 70 Fog Lights .................................... 70 High Beam .................................... 70 Key (Immobilizer System) ......... 70 Lights On ...................................... 70 Low Fuel ....................................... 71 Low Oil Pressure ................. 65, 436 Low Tire Pressure ....................... 68 Malfunction Indicator Lamp .... 437 Security System ........................... 71 Side Airbag Off ............................ 66 Seat Belt ........................................ 64
CONTINUED
V
07/07/09 10:26:26 31STX610 0481
Index Locks Anti-theft Steering Column ...... 129 Fuel Fill Door ............................. 323 Glove Box ................................... 164 Lockout Prevention ................... 131 Power Door ................................ 130 Tailgate ............................... 131, 132 Low Coolant Level ......................... 326 Low Fuel Indicator .......................... 71 Low Oil Pressure Indicator .... 65, 436 Lubricant Specifications Chart .... 452 Luggage, Storing (cargo) ............. 332
M Maintenance ................................... 381 Owner’s Maintenance Checks .................................... 389 Minder......................................... 383 Safety........................................... 382 Schedule ..................................... 390 Malfunction Indicator Lamp ........ 437 Memory, Driving Position ............ 157 Message Display .............................. 80 Message Indicator ........................... 69 Meters, Gauges ................................ 72
VI
Mirrors, Adjusting ......................... 155 Modifications.................................. 331 Modifying Your Vehicle................ 331 Moonroof ........................................ 152 Multi-Information Display .............. 73
N Neutral Gear Position.................... 342 New Vehicle Break-in ................... 322 NOTICE, Explanation of .................... i Numbers, Identification ................ 450
O Octane Requirement, Gasoline .... 322 Odometer .......................................... 75 Odometer, Trip ................................ 75 Off-Highway Driving ..................... 377 Off-Road Precautions .................... 377 Oil Change, How to ......................... 394 Change, When to ....................... 383 Checking Engine ....................... 326 Life, Engine ................................ 383 Pressure Indicator ............... 65, 436
Selecting Proper Viscosity Chart ....................................... 393 ON (Ignition Key Position) .......... 129 Outside Mirrors ............................. 154 Outside Temperature ...................... 76 Overheating, Engine ..................... 434 Owner’s Maintenance Checks ..... 389 Oxygenated Fuels.......................... 322
P Panel Brightness Control ............. 123 Park Gear Position......................... 342 Parking ............................................ 350 Parking Brake ................................ 153 Parking Brake and Brake System Indicator .................. 65, 438 Parking Lights................................ 118 Parking Over Things that Burn ... 350 Passenger Airbag Off Indicator ..... 34 PGM-FI System.............................. 461 Power Seat Adjustments ............... 140 Power Socket Locations................ 162 Power Windows ............................. 149 Pregnancy, Using Seat Belts .......... 18
07/07/09 10:26:32 31STX610 0482
Index Protecting Adults and Teens.......... 11 Additional Safety Precautions .... 19 Advice for Pregnant Women...... 18 Protecting Children ......................... 37 General Guidelines ...................... 37 Protecting Infants ........................ 42 Protecting Larger Children ........ 54 Protecting Small Children .......... 43 Using Child Seats with Tethers...................................... 51 Using LATCH .............................. 47
R
S Safety Belts................................... 8, 20 Safety Defects, Reporting* .......... 468
Safety Features .................................. 7 Airbags ............................................ 9 Door Locks ................................... 11 Head Restraints ........................... 14 Seat Belts .................................. 8, 15 Seats & Seat-Backs ................ 12, 13 Safety Labels, Location of .............. 59 Safety Messages ............................... iii Satellite Radio, XM ................ 185, 210 Seat Belts ...................................... 8, 15 Additional Information ................ 20 Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners ................................ 22 Cleaning ...................................... 409 Lap/Shoulder Belt ....................... 21 Maintenance ................................. 23 Reminder Light and Beeper ................................. 20, 64 System Components.................... 20 Use During Pregnancy................ 18 Wearing a Lap/Shoulder Belt .... 15 INDEX
Radiator Overheating .................... 434 Radio/Disc Sound System.... 181, 201 Readiness Codes ............................ 462 Rear A/C Unit ................................ 175 Rear Audio Control Panel ............. 241 Rear Entertainment System ......... 237 Rear Lights, Bulb Replacement ... 406 Rear View Camera and Monitor .. 320 Rear View Mirror........................... 154 Rear Window Defogger ................ 174 Rear Window Wiper and Washer ........................................ 117
Reclining the Seat Backs .............. 140 Reclining the Second Seats .......... 144 Reminder Indicators ........................ 64 Remote Audio Controls................. 233 Remote Control (RES) .................. 242 Remote Transmitter ...................... 135 Replacement Information Engine Oil and Filter ................. 394 Fuses ........................................... 440 Light Bulbs ................................. 403 Schedule ..................................... 383 Timing Belt ................................. 402 Tires ............................................ 418 Wiper Blades .............................. 411 Replacing Seat Belts After a Crash ............................................. 23 Reserve Tank, Engine Coolant .... 326 Restraint, Child ................................ 37 Reverse Gear Position................... 342 Rotation, Tire ................................. 418
CONTINUED
VII
07/07/09 10:26:36 31STX610 0483
Index Seats ................................................ 140 Adjusting the Second Seat ........ 144 Folding the Second Seat ........... 144 Folding the Third Seat .............. 145 Head Restraints ......................... 141 Heaters........................................ 148 Position Memory ....................... 157 Third Row Access ..................... 145 Security System ............................. 269 Sensors Driver’s Seat Position Sensor ..... 29 Front Passenger’s Weight Sensors...................................... 29 Impact Sensors....................... 25, 26 Sequential SportShift Mode ......... 343 Serial Number ................................ 450 Service Intervals ............................ 383 Service Manual* ............................ 469 Service Station Procedures .......... 323 SH-AWD® ....................................... 348 Indicator ........................................ 69 Torque Distribution Monitor ... 348 Shifting the Automatic Transmission .............................. 341 Shift Lever Position Indicator ...... 341 Shift Lock Release ......................... 346
VIII
Side Airbags ..................................... 30 Off Indicator ................................. 33 Side Curtain Airbags ....................... 32 Side Marker Lights, Bulb Replacement in .......................... 404 Signaling Turns ................................ 67 Snow Tires ...................................... 419 Sound System......................... 180, 200 Spare Tire Inflating............................... 416, 424 Specifications ............................. 453 Specifications Charts..................... 452 Speed Limiter ................................. 346 Speed Control ................................. 270 Speedometer .................................... 72 SRS, Additional Information........... 24 Additional Safety Precautions .... 35 Airbag System Components ....... 24 Airbag Service .............................. 35 How the SRS Indicator Works ... 33 How Your Front Airbags Work.......................................... 27 How Your Side Airbags Work.... 30 How Your Side Curtain Airbags Work.......................................... 32 SRS Indicator.............................. 33, 66
START (Ignition Key Position) ... 129 Starting the Engine........................ 339 Auto Control Mode.................... 339 In Cold Weather at High Altitude ................................... 340 With a Dead Battery ................. 432 State Emissions Testing ............... 460 Steam Coming from Engine ......... 434 Steering Wheel Adjustment ................................. 124 Anti-theft Column Lock ............ 129 Buttons ....................... 233, 270, 281 Position Memory ....................... 157 Stereo Sound System .... 180, 181, 200 Storage Compartment ................... 164 Storing Your Vehicle ..................... 422 Sun Visor......................................... 166 Supplemental Restraint System Servicing ....................................... 35 SRS Indicator.......................... 33, 66 System Components.................... 24 Synthetic Oil ................................... 394 T Tachometer ...................................... 72
07/07/09 10:26:41 31STX610 0484
Index Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) ............. 351, 458 Low Tire Pressure Indicator............................ 68, 351 Tire Pressure Monitor ........ 77, 352 Tires ................................................ 415 Air Pressure ............................... 415 Checking Wear .......................... 417 Compact Spare ........................... 424 DOT Tire Quality Grading ....... 454 Inflation ....................................... 415 Inspection ................................... 417 Maintenance ............................... 418 Replacing .................................... 418 Rotating....................................... 418 Snow ............................................ 419 Specifications ............................. 453 Tire Chains ................................. 420 Tools, Tire Changing .................... 425 Torque Distribution Monitor (SH-AWD®) ................................ 348 Towing A Trailer ...................................... 363 Emergency Wrecker ................. 446 Equipment and Accessories ..... 368 Weight Limit .............................. 364
Trailer Loading .......................... 364 Trailer Stability Assist ............... 376 Trailer Towing Tips .................. 372 Trailer Stability Assist ................... 375 Transmission Checking Fluid Level ................ 399 Fluid Selection............................ 400 Identification Number............... 450 Shifting the Automatic .............. 341 Treadwear ...................................... 417 Trip Computer ................................. 78 Trip Meter ........................................ 75 Turn Signals ..................................... 67 Tools, Tire Changing .................... 425 U Unexpected, Taking Care of the ........................................... 423 Uniform Tire Quality Grading ..... 454 Unleaded Gasoline......................... 322 Used Oil, How to Dispose of ........ 395 INDEX
Tailgate ........................................... 131 Opening the ................................ 131 Open Monitor ............................... 11 Power .......................................... 132 Taillights, Changing Bulbs in ....... 406 Taking Care of the Unexpected .. 423 Technical Descriptions DOT Tire Quality Grading ....... 454 Emissions Control Systems ...... 460 Three Way Catalytic Converter ................................ 461 Temperature Gauge ........................ 72 Temperature, Inside Sensor ......... 179 Temperature, Outside ..................... 76 Tensioners, Seat Belts .................... 22 Tether Anchorage Points ............... 51 Theft Protection, Radio................. 235 Three Way Catalytic Converter ... 462 Tilt/Telescopic Steering Wheel .. 124 Timing Belt ..................................... 402 Tire Chains ..................................... 420 Tire, How to Change a Flat .......... 425 Tire Labeling .................................. 456
CONTINUED
IX
07/07/09 10:26:46 31STX610 0485
Index V Vanity Mirror ................................. 166 Vehicle Capacity Load .................. 333 Vehicle Dimensions....................... 452 Vehicle Identification Number..... 450 Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System..................................... 359 VSA System Indicator ... 67, 81, 359 VSA Activation Indicator ..................... 67, 81, 359 VSA Off Switch .......................... 360 Vehicle Storage .............................. 422 Ventilation ...................................... 177 VIN .................................................. 450 Viscosity, Oil................................... 393
W WARNING, Explanation of ............. iii Warning Labels, Location of .......... 59 Warranty Coverages* ................... 467 Washer, Windshield Checking the Fluid Level ......... 398 Level Indicator ............................. 82 Operation .................................... 116
X
Wheels Adjusting the Steering .............. 124 Alignment and Balance ............. 418 Aluminum Alloy Wheels ........... 421 Cleaning ...................................... 421 Compact Spare ........................... 424 Wrench, Nut ............................... 427 Windows Auto Reverse .............................. 150 Operating the Power ................. 149 Rear, Defogger .......................... 122 Windshield Cleaning ...................................... 116 Defroster .................................... 174 Washers ...................................... 116 Wipers, Windshield Changing Blades ........................ 411 Operation .................................... 116 Rear Windshield Wiper and Washer .................................... 117 Worn Tires ..................................... 417 Wrecker, Emergency Towing ...... 446
X XM Satellite Radio ................. 185, 210
*
: U.S. only
07/07/09 10:26:48 31STX610 0486
07/07/09 10:26:51 31STX610 0487
07/07/09 10:26:53 31STX610 0488
07/07/09 10:27:09 31STX610 0489
Service Information Summary Gasoline: Premium unleaded gasoline, pump octane number of 91 or higher. Fuel Tank Capacity: 21.00 US gal (79.5 ) Recommended Engine Oil: API Premium grade 5W-20 detergent oil (see page 393 ). Oil change capacity (including filter): 4.5 US qt (4.3 ) Automatic Transmission Fluid: Honda ATF-Z1 (Automatic Transmission Fluid) (see page 400 ).
Rear Differential Fluid: Use Honda ATF-Z1 (Automatic Transmission Fluid) only. Capacity: SH-AWD® differential case 2.6 US qt (2.5 ) Transfer Assembly Fluid: SAE 90 or SAE 80W-90 viscosity hypoid gear oil, API service classified GL4 or GL5 only. Power Steering Fluid: Honda Power Steering Fluid preferred, or another brand of power steering fluid as a temporary replacement. Do not use ATF (see page 402 ).
Brake Fluid: Honda Heavy Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3 preferred, or a DOT 3 or DOT 4 brake fluid as a temporary replacement (see page 401 ). Tire Pressure (measured cold): Front/Rear: 32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm ) Compact Spare Tire: 60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )